Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

MK Service-Manual

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 416

MK Service-Manual

Geely International Corporation


July. 2007
Foreword
Geely “MK” series sedans (JL7132U,JL7132HU,JL7152U,JL7152HU,JL7162U) are brand
new superior models developed by Geely Group who has fully proprietary intellectual property
rights. As a result of the three years of involvements and efforts of the experts from Geely Automo-
bile Research Institute, these sedans reach international leading level in model design, power,
sense of comfort, safety and manufacturing technology while featured in beautiful appearance,
economy, environment protection and safety. The meaning of MK implied that Geely Automobile
has a great development from caterpillar to butterfly. With respect to the power, Geely “MK” series
sedans are equipped with 1.3L, 1.5L, and 1.6L EFI engines developed and manufactured by Geely
itself, and has reached “Chinese III” (Euro III) emission standard.

This manual contains a detailed description of the structures and principles, servicing and adjustment,
removal, assembling technology and matching clearance of the parts of the Geely “MK” sedans
with torque information of the bolts and nuts as well as schematic diagram for special tool operation.
This manual also introduces the transmission control system of the automatic transmission models,
vehicle electric circuits and elaborates ABS system, SRS, BOSCH M7.9.7 electronic control fuel
injection and ignition system, rear parking radar, sound, air conditioning and onboard hands-free
phone system. You can refer to this manual for the information about the regular maintenance,
servicing, adjustment, troubleshooting, removal and installation procedure, specific operations of
the “MK” sedans.

This manual covers the matching relation among the engine assembly, transmission assembly and
the vehicle, but does not have the further description of the structures and principles of the engine
and transmission assemblies and their servicing process. You can refer to the service manuals
solely prepared for engine assembly and transmission assembly for these information.

All information in this manual is based on the latest products released at the time of publication of
this manual. However, the specifications and procedures may need to be modified, and the subse-
quent change will be revealed in later versions.

This manual is prepared by Geely Automobile Research Institute under the assistance of technical
staff from Zhejiang Geely Automobile Co., Ltd and Geely International Corporation. Readers
discovering during the use of this manual the errors and careless omissions due to limited skills of
the preparers and tight schedule are encouraged and pled to contact Geely International in time for
our timely correction of the mistakes.

Geely International Corporation


April 2007
Table of Contents I

Table of Contents
Part I General Information
Chapter 1 How to Use This Manual .................................................................................. 1-1
Chapter 2 Repair Instruction ............................................................................................. 1-3

Part II Vehicle Usage and Maintenance


Chapter 1 Brief Introduction of Geely MK ......................................................................... 2-1
Section 1 Major Functional and Technical Data of MK Series. ...................................... 2-1

Section 2 Vehicle System Configuration ........................................................................ 2-3


Section 3 Main Vehicle Test Technical Specification ...................................................... 2-5
Chapter 2 Usage and Maintenance of MK Series ............................................................ 2-6

Section 1 Usage of MK Series ....................................................................................... 2-6


Section 2 Maintenance Category and Content of MK Sedan........................................2-12
Section 3 Daily Maintenance of MK Sedan .................................................................... 2-18

Part III Engine


Chapter 1 Engine Assembly ............................................................................................... 3-1

Section 1 Engine Inspection ........................................................................................... 3-1


Section 2 Removal of the Engine Assembly from the Vehicle ....................................... 3-5
Section 3 Drive Belt Replacement .................................................................................. 3-7

Chapter 2 Engine Mechanical ............................................................................................ 3-8


Section 1 Engine Components ....................................................................................... 3-8
Section 2 Throttle Body .................................................................................................. 3-12

Section 3 Valve Clearance Adjustment .......................................................................... 3-14


Chapter 3 Fuel System ....................................................................................................... 3-15
Section 1 Check Fuel System Pressure ......................................................................... 3-15

Section 2 Fuel Pump Inspection..................................................................................... 3-16


Section 3 Fuel Pump Replacement ................................................................................ 3-17
I Table of Contents

Section 4 Fuel Emission Control System ....................................................................... 3-18


Section 5 Carbon Canister Replacement ....................................................................... 3-19
Chapter 4 Exhaust System ................................................................................................. 3-21

Chapter 5 Cooling System ................................................................................................. 3-22


Section 1 System Inspection .......................................................................................... 3-22
Section 2 Radiator Replacement................................................................................... 3-24

Chapter 6 Manual Transaxle Assembly............................................................................. 3-25


Section 1 Frequent Problem Diagnosis .......................................................................... 3-25
Section 2 Vehicle Speed Sensor Replacement ............................................................. 3-26

Section 3 Manual Transaxle Replacement ..................................................................... 3-27


Section 4 Transmission/Transaxle Case Oil Seal Replacement .................................... 3-28
Chapter 7 Automatic Transaxle Assembly ........................................................................ 3-29

Section 1 Frequent Problems Diagnosis ........................................................................ 3-29


Section 2 Hydraulic Torque Converter and Transaxle .................................................... 3-30
Section 3 Differential Front Oil Seal (ATM) .................................................................... 3-33

Section 4 Neutral Switch Assembly ................................................................................ 3-35

Part IV Chassis
Chapter 1 Transmission Control ........................................................................................ 4-1
Section 1 Introduction of Transmission Control ............................................................. 4-1
Section 2 Cable Type Transmission Control .................................................................. 4-3

Section 3 Manual Transmission Shift Mechanism .......................................................... 4-5


Section 4 Automatic Transmission Shift Mechanism...................................................... 4-7
Chapter 2 Accelerator Pedal Device ................................................................................. 4-11

Section 1 Introduction of Accelerator Pedal ................................................................... 4-11


Chapter 3 Clutch Control System ...................................................................................... 4-12
Section 1 Introduction of Clutch Centrol......................................................................... 4-12

Section 2 Clutch Pedal ................................................................................................... 4-13


Chapter 4 Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft ................................................................................ 4-17
Section 1 Propeller Shaft, Driveshaft and Transaxle ..................................................... 4-17
Table of Contents III

Section 2 Front Driveshaft .............................................................................................. 4-19


Section 3 Front Wheel Hub ............................................................................................ 4-30
Section 4 Rear Wheel Hub and Bearing Assembly ....................................................... 4-35

Chapter 5 Front Suspension System ................................................................................ 4-38


Section 1 Front Suspension System .............................................................................. 4-38
Section 2 Front Suspension ........................................................................................... 4-40

Section 3 Front Wheel Alignment ................................................................................... 4-43


Section 4 Front Strut Assembly ...................................................................................... 4-46
Section 5 Front Lower Swing Arm Assembly ................................................................. 4-49

Section 6 Front Stabilizer Bar and Link Rod Assembly.................................................. 4-53


Chapter 6 Rear Suspension System ................................................................................. 4-54
Section 1 Rear Suspension System ............................................................................... 4-54

Section 2 Rear Wheel Alignment ................................................................................... 4-56


Section 3 LH/RH Rear Suspension Coil Spring ............................................................. 4-57
Section 4 Rear Absorber Installation Assembly ............................................................. 4-60

Section 5 Rear Suspension Crossmember .................................................................... 4-62


Chapter 7 Wheel .................................................................................................................. 4-66
Section 1 Tire Inspection and Wheel Replacement ....................................................... 4-66

Chapter 8 Power Steering System .................................................................................... 4-67


Section 1 Power Steering System .................................................................................. 4-67
Section 2 Steering Drive and Control Mechanism ......................................................... 4-69

Section 3 Steering Pipeline Component ........................................................................ 4-73


Section 4 Power Steering Gear ...................................................................................... 4-75
Chapter 9 Brake System .................................................................................................... 4-79

Section 1 Brake System ................................................................................................. 4-79


Section 2 Brake Fluid ..................................................................................................... 4-81
Section 3 Brake Pedal .................................................................................................... 4-82

Section 4 Brake Master Cylinder Assembly ................................................................... 4-85


Section 5 Vacuum Booster ............................................................................................. 4-91
Section 6 Front Brake Disc ............................................................................................. 4-94
IV Table of Contents

Section 7 Rear Brake Drum ............................................................................................ 4-99


Section 8 Parking Brake System.......................................................................................4-106

Part V Electric System & Accessory


Chapter 1 Starting and Charging System ......................................................................... 5-1

Section 1 Starting System (MR479Q, MR479QA, MR481QA) ...................................... 5-1


Section 2 Charging System (MR479Q, MR479QA, MR481QA) .................................... 5-3
Chapter 2 Combination Instrument System ..................................................................... 5-7

Section 1 Wiring diagram of Combination Instrument and Location of Multi-pin Plug-in Terminal 5-7
Section 2 Malfunction Symptom Table and Troubleshooting ......................................... 5-10
Chapter 3 Wiper and Washer System ............................................................................... 5-21

Section 1 Wiper and Washer System Inspection ........................................................... 5-21


Section 2 Replacement and Adjustment ........................................................................ 5-23
Chapter 4 Light System ...................................................................................................... 5-26

Section 1 Light System Introduction ............................................................................... 5-26


Section 2 Light System Malfunction Inspection ............................................................. 5-28
Section 3 Headlamp Replacement ................................................................................. 5-34

Section 4 Front Fog Lamp Replacement ...................................................................... 5-35


Section 5 Rear Combination Lamp Replacement .......................................................... 5-36
Section 6 High-mounted Stop light Replacement .......................................................... 5-36

Section 7 Front Reading Lamp Replacement ................................................................ 5-37


Section 8 Rear Reading Lamp Replacement ................................................................. 5-37
Section 9 License Plate Lamp Replacement ................................................................. 5-37

Chapter 5 Audio System ..................................................................................................... 5-38


Section 1 Audio System Description .............................................................................. 5-38
Section 2 Audio System Connector Terminal Layout ..................................................... 5-40

Section 3 Audio System Inspection ................................................................................ 5-41


Section 4 Audio System Replacement ........................................................................... 5-52
Chapter 6 SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) ............................................................ 5-54
Table of Contents V

Section 1 SRS General Information ............................................................................... 5-54


Chapter 7 Air Conditioning System ................................................................................... 5-72
Section 1 General Information........................................................................................ 5-72

Section 2 Refrigerant ...................................................................................................... 5-77


Section 3 A/C Operating Mechanism ............................................................................. 5-83
Section 4 Heater, Ventilation and Air Conditioning ........................................................ 5-86

Section 5 Layont of Air Conditioning Hose ..................................................................... 5-92


Section 6 Multi-wedge belt (Connecting Compressor and Crankshaft Pulley) .............. 5-93
Section 7 Compressor Assembly.................................................................................... 5-94

Section 8 Condenser Fan and Condenser Assembly .................................................... 5-96


Chapter 8 MK-60 ABS System ........................................................................................... 5-99
Section 1 ABS Diagnosis ................................................................................................ 5-99

Section 2 ABS System Check ...................................................................................... 5-103


Section 3 Removal and Installation .............................................................................. 5-138
Section 2 Power Door Lock Control System ................................................................ 5-142

Part 6 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory


Chapter 1 Front Seat Assembly ......................................................................................... 6-1

Chapter 2 Rear Row Seat Assembly ................................................................................. 6-3


Chapter 3 Front Seat Belt ................................................................................................... 6-5
Chapter 4 Rear Seat Belt .................................................................................................... 6-9

Chapter 5 Dashboard, Middle Console and Instrument Panel ....................................... 6-11


Chapter 6 Windshield ......................................................................................................... 6-16
Chapter 7 Rear Window Glass (with Defrosting Heater Wire) ........................................ 6-20

Chapter 8 Side Inner Panel Trim ........................................................................................ 6-22


Chapter 9 Roof Trim ............................................................................................................ 6-25
Chapter 10 Front Door Interior Trim .................................................................................. 6-27

Chapter 11 Rear Door Interior Trim ................................................................................... 6-30


Chapter 12 Front Bumper ................................................................................................... 6-33
Chapter 13 Rear Bumper .................................................................................................... 6-35
VI Table of Contents

Chapter 14 Outside Rearview Mirror ................................................................................. 6-37


Chapter 15 Door Protecting Stripe .................................................................................... 6-38
Chapter 16 Carpet and Insulator ....................................................................................... 6-39

Chapter 17 Moonroof Assembly (Optional) ...................................................................... 6-40


Chapter 18 Plug List ........................................................................................................... 6-42

Part 7 Body
Chapter 1 Survey ................................................................................................................ 7-1
Section 1 Body Structure ................................................................................................ 7-1

Chapter 2 Body Repair ....................................................................................................... 7-9


Section 1 Body Damage Forms and Requirements for Repair...................................... 7-9
Section 2 Typical Technique of Body Panel Repair ....................................................... 7-16

Section 3 Repair After Body Damage ............................................................................ 7-16


Section 4 Features and Composition of Automobile Body ............................................ 7-24
Section 5 Painting Techniques After Body Repair ......................................................... 7-35

Section 6 Service Data For for Body .............................................................................. 7-36

Attachment: Body Key Dimensions


Appendix: Torque Table of the Fasteners for Important Assembly
General Information - How to Use This Manual 1-1

Part 1 General Information


Chapter 1 How to Use This Manual
I. Instruction
1. General Information
(1)This manual conform to the first part of GB/T1.1--2000 Standardization Guide: The structure and prepar-
ing rule of the standard.
(2)Generally, the repairing job can be divided into the following 3 procedures:
1. Diagnosis
2. Removal and installation, replacement, disassembly and inspection, adjustment
3. Final inspection
(3)The first procedure “Diagnosis” (the details refers to each section or chapter) and second procedure “Re-
moval and installation, replacement, disassembly and inspection, adjustment” are scattered in the chapters and
sections, and this manual omits the third procedure “Final inspection”.
(4)This manual does not include the following basic operations which are imperative in real scenarios.
a. operate the jack or lifter
b. clean the removed parts if necessary.
c. inspect the appearance
2. Preparation
SST (Special Service Tools) and SSM (Special Service Materials) may be required and correctly used based
on the repairing condition, make sure the job procedure is followed.
3. Repair Procedure
(1)The disassembly illustration is placed under the title.
(2)The illustration shows the disassembly of the parts to help you understand the assembly of the parts.
(3)Non-reusable parts need to be coated with grease, and the precoated parts and torque are specially shown
in the disassembly illustration.
(4)Sometimes, the illustrations of the similar model are used where there may be some details differently
from the actual vehicle.
(5)The operational procedure is described in the following ways:
a. The illustration shows what to do and where to do it.
b. The task heading tells what to do.
c.The detailed text tells how to perform the task and gives other information such as specifications and
warnings.
4. Specification
Specifications are presented in bold type throughout the manual.
5.Term Definition
Caution indicates there is a possibility of injury to you or other people.
Notice indicates the possibility of damage to the components being repaired.
Tip provides additional information to help you perform the repair efficiently.
6. International System of Unit
The Units given in this manual are primarily expressed according to the International System of Unit.
1-2 General Information - How to Use This Manual

II. Vehicle Identification


1. Vehicle Identification Number
(VIN):
Vehicle Identification Number
(VIN) is the legal identification of the
vehicle which is printed on the middle
of the engine compartment cowl (as
shown in the illustration).
VIN code position

2. VIN Code 3. Ex-work Nameplate: on the middle of the engine


compartment cowl

4. VIN Code: on the left lower corner of the front windshield.

5. Engine Number: 6. Transmission Mark:


marked on the engine block as shown in the illustration printed on the left side of the transmission

Mark position

Mark position
General Information - Repair Instruction 1-3

Chapter 2 Repair Instruction


I. Precautions
1. Basic Repair Hint
(1)Operation Hint

2
1

4 3
6 5

Vehicle Protection Before the work, place radiator fascia cloth, fender cloth, seat cover and mat.
Appearance Always wear clean uniform
Make sure to wear the helmet and safety shoe
when more than 2 persons work together, be sure to pay mutual attention to the safety.
when it is required to run the engine, you have to pay attention to the ventilation of the workshop.
Safe Operation When handling the high-temperature, rotating, moving and vibrating parts, be careful not to be scalded
or hurt.
When lifting the vehicle, safety stand should be used to support the specified position.
When lifting the vehicle, safety devices should be used.
The diagnosis requires full understanding of the trouble and effective operation.
Before the parts are removed, check the assembly for distortion and damage.
Removal and The diagnosis requires full understanding of the trouble and effective operation.
installation, disas- Before the parts are removed, check the assembly for distortion and damage.
semble and inspection If the structure is complicated, notes or marks should made to avoid mistake and impact of the part
function.
If needed, clean the removed parts and reassemble them after careful inspection.
Prepare the tools and Before the work, prepare the tool fixture, special tools, instrument, oil, workshop cloth and required
measuring instrument parts for replacement.
arrange the removed parts in correct sequence, do not confuse or contaminate them.
For non-reusable parts such as gasket, O ring and self-locking nut, replace them with new ones in
Removed parts
accordance with the instruction described in this manual.
Pick up replaced parts, put them in the containers, and show them to the customers.
1-4 General Information - Repair Instruction

(2)Lift and support the vehicle


Be careful to lift and support the vehicle. Make sure that the vehicle is appropriately supported.
(3)Precoated Parts
a. Precoated parts are bolts, nuts, etc. that are coated with a seal
lock adhesive at the factory.
b. If a precoated part is retightened, loosened or caused to move
in any way, it must be recoated with the specified adhesive.
c. When reusing precoated parts, clean off the old adhesive and
dry with compressed air. Then apply the specified sealing adhesive Sealing Adhesive
to the bolt, nut or threads.
Notice: the torque should achieve the lower limit of the allowed torque range.
d.The precoated parts should be kept intact for a period of time for induration based on the requirement of
the sealing adhesive.
(4)Gasket
If necessary, apply the sealant to the gasket to prevent disclosure.
(5)Bolt, nut and screw
Be careful to follow all torque specification and torque wrench should be used.

(6)Fuse
Equal Rated Ampere Value
When replacing fuses, be sure the new fuse has the correct am-
perage rating. Do not exceed the rating or use one with a lower rating.

Illustration Symbol Part Name

Fuse

Medium Current
Fuse

High Current Fuse


General Information - Repair Instruction 1-5

(7)Clip
The following illustration shows the typical removal and installation of the clip for body parts.
Tip:
If the clip is damaged during the operation, you have to replace it with a new one.

Illustration Removal/installation
Protective Band

Screwdriver

Protective Band

Scraper

Slip-joint
Pliers

Clip Remover
1-6 General Information - Repair Instruction

Illustration Removal/installation

Remove
Install

Remove

Install

2. For Vehicles Equipped With SRS Airbag and Seat Belt Pretensioner
Tip: This is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental Restraint System), such as the driver airbag assembly,
front passenger airbag assembly airbag ECU and seat belt pretensioner. Failure to carry out service operations in
the correct sequence could cause the supplemental restraint system to unexpectedly deploy during servicing,
possibly leading to a serious accident. Further, if a mistake is made in servicing the supplemental restraint
system, it is possible the SRS may fail to operate when required. Before servicing (including removal or instal-
lation of parts, inspection or replacement), be sure to read the following items carefully, then follow the correct
procedure described in this manual.
(1) General Notice
a. Malfunction symptoms of the supplemental restraint system are difficult to confirm, so the diagnostic
trouble codes become the most important source of information when troubleshooting. When troubleshooting
the supplemental restraint system, always inspect the diagnostic trouble codes before disconnecting the battery.
b. Work must be started after 90 seconds from the time the ignition switch is turned to the "LOCK"
position and the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery. (The supplemental restraint system
is equipped with a back--up power source so that if work is started within 90 seconds of disconnecting the
negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, the SRS may deploy.) When the negative (-) terminal cable is
disconnected from the battery, memory of the clock and audio systems will be cancelled. So before starting
work, make a record of the contents memorized by the each memory system. Then when work is finished, reset
the clock and audio systems as before. To avoid erasing the memory of each memory system, never use a back-
up power supply from another battery.
General Information - Repair Instruction 1-7

c. Even in cases of a minor collision where the SRS does not deploy, the driver airbag assembly, front
passenger airbag assembly and seat belt pretensioner should be inspected.
d. Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When replacing parts, replace them with new parts.
e. Before repairs, remove the airbag ECU if shocks are likely to be applied to the sensor during repairs.
f. Never disassemble and repair the airbag ECU assembly, driver airbag assembly, front passenger airbag
assembly or seat belt pretensioner.
g. If the airbag ECU assembly, driver airbag assembly, front passenger airbag assembly or seat belt
pretensioner has been dropped, or if there are cracks, dents or other defects in the case, bracket or connector,
replace them with new ones.
h. Do not directly expose the airbag ECU assembly, driver airbag assembly, front passenger airbag assem-
bly or seat belt pretensioner to hot air or flames.
i. Use a volt/ohmmeter with high impedance (10 k ohm/ V minimum) for troubleshooting of the electrical
circuit.
j. Information labels are attached to the periphery of the SRS components. Follow the instructions on the
notices.
k. After work on the supplemental restraint system is completed, check the SRS warning light
(2) Clock Spring (in combination switch)
The steering wheel must be fitted correctly to the steering col-
umn with the clock spring at the neutral position, otherwise clock
Mark
spring disconnection and other troubles may result.

(3) Driver Airbag Assembly


a. When removing the driver airbag assembly or handling a new driver airbag assembly, it should be placed
with the steering wheel top surface facing up. Storing the steering wheel with its top surface facing downward
may lead to a serious accident if the airbag deploys for some reason. In addition do not store a driver airbag
assembly on top of another one.
b. Never measure the resistance of the airbag squib. (This may cause the airbag to deploy, which is very
dangerous.)
c. Grease should not be applied to the driver airbag assembly and the pad should not be cleaned with
detergents of any kind.

Correct Wrong
1-8 General Information - Repair Instruction

d. Store the driver airbag assembly where the ambient temperature remains below 93C , without
high humidity and away from electrical noise.
e. When using electric welding, first disconnect the airbag connector (yellow color and 2 pins) under the
steering column near the combination switch connector before starting work.
f. When disposing of a vehicle or the driver airbag assembly alone, the airbag should be deployed using an
SST before disposal. Perform the operation in a safe place away from electrical noise.
(4) Front Passenger Airbag Assembly
a. Always store a removed or new front passenger airbag assembly with the airbag rupture surface facing
up. Storing the airbag assembly with the airbag rupture surface facing down could cause a serious accident if the
airbag inflates.
b. Never measure the resistance of the airbag squib. (This may cause the airbag to deploy, which is very
dangerous.)
c. Grease should not be applied to the front passenger airbag assembly and the airbag door should not be
cleaned with detergents of any kind.
d. Store the airbag assembly where the ambient temperature remains below 93C , without high humidity
and away from electrical noise.
e. When using electric welding, first disconnect the airbag connector (yellow color and 2 pins) installed on
the assembly before starting work.
f. When disposing of a vehicle or the airbag assembly alone, the airbag should be deployed using an SST
before disposal. Perform the operation in a safe place away from electrical noise.

Correct Wrong

(5) Seat Belt Pretensioner


a. Never measure the resistance of the seat belt pretensioner. (This may cause the seat belt pretensioner to
activate, which is very dangerous.)
b. Never disassemble the seat belt pretensioner.
c. Never install the seat belt pretensioner in another vehicle.
d. Store the seat belt pretensioner where the ambient temperature remains below 80C and away from
electrical noise without high humidity.
e. When using electric welding, first disconnect the connector (yellow color and 2 pins) before starting
work.
f. When disposing of a vehicle or the seat belt pretensioner alone, the seat belt pretensioner should be
activated before disposal. Perform the operation in a safe place away from electrical noise.
g. The seat belt pretensioner is hot after activation, so let it cool down sufficiently before the disposal.
However never apply water to the seat belt pretensioner.
h. There should be no oil or water on the seat belt, no cleanser should be used to wash it.
General Information - Repair Instruction 1-9

(6) Airbag ECU


a. Never reuse the airbag ECU involved in a collision when the SRS has deployed.
b. The connectors to the airbag sensor assembly should be connected or disconnected with the airbag ECU
mounted on the floor. If the connectors are connected or disconnected while the airbag ECU is not mounted to
the floor, it could cause undesired inflation of the supplemental restraint system.
c. Work must be started after 60 seconds from the time the ignition switch is turned to the "LOCK" position
and the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, even if only loosing the set bolts of the
airbag ECU.
(7) Wire Harness and Connector
The SRS wire harness is integrated with the instrument panel wire harness assembly. All the connectors in
the system are a standard yellow color. If the SRS wire harness becomes disconnected or the connector becomes
broken due to an accident, etc., repair or replace it.

3. Electronic Control Device


(1) Removal of the battery terminal cable
a. Before performing electrical servicing, disconnect the nega-
tive (-) cable from the battery in order to avoid short for burnout. Negative(-)
b. When disconnecting the terminal cable, turn off the ignition Cable

and light switches, loosen the cable nut and raise the cable straight
up without twisting or prying it.
c. When disconnecting the terminal cable from the battery, all
information stored in the clock, radio and DTC shall be deleted,
therefore, these information shall be checked before disconnection.
(2) Processing of Electronic Parts
a. Do not open the cover or case of the ECU unless absolutely
necessary. (If the IC terminals are touched, the IC may be destroyed
by static electricity.)
b. To pull apart electrical connectors, pull on the connector itself,
not the wires.
c. Be careful not to drop electrical components, such as ECU
or relays. If they are dropped on a hard floor, they should be replaced
and not reused.
d. When steam cleaning an engine, protect the electronic Wrong
components, air filter and emission-related components from water.
e. Never use an impact wrench to remove or install tempera-
ture switches or temperature sensors.
f. When checking continuity at the wire connector, insert the
tester probe carefully to prevent terminals from bending.
4. Remove and Installation of Engine Intake Parts
(1)If any metal scrap is mixed in the inlet pass, that may give a
bad effect to the engine.
(2)When removing and installing of the inlet system parts, close
1-10 General Information - Repair Instruction

the opening of the removed inlet system parts and the engine with a
clean shop lag or gum tape.
(3)When installing the inlet system parts, check that there is no
mixing of a metal scrap.
5. Handling of Hose Clamp Steel Band Circlip
(1)Before removing the hose, check the clamp position to re-tighten
it for sure.
(2)Replace a deformed or dented clamp with a new one.
(3)In case of reusing the hose, install the clamp on the hose where
it has a clamp track.
(4)For a steel band circlip, make it adjust by adding force to the Clamp Trace
arrow mark direction after the installation.

II. Vehicle Lift and Support Location


1. Vehicle Conditions To Be Under Attention During Lift
(1)Generally speaking, when being lifted, the vehicle should be empty, do not lift the heavily loaded vehicles.
(2)When removing heavy parts such as engine and transmission, the center of gravity of the vehicle will move.
Place balance weight to prevent the vehicle from rolling or use special jack to support the vehicle.
2. Precautions for Use of Four-tappet Lift
(1)follow the safe operation instruction described in this manual.
(2)do not damage the tire or rim.
(3)use wheel stopper to retain the vehicle.
3.Precautions for Use of Jack and Safety Stand
(1)always use the wheel stoppers when performing servicing on
level ground.
Rubber Suport
(2)use safety stand and rubber support as shown in the illustration.
(3)use the jack and safety stand to support specified location.
(4)When jacking up the front wheels of the vehicle, release the
park brake and place stoppers only behind the rear wheels. When
jacking up the rear wheels, place stoppers only before the front wheels.
(5)During the job, make sure to use safety stand instead of jack
only to support the vehicle.
(6)When only jacking up the front wheels or rear wheels, place
stoppers before or after the wheels touching the ground.
(7)when lowering the vehicle with its front wheels lifted, release
the park brake, and place the stopper only before the rear wheels.
When lowering the vehicle with its rear wheels lifted, place the stop-
per only after the front wheels.
General Information - Repair Instruction 1-11

Jack Position

Support Position
Jack Lifting Position
Center of Gravity of the Vehicle
(empty load)

4. Precautions for Use of Swing Arm Type Lift


(1) follow the safe operation instruction described in this manual.
(2) use bracket with rubber support as shown in the illustration.
(3) make the center of gravity of the vehicle as close as possible to that of the lift ("L" should be smaller).
(4) adjust the bracker height, level the vehicle, align the groove of the bracket with the safety stand
support location.
(5) the arm should be locked during the job
(6) lift the vehicle until the tires become round.Swing the vehicle to make sure of stable vehicle.
5. Precautions for Use of Plate Type Lift
(1) follow the safe operation instruction described in this manual.
(2) use the support of the plate type lift.
(3) make sure to secure the vehicle in the specified position.

Left and right set position Place the vehicle over the center of the lift.
Align the cushion gum ends of the plate with the attachment
Front and rear set position lower ends (A, C).
Align the attachment upper end (B) with the front jack supporting point.
1-12 General Information - Repair Instruction

(3)lift the vehicle until the tires become a little bit round. Swing the vehicle to make sure of stable vehicle.

Lift Center
Swing Arm Type Lifter

Cener of Gravity of the Vehicle


(Empty Load) rubber support
Plate Type Lift

Support Dimension

Support
Vehicle Usage and Maintenance - Brief Introduction of Geely MK 2-1

Part II Vehicle Usage and Maintenance


Chapter 1 Brief Introduction of Geely MK
Section 1 Major Functional and Technical Data of MK Series.
I. Vehicle performance and structural data
Table 1 vehicle data

ID Item Unit JL7132U JL7152U JL7162U JL7132HU JL7152HU


Length 4342
Dimension Width 1692
Height mm 1435
1 Dimension Front 1450
Axle
Rear 1431
Wheelbase 2502
Front Suspension mm 848
Rear suspension 992
2 Number of passengers person 5
Curb weight 1090(1040) 1080
Weight Curb Front Axle 660(640) 665
Rear Axle 430(400) 415
3
Vehicle kg 1460(1410) 1450(1455)
Gross Vehicle
Front 780(760) 780(785)
Weight
Rear 680(650) 670
Minimum turning diameter m 10.4m
Road
Minimum Ground Clearance mm 150mm
4 adaptability
Approach angle ° 15°
Deviation angle ° 20°
Max turning angle Left: Inner/out ° 37.2°±2°/ 32°±2°
of front wheel Right: inner/out ° 37.2°±2°/ 32°±2°
Wheel Front wheel leaning angle ° -0°30'±45'
Posi- Kingpin inward leaning angle ° 10°0'±45'
5
tioning Kingpin rearward leaning angle ° 2°0'±45'
Left front wheel toe-in mm 1±2mm
Rear wheel outward ° -0°56'±45'
2-2 Brief Introduction of Geely MK - Major Functional and Technical Data of MK Series.

II. Introduction of major systems


Table 2 Models and technical data of major systems.

ID Item Description Unit JL7132U JL7152U JL7162U JL7132HU JL7152HU


1 Drive Type 4 ›‹ 2 Front Wheel Drive
Model MR479Q MR479QA MR481QA MR479Q MR479QA
Type In-line 4 cylinder In-line 4 cylinder In-line 4 cylinder In-line 4 cylinder In-line 4 cylinder
Bore Diameter mm 78.7 78.7 81.0 78.7 78.7
Engine Piston play mm 69.0 77.0 77.0 69.0 77.0
2 Displacement L 1.342 1.498 1.587 1.342 1.498
Compression Ratio 9.3 : 1 9.8 : 1 9.6 : 1 9.3 : 1 9.8 : 1
Max Power kw/r/min 63/6000 69/6000 78.7/6000 63/6000 69/6000
Max Torque N.m/r/min 110/5200 128/3400 137/4400 110/5200 128/3400
Idle Speed r/min 800±50 800±50 800±50 800±50 800±50
Ignition Sequence 1-3-4-2 1-3-4-2 1-3-4-2 1-3-4-2 1-3-4-2
minimum fuel consumption rate g/kw.h 259 279 269 259 279
Model JL-S160 JL-S160A JL-Z110 JL-Z130
1st gear 3.182 3.087 3.087
2nd gear 1.895 1.634 1.634
3rd gear 1.250 1 1
3 Transmission
4th gear 0.909 / /
5th gear 0.703 / /
Reverse gear 3.083 2.29 2.29
Final Drive Ratio 4.308 3.317 3.317
4 Clutch Type Single disc, Plate and dry Spring /
5 Steering type Hydraulic Gear-rack
Braking Model Hydraulic, X-type pipe
6
system Booster type Vacuum booster, Front Wheel Disc, Rear Wheel Drum
Front McPherson suspension strut system
7 suspension
Rear Twist beam independent suspension system
Specification 85/60R15(1175/65R14)
8 Tire Tire pressure KPa 230(Front)/210(Rear)
Wheel Aluminum 15X6J (Iron 14X5 1/2JJ)
9 Fuel Tank Capacity L 45
10 Body structure Unitary construction body
Brief Introduction of Geely MK - Vehicle Configuration 2-3

Table 3 Power Performance Parameter


No. Item Name Unit JL7132U JL7152U JL7162U JL7132HU JL7152HU
1 Maximum vehicle speed km/h 155 165 175 155 165
2 Acceleration time within the fourth gear from 30km/h to 120km/h s 33 30 28 / /
3 Acceleration time from 0-100km/h s 20 18 16.5 22 20
4 Minimum stable vehicle speed within the fourth gear km/h 25 /
5 Maximum gradeability % 30

Table 4 Economic Performance Parameter


No. Item Name Unit JL7132U JL7152U JL7162U JL7132HU JL7152HU
1 Fuel consumption at constant speed (60km/h) L/100km 4.5 4.6 4.7 5.0 5.1
2 Fuel consumption at constant speed (90km/h) L/100km 6.2 6.2 6.3 6.6 6.7
3 Coasting distance (fully loaded, initial speed 50km/h) m 550 550 550 550 550

Section 2 Vehicle Configuration


No. Item Name Type Standard Comfortable Luxury
1 Common color Chinese red, snow mountain white, pearl black, sky blue, ribbon silver
Body color
2 Uncommon color Crystal diamond silver, golden sand green, pineapple yellow
3 Front chromeplated trim molding
4 Diamond-shape headlight
5 Crystal diamond taillight
6 Exterior Highly penetrable front fog light
7 device Green heat insulating four-door glass
8 Scuff strip with same color as that of the body
9 Aluminum alloy wheel rim
10 Tire (185/60R15) (with spare tire)
11 Retractive antenna (A pillar)
12 Bumper with same color as that of the body
13 Light color (T)deep color(S)mixed color(R)interior trim / / / / / /
14 Central control panel Firry red Firry red Titanium silver
15 A/C outlet vent + trim ring
Interior
16 Chromeplated inner handle
device
17 Sun shade (with ticket folder)
High-grade flannelette
18 Seat
Luxury leather
19 Front seat headrest front and rear angle/height adjustable function
2-4 Brief Introduction of Geely MK - Vehicle Configuration

No. Item Name Type Standard Comfortable Luxury


20 Front seat back trash bag
21 6/4 split foldable rear seat
Interior Cable-controlled oil tank cap
22
device
23 Cable-controlled trunk
plastic
24 Adjustable steering wheel
leather
25 Power window (with one-touch function)
26 Remote control central door lock
27 Power rearview mirror with turn signal light
Smart remote control key (control the closure of the
28
door and window and the delay of the vehicle lights)
29 Adjustable intermittent wiper
Electric
30 device On-board handsfree handset
31 Anti-clamp retractive power window
32 Central pointer type instrument
33 Temperature display
34 Hi-fi CD audio Single Disc Single Disc 6 Discs
35 MP3 function
36 Speaker 6 speakers (2 Tweeters) 6 speakers (2 Tweeters) 6 speakers (2 Tweeters)
37 Freon-free A/C system
38 Air cleaner
39 ABS + EBD
40 Driver side airbag
41 Front passenger side airbag
42 Telescopic steering column
Safety
43 Front seat belt pretensioner /height adjustable
device
44 Rear row triple-person seat belt
45 Anti-glaze inner rearview mirror
46 Anti-explosion and anti-leak plastic oil tank
47 Rear windshield defroster function
48 High-mounted stop light
49 Four-door anti-impact beam
50 Digital display rear parking radar
51 Follow me home light delay system

Remark: - denote standard configuration Z - standard C - comfortable D - luxury S - dark interior trim
T - light colored interior trim R - mixed color
Brief Introduction of Geely MK - Main Vehicle Test Technical Specification 2-5

Section 3 Main Vehicle Test Technical Specification


Item Description Specification
Front wheel outward leaning angle -0°30'± 45'
Kingpin inward leaning angle 10°0'± 45'
Kingpin rearward leaning angle 2°0'± 45'
Left front wheel toe-in (mm) 1±2
Rear wheel outward leaning angle -0°56'± 45'
% of braking total power vs. gross vehicle weight 60% (no load), 50% (full load)
% of front wheel braking power vs. front axle load 60% (no load, and full load)
Inspection
% of gap between left and right wheel brake power vs. the 20%(Front Axis),
line items
greater braking power of them two 24%(Rear Axis)
rolling resistance of each wheel should not be larger than the axle load by 5%
parking brake total power should be lighter than the test vehicle weight by 20%
sliding distance of front/rear wheels 2 m/km
when vehicle speed meter shows 40km/h, vehicle speed
33.3 Km/h-42.1Km/h
monitor indicates
brightness of left/right headlamps 15000 cd

tolerance of close lamps is (0.6-0.8)H, H refers to the central


height of headlamps.
tolerance of distant lamps is 10cm/10m
Harsh brake at 50km/h. the stop distance is 19m
Rain test. 100 points is full mark. Minus one point for each
seepage. Minus 3 points for slow seepage 3 points, and minus 93 points
6 for a quick seepage. The limit of vehicle sealing is
Check leaks of the vehicle. When vehicle has run 50km, stop it and
inspect for leaks. Check if there is oil/water marks at static joints, Daily inspection and smell with
Regular or if there is oil/water drops dripping down at dynamic joints nose
quality 10min after the vehicle is stopped, there is a leak; if there is oil/
inspection water marks/drops, but it does not drip down, there is seepage.
items Measure the temperature of transmission oil inspection hole.
70°C
Usually it is not higher than ambient temperature.
Check the surface temperature of wheel trim column. Usually
40°C
it is no higher than ambient temperature.
vehicle should be slightly steering insufficient i.e. driving on
a circle with same steering wheel angle, and accelerate from Inspect regularly
low to high speed, the diameter of the circle increases gradually.
Maximum front wheel turning angle (inner/outer) 37.2°±2°/ 32°±2°
Emission Specification: GB18352.3-2005
2-6 Usage and Maintenance of MK Series - Usage of MK Series

Chapter 2 Usage and Maintenance of MK Series


Section 1 Usage of MK Series
1. Instrument Panel Overview
1.Instrument Panel Outlet Vent
2. Instrument Panel
3.Upper Glove Compartment
(Front Passenger Airbag Cover)
4.Sunshade
5.Dome Light And Sunroof
Switch
6.Inside Rearview Mirror
7.Glove Box
8. Power Window Regulator
Switch
9. Manual Transmission Shift
Lever Or Automatic Transmis-
sion Shift Lever
10.Parking Brake Control Lever
11.Engine Hood Release Handle
12.Power Window Lock
13.Power Door Lock Switch

1.Left Combination Switch


2.Right Combination Switch
3.Display
4.Audio
5.Short-Distance Odometer
Adjustment Button
6.Instrument Panel Brightness
Adjustment Switch
7.Hazard Warning Light
8.A/C Control Panel
9.Ash Tray
10.Defroster Switch
11.Cigarette Lighter
12.”A/C“ Switch
13.Ignition Switch
14.Tilt Steering Adjustment
Handle
15.Theft-Deterrent Indicator
16.Power Outside Rearview
Mirror Control Switch
Usage and Maintenance of MK Series - Usage of MK Series 2-7

2.How to use ignition switch


(1) LOCK when key is at this position, it can be pulled out and inserted in easily. The function of this position
is to lock steering wheel. If the key cannot be turned from LOCK to ACC, please rotate the steering wheel slightly
while turning the ignition key.
(2) ACC radio and cigarette lighter is turned on when key is at this position.
(3) ON when key is at this position, the following indicator is on: battery charging, ABS, brake fluid level,
park brake, engine coolant temperature, engine MIL, airbag oil pressure.
(4) START Turn the key to this position to start the engine. When engine is started, release the key
immediately. It returns to ON automatically. When engine is on, do not turn the key to this position.
Notice:
(1) Do not pull the key out or turn it to LOCK before the car is fully stopped, or there will be dangers caused
by locking steering wheel or disabling some safety functions.
(2) It is prohibited to drive the car with engine turned off to ensure functioning of braking and steering booster.
(3) Do not let the key stay at ON for a long time when engine is off, or the battery fully discharged.
(4) Shift to neutral gear before ignition key is switched to START.
(5) Turn the steering wheel lightly after the car is fully stopped to make sure it is locked.
3.Unlock Steering Wheel
How to unlock steering wheel: insert ignition key, turn the steering wheel lightly and switch the ignition key.
Steering wheel is unlocked.
4.Adjust seat position
Seat back angle and cushion angle of front seats in MK-1 sedan can be adjusted.
(1) Adjust seat back angle
Turn around adjusting handle, and adjust seat back to appro
priate position.
(2) Move seat forward or backward
Steps:
a. pull adjusting handler up
b. Move the seat forward or backward, and adjust the seat to
appropriate position.
c. Put the handler down and move the seat again till it is
locked.
Attention: adjust the seat only when the car is fully stopped 1
Adjust seat back angle
to ensure safety. 2
Move seat forward or backward angle
(3) Front head rest can be adjusted in two ways.
Push the head rest from back to front, there are three fixed
positions to lock.If pushed over the final locking position,the
head rest can return to the original position after hand
withdraws.
(4) Fold Rear Row Seat
The seat back can be tilted forward so that the trunk will be
used to the last degree.
a. Remove the head rest
b. Unlock the seatback and fold it down.
Split seatback can be folded separately on demand.
2-8 Usage and Maintenance of MK Series - Usage of MK Series

5. Actions to ensure vehicle working condition and safe driving.


(1) To make sure of driving safety, execute the following inspections before driving.
a. Inspect fuel level, and add fuel when necessary.
b. Inspect illuminating lights, turning signal lights, braking signal lights to see if they work.
c.Check the position of rearview mirrors.
d.Check if breaking system functions well.
e.Check if glass of all the lights, windshield is clean.
(2) Regular inspection Perform the following regular inspections to ensure the vehicle work condition and
driving safety.
a. Check engine oil level. Park the vehicle on flat road; check the oil level with engine oil level indicator
at least 10 minutes after the engine is stopped. The oil level should be between the two marks. If it is
lower than "L" mark, add some oil; if it is higher than "F" mark, there is excessive oil, so release it.
Or investigate the cause of high oil level.
The volume between the lowest oil level ("L") and highest oil level ("F") is 1.4L.
b. Check engine coolant level. Check the level when the engine is cool. The coolant level should be between
LOW and FULL. If it is lower than "LOW", add coolant. If the coolant is much lower than Min (every
coolant fill is more than 1L) or the vehicle requires frequent fills,investigate if there is any problem with
the cooling system.
To keep the function of coolant, replace coolant every two years at the beginning of cold winter.
c. Check brake and clutch fluid level (sharing a reservoir). Brake fluid level should between the Max and
Min marks. And it is better to keep it close to the Max mark. Add fluid in time when there is not enough
fluid.
d. Check power steering fluid tank. The level should be between Max and Min marks. Refill when there
is not enough steering fluid to avoid pump stuck. It is strictly prohibited to run the vehicle without
steering fluid in any circumstances.
e. Check the charging status of battery and if the connection of battery wires is good.
f. Check tire status and pressure
g. Check the status of wipers.
(3) Observe warning lights and indicators on instrument panel.
a. There are various warning lights and indicators on the instrument panel of MK-1 sedans to indicate and
warn abnormal operations of engine, braking, and charging systems.
b. Pay attention to these lights when driving.When the warning lights or indicators are on,stop the vehicle,
check the vehicle and resolve the causes to make sure the vehicle works well or drives safely.
6. Correct ways to use new cars
Reliability and stability of components in new cars and recently repaired cars still need to be confirmed, and
relative parts are not broken-in, so they must be used carefully to ensure driving safety, to avoid abnormal damage,
and to extend the useful life of the car.
(1) Before driving inspection The following inspections must be performed on the new car to ensure car safety
and reliable operation:
a. Check if instrument panel, warning lights, and indicator, front and rear wiper and washer, and switches
work.
b. Check if the fastening of driveline, steering, suspension, wheels and other connection parts is good.
Usage and Maintenance of MK Series - Usage of MK Series 2-9

c. Check levels of braking fluid, engine coolant, engine oil, transmission oil, power steering fluid, and
washing fluid to see if there is any leaking.
d. Inspect if brake pedal, clutch pedal, accelerator pedal, transmission shifter, steering wheel, choke are
loose or stuck. The free travel of clutch pedal is 5~15mm, the free travel of brake pedal is 1~6mm and
the free play of steering wheel is less than 30mm(measurement point at margin of steering wheel). if it
is out of this normal range, the clutch needs to be tuned.
e. Inspect if the connection of battery, lamps and signal lights are normal, and if the wire routing and
position are correct and not loose.
f. Inspect if the tire pressure is correct.
(2) On-road inspection If the inspection result of the above items is good, start the engine and test the car on
road, and perform the following inspections.
a. Acceleration pedal, see if the operation is smooth and if it is loose.
b. Clutch, see if there is any stuck or abnormal noise, and slip when driving.
c. Transmission,check if shifting is smooth,or rough and wrong shifting.Inspect if the display of A/T
shift lever is normal.
d. Steering, check if steering is light and smooth, and if the steering wheel turns back after steering.
e. Brake pedal, apply brake pedal to check if the braking functions well when vehicle speed is at
40km/h and if the vehicle runs off track.
f. Park brake, when parking brake handler is pulled, there should be 6~9 clicking sounds. Pull park brake
when vehicle is running at the speed of 20km/h and transmission is at neutral gear to see if it brakes.
g. Vehicle speed meter, observe the vehicle speed meter while driving. When speed changes, check if the
indicator is moving steadily or shakes.
h. Heating and air-conditioning.Try every control button to see if both heating and cooling system work
well.
i. Abnormal noise, listen carefully to see if there is any abnormal noise from engine, drive line system or
any other parts of the vehicle at a steady speed and during accelerating, and decelerating.
(3) Inspection after test ride check if there is anything abnormal in the vehicle while driving and conduct the
following inspections after the vehicle is parked.
a. Check electrical fan When engine coolant temperature is beyond 92.5°C, the radiator fan should be
running; When A/C is on and the pressure of refrigerant is more than 1.5 cooling ton, air conditioning
cooling fan should be running.
b. Check headlamp, method: park the car 5m away from the inspection surface (inspection board, curtain,
or wall) to the front bumper, and check if the beam from headlamp is good. The upper level if headlamp
should be 540mm above the ground, and the distance between headlamps on the two sides is 900mm.
c. Inspect engine idle speed,idle speed of hot engine is 800r/min±50r/min,when A/C compressor works,
the idle speed should be 900r/min±50r/min. If idle speed is abnormal, adjust the idle speed adjust
ment screw to adjust it.
(4) Usage of new cars in breaking-in period Follow the instructions below in the first 1500~2500km breaking
mileage to avoid wear and abnormal damage in breaking-in period, and to improve vehicle performance, fuel
economy and to extend vehicle useful life.
a. Drive steadily during breaking-in; do not accelerate harshly to avoid running engine at high speed.
Engine should not exceed 4500r/min in any gears. Especially at the early stage of breaking-in, vehicle
2-10 Usage and Maintenance of MK Series - Usage of MK Series

must be running at medium speed without load. Increase the speed and load gradually with the
accumulation of breaking-in mileage.
b. Because the brake plat is not broken in on a new vehicle,in order to ensure safety and reduce wear,avoid
harsh brake, and brake for multiple times to break in the brake plate faster.
c. It is better to avoid driving vehicle on steep roads or in bad conditions during breaking-in period.
d. Pay special attention to engine coolant temperature meter and oil pressure meter.Check engine oil level
frequently and make sure engine works in normal temperature and good lubrication.
e. Maintain the vehicle strictly according to first-time maintenance requirements to bring the vehicle into
normal usage life under good condition.
7.vehicle towing
There are towing facilities both in the front and rear end of MK-1 sedan for towing other vehicles and being towed.
To ensure safety, pay attention to the following instructions when towing.
(1) Towing car Towing car should be started and shifted steadily.The speed should be no more than 40km/h.
(2) Follow the instructions below when being towed:
a. Steering system of the vehicle being towed works well.
b. Braking system of the vehicle being towed works well or it cannot be towed with a rope and must be
towed with the towing shaft instead.
c. Release park brake and shift the transmission to neutral gear when the vehicle is being towed.
d. Turn the ignition switch to ACC to allow turning signal lights,braking indicator to be turned on when
necessary.
e. The towing rope must be tensioned in the towing process.
f. If the purpose of towing is to start the engine, shift the transmission to the 2nd or 3rd gear to increase
engine speed. It is good for starting the engine.
8. Instructions to save fuel when using the vehicle
(1) Reasonable load Do not store useless articles in luggage compartment because they consumes fuel for
nothing.
(2) Correct driving style Instructions as follows:
a. When engine is started, do not heat it but press the accelerator pedal slightly, drive the vehicle slowly
and accelerate gradually.
b. Shift to higher gears when driving to allow the engine to work at appropriate engine speed and avoid
running the engine at low or high speed. The engine speed should be higher than 2500r/min when
driving, and higher than 3000r/min when up-shifting.
c. Keep the vehicle speed stable, and avoid harsh acceleration and frequent braking.
d. Pay attention to vehicle speed. Drive at high speed results in excessive fuel consumption.
(3) Organize vehicle usage well Pay attention to the following two instructions.
a. Organize vehicle usage time and avoid short trips. Because at the beginning when the vehicle is started
(around 1km), the engine has not reached its efficiency point, and the fuel consumption doubles
compared to regular.
b. Select a good driving route, avoid driving through the city or blocks with heavy traffic.
(4) Keep the vehicle under good work condition Strictly follow instructions to maintain the vehicle to make
sure the vehicle is under good technical working condition, and inspect and replace key parts that affect vehicle
fuel consumptions. For example:
Usage and Maintenance of MK Series - Usage of MK Series 2-11

a. Keep air filter clean, Block of air filter affects engine air induction efficiency and increases fuel
consumption. So it must be cleaned and replaced in time.
b. Keep ignition system under good work condition. Bad connection or electricity leak of ignition coil and
power distributor or inappropriate gap or carbon residue of spark plug decreases ignition power supply
and efficiency, which leads to engine fuel consumption increase. So they need regular inspection and
repair to keep their good work condition.
c. Fuel feeding system works well. Often check if fuel feeder pipe leaks, and check if injectors and other
parts perform well on regular basis (electrical injection engines).
d. Keep regular tire pressure. If the tire pressure is not enough, vehicle rolling resistance increases and
engine fuel consumption increases accordingly. So tire pressure must be checked on time (around once
a week).
2-12 Usage and Maintenance of MK Series - Maintenance Category and Content of MK Sedan

Section 2 Maintenance Category and Content of MK Sedan


As the vehicle is being used, its technical performance changes as the mileage accumulates and being affected by
various factors, which results in decrease of power, fuel economy, safety, and increase of emission pollutions,
noise and incidents. So timely maintenance during vehicle usage eliminates potential risks and prevents incidents
from happening, improves vehicle integrity and technical functionality, and prolongs useful life of the vehicle.
According to the vehicle technical requirements and usage history, maintenance of freedom Cruiser sedan can be
classified into several categories.
I. first time maintenance
First time maintenance is also called breaking-in maintenance. It is performed when the vehicle mileage has
accumulated to 1500~2500km in breaking-in period. First time maintenance must be conducted at the appointed
service shops. It includes:
1. Check if there is any leak in engine, transmission, and differential. Fix if there is any.
2. Replace engine oil filter, engine oil and ATF for A/T.
3. Check the level of engine coolant, braking fluid, windshield washing fluid, power steering fluid and if there
is any leak. Refill if the level is too low and repair if there is any leak.
4. Check if there is any damage in triangle arm and ball joint, connection ball joint, triangle arm flexible hinge,
or the ball joint is loose. If there is, fix or replace it.
5. Check if the drive shaft dust cover is damaged. If there is, replace it.
6. Check if there is any leak in steering mechanism, or front and rear absorber and fix it there is any.
7. Check the tire pressure, front 230kpa, and rear 210kpa.

II. Regular maintenance


After first time maintenance, the vehicle is in regular usage life. During regular use, the vehicle needs to be
maintained regularly according to the way it is used in.
1.Regular maintenance for vehicles used under extreme bad conditions. Any of the condition below is defined
as extreme bad condition:
(1) Frequent start.
(2) Often drive the vehicle in dusty circumstances.
(3) Drive the vehicle in hot areas (such as in summer in the south).
(4) Often drive in cold areas (often runs short trips, engine temperate cannot reach regular work temperature).
Vehicles ran under extreme bad conditions need to be maintained every 5000km.
2. Regular maintenance for vehicles Vehicles that have not been through extreme bad conditions need to be
maintained every 7500km.
Regular maintenance is required to be performed at Geely service shop, too.
List of parts that need to be replaced regularly is in table 1.
Maintenance timetable is in table2.

III. Geely maintenance program


Geely recommends following Geely maintenance program.
The intervals of maintenance schedules are determined by mileage meter or time periods. Maintain the vehicle
when either meets the schedule. For details, please refer to the schedule.
Usage and Maintenance of MK Series - Maintenance Category and Content of MK Sedan 2-13

For servicing items whose deadlines have expired, they should be maintained at the same intervals as before. The
intervals are recorded in maintenance schedule.
Rubber hoses
Used in cooling and heating system, braking and fuel-feeding systems should be inspected by qualified Geely
technicians according to Geely maintenance schedule.
There are all very important maintenance items. Hoses must be replaced immediately should there be any aging
or damage. Please pay attention, rubber hoses age as time goes by, and they may have problems of inflation, wear,
or crack.
Special Tips
If the vehicle is driven under one or more of the following circumstances, the maintenance items should be
carried out more frequently. See attached maintenance schedule.
A Road condition
1. drive on rough, muddy or skiddy roads
2. drive on dusty roads.
B driving condition
1. Repeat driving within 8km a few times, or when the outdoor temperature is below 0 degree centigrade.
2. Idle the car drive at a low speed for a long time, such as police car, taxi, or door to door delivery vehicles.
3. Continuously drive the car at high speed for more than 2 hours (80% of the max speed).

IV. Regular inspections


1. weekly schedule
inspect engine oil level and cleanness
inspect engine coolant level
inspect brake fluid level
inspect windshield wash fluid level
inspect power steering fluid level
2. monthly inspections
inspect water pump belt
inspect electrolyte level in battery
inspect tire air pressure and wear
inspect steering wheel
inspect brake
inspect acceleration pedal
3. inspection when driving (low speed)
inspect speed meter and water temperature
check steering wheel power and if vehicle runs off-track
check if the front wheels skid or swing
inspect if brake functions or if the vehicle runs off-track when brake is functioning
4. other inspection items
Eliminate problems immediately when there is anything abnormal
2-14 Usage and Maintenance of MK Series - Maintenance Category and Content of MK Sedan

V. Table 1 List of parts to be replaced regularly


(Table 1)
System Parts need to be replaced regularly Intervals
1 Brake master cylinder cup valve and dust cover Every 2 years (or as required)
2 Brake master cylinder cup Every 2 years (or as required)
Braking
3 Brake hose Every 2 years (or as required)
System
4 Brake caliper valve Every 4 years (or as required)
5 Brake booster rubber Every 2 years (or as required)
6 Brake booster vacuum hose Every 4 years (or as required)
7 Brake fluid Every 2 years,or 40000km (or as required)
8 MT Transmission oil Every 2 years,or 40000km (or as required)
Driveline
9 AT Transmission oil Every 2 years,or 40000km (or as required)
Steering System 10 Steering fluid Every 2 years,or 40000km (or as required)
To be cleaned every 10,000km and changed
A/C System 11 Air Cleaner
every 30,000km (or as required)
First 2500km or 2 months. Every 7500km or
12 Air c leaner f ilter
6 months afterward (or as required)
First 2500km or 2 months. Every 7500km or
13 Lubricant (API) SG or above
Engine 6 months afterward (or as required)
14 Oil filter Every 5000km (or as required)
15 Fuel filter Every 40000km (or as required)
16 Coolant Every year (or as required)
17 All hoses Every 2 years (or as required)
18 Canister Every 60000km (or as required)
19 Timing belt Every 120000km (or as required)
Wedge belt (including the power steering pump,
20 Every 50000km (or as required)
air conditioner compressor and generator belts)
21 PCV system Every 20000km or 12 months (or as required)
22 Spark plug Every 20000km (or as required)

The intervals in the part list are for cars driven under normal condition. If the car is driven in special circumstances,
the replacement can be advanced from the schedule above.
Usage and Maintenance of MK Series - Maintenance Category and Content of MK Sedan 2-15

VI. Table 2 Maintenance Timetable of Geely Freedom Cruiser Sedan


Maintain the vehicle when either mileage or time has reached maintenance requirements. User should keep
maintaining the vehicle to no less than 100000km. User can send the vehicle for inspection and repair in advance
if it has been through special conditions.
o ......Inspect . . . . . . R e p l a c e Table 2

X1000km 7.5 15 22.5 30 37.5 45 52.5 60 67.5 75


System Inspection item
Year 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5
Steering Steering-wheel Play,Fastening and abnormal noise o o o o o
Wheel o o
Operation o o o
Steering Oil Leak o o o
Gear o
Steering
Fastening o
System Steering Fastening,abnormal noise and damage o o o o o
Link and Steering link,joint,rack and dust boot o o o o o
Joint
crack and damage
Knuckle Abnormal noise at a joint o o
Front Wheel adjustment o o o o
Wheel Left and right rotation angle o
Trie pressure o o o o o o o o o o
Tire crack and damage o o o o o o o o o o
Tire thread and uneven wear o o o o o o o o o o
Drive
line
Wheel Metal dust,stone and foreign material o o o o o o o o o o
Loose hub nut and bolt o o o o o
Front wheel bearing abnormal noise o o
Rear wheel bearing abnormal noise o o
Free play o o o o o o o o o o
Clutch
Operation o o o o o
Oil leak and oil level o o o o o
Manual
Transmission
Operation system abnormal noise o o
Drive
Replace oil
Train
Automatic Replace ATF
Transmission Oil leak and oil level o o o o o
Joint fastening o o o o o
Driveshaft
Universal joint,dust root crack and damage o o o o o
Spline abnormal noise o o
Universal joint abnormal nosie o o
Brake Free play and Function o o o o o o o o o o
Pedal Function o o o o o o o o o o
Braking Operating travel o o o o o o o o o o
System Parking
Function o o o o o
Brake o
Parking brake cable fastening,abnormal noise and damage o
2-16 Usage and Maintenance of MK Series - Maintenance Category and Content of MK Sedan

o ......Inspect ......Replace

X1000km 7.5 15 22.5 30 37.5 45 52.5 60 67.5 75


System Inspection item
Year 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5
Brake Brake reservoir level o o o o o o o o o o
Booster Function o o
Master brake cylinder,brake Brake liguid leak o o o o o o
cylinder and brakecalipel
Function wear and damage o o
Braking
System Brake
Clearance between brake drum and brake lining o o o o o
Drum and Brake shoe sliding part and brake lining wear o o o o o
Shoe Brake drum wear and damage o o
Brake Disc and Brake lining wear o o o o o
Brake Lining Brake disc wear and damage o o
Spring Damage o o
Attachment Fastening and damage of attachment o o
and Joint Abnormal noise at a joint o o
Suspen-
Suspension Noise from joint,damage to arm and o o
sion
Arm and
System shock absorber fluid leak and damage
Shock
Absorber Abnormal noise at fixture o o
Spark plug working status o o o o o o o o o o
Lgnition time o o o o o
Ignition System
Distributor air gap o o o o o
Electri- Distributor cap condition o o o o o
cal
Battery Connection o o o o o
System
Wiring Harnee and Clip Fastening and damage of joints o o
Lighting Function o o o o o o o o o o
Comblned Instrument Function o o o o o
Horn,Wiper and Function
Washer o o o o o
Defrost and Function
Power Door Lock o o o o o
Starting performance,abnormal noise,
Engine o o o o o
idle and acceleration
Engine General
Status Valve clearance o o
Oil leak o o o o o o
Body Door and Trunk Lock Lock Function o o
and Hood Fastening abnormal noise and damage o o
Acces-
Seat Seat and seat belt status o o
sory
Others Lubrication o o o o o
Usage and Maintenance of MK Series - Maintenance Category and Content of MK Sedan 2-17

VII . Additional maintenance schedule


Vehicles run in special circumstances require higher frequency of maintenance as listed below.

A-1: driving on bumpy, muddy or melted snow road.

o Inspection of the brake friction wafer and braking drum Every 10,000 km (kilometer) or every 6 months
o Inspection of the braking pad and braking disc Every 5,000km (kilometer) or every 3 months
o Inspection of the brake piping and hose Driving for 1000 km (kilometer) for the first time and
then every 10,000 km or every 6 months
o Inspection of the transmit shaft ball and joint and dust shield Every 10,000 km (kilometer) or every 6 months
o Inspection of the drive shaft cover Every 10,000 km (kilometer) or every 12 months
o Inspection of the steering wheel, connecting rod and steering gear Every 5,000km (kilometer) or every 3 months
box oil
o Inspection of the front and rear suspension devices Every 10,000 km (kilometer) or every 6 months
o Screwing down the bolts and nuts of the chassis and vehicle body Every 10,000 km (kilometer) or every 6 months

A-2: driving on dusty road


o Replacement of engine oil Every 5,000km (kilometer) or every 6 months
o Replacement of engine oil filter Every 5,000km (kilometer) or every 6 months
o Inspection and replacement of air filter Every 2,500km (kilometer) or every 3 months
o Inspection of the brake friction wafer and braking drum Every 10,000 km (kilometer) or every 6 months
o Inspection of the braking pad and braking disc Every 5,000km (kilometer) or every 3 months
o Replacement of the air conditioner filter Every 10,000km (kilometer)

B-1: repeated short-distance driving and outer air temperature under zero within 8km (kilometer)

o Replacement of engine oil Every 2,500km (kilometer) or every 3 months


o Replacement of engine oil filter Every 5,000km (kilometer) or every 6 months

B-2: long-term empty run and / or long-distance driving with low speed, such as police wagon, taxi or automobile delivering
goods to the customers etc

o Inspection of the brake friction wafer and braking drum Every 10,000 km (kilometer) or every 6 months
o Inspection of the braking pad and braking disc Every 5,000km (kilometer) or every 3 months

B-3: continuous high-speed driving for more than 2 hours (80% of the maximum vehicle speed or above)

o Replacement of driving axle oil of the manual transmission Every 40,000km (kilometer) or every 48 months
o Inspection or replacement of the driving axle fluid of the Every 40,000km (kilometer) or every 24 months
automatic transmission
2-18 Usage and Maintenance of MK Series - Daily Maintenance of MK Sedan

Section 3 Daily Maintenance of MK Sedan


Daily maintenance means operation of vehicle regular inspection, cleaning, fastening, and refilling according to
vehicle usage and condition on the basis of regular maintenance to make sure the vehicle is at good status. Daily
maintenance can be performed by driver or professional automotive mechanics in daily use of vehicle. But some
of the items must be conducted by professional mechanics at service shops.
1. Maintenance of air cleaner
Air cleaner filters the air that is coming into engine for the first time. Dust and other dirt filtered out gathers in the
induction tube. Air cleaner filters a lot of dust and dirty, so it must be cleaned in time.
2. Maintenance of air filter
Air filter does not only filter the dust and dirt in the air, but also keeps smooth ventilation. Its status has great effects
on the fuel economy and power of the engine, so it must be checked and maintained in time.
Before it is time to replace air filter, maintain it. Remove the filter, knock it with hand or stick to get rid of dust
on the filter and remove dirt inside the filter cover according to the cleanness of the road that the vehicle usually
runs on.
ATTENTION: do not clean the filter with wet cloth. Fasten the filter well when installing it back.
3. Maintenance of battery
Battery is used to start the vehicle and supply power to electrical facilities. Its status directly affects the regular
usage of the vehicle, especially for vehicles equipped with electrical controlled facilities. Keeping the battery in
good technical status and connections is especially important. It is necessary to often perform the following
inspections and maintenance in regular usage:
(1) Clean the outside of battery Inspect if the battery case or cover surface is dirty or has dirt, oil, or other dirty
things regularly. Clean it and keep the surface dry to avoid electrical leak caused by cover deformation.
(2) Check battery connections Bad connection between battery electrode and cable results in low engine start
speed which makes it difficult to start the vehicle or the vehicle cannot be started because of low output voltage
from battery. Loose connection at battery end leads to damage of electrical components and loss of trouble code
and other information stored in RAM of the computer system as a result of low voltage. Therefore, it is necessary
to check if the connection of cables on the battery electrode is good. When it is found loose, it must be fastened.
If there is any rust, the cables must be loosened, washed clean and be connected again.
4. Maintenance of tires and wheels
(1) Keeping tires and wheels under good condition is very important to vehicle fuel consumption and driving
safety. Therefore, inspect and maintain the tires regularly. Every 10000 km, the wheels should be adjusted. Follow
the sequence in picture 3:
Judge if there is any hidden problems in vehicle chassis mechanism by observing wear in different places, and
finding out the hidden problems does not only help you to understand
the technical status of the vehicle, but also benefits driving safety.
a. Serious wear on both edges of tire tread, means tires often
work with low tire pressure.
b. Wear of middle of the tire tread is mainly because the tires
are used with high tire pressure.This kind of wear shortens
the useful life of tires, and may result in sudden flat tire
when the vehicle runs on uneven road surface or meets any
obstacles.
Usage and Maintenance of MK Series - Daily Maintenance of MK Sedan 2-19

c. Wavy wear on the tread is related to its quality and positioning of the wheels. Find out the root cause
and eliminate any problems.
d. Serious wear on the outer side beside the tread of steering wheels means the wheel outward leaning angle
is too big; wear on the inner side beside the tread means the leaning angle is too small.
e. When the toe-in value is getting smaller, the wear on the outer side of tread is in shape of saws. On the
contrary, when the inner side has the saw shape wear means the toe-in value is too big.
(2) Maintenance
a. Keep the tire pressure to specified value under any circumstances. Measure the pressure on cold tire
b. Check tire pressure regularly, and remove any indented objects that may stick through the tires.
c. Avoid oil, gasoline, and brake fluid on tires.
d. When replaced with new tires, the wheels need to be balanced and adjusted again. Or the vehicle may
shake when running at high speed and bear abnormal wear.
e. Do not mix tires of different structure, pattern, or brand on one vehicle.
(3) Tire specification and pressure
Tire Specification Tire Pressure (KPa)
Front Tire 185/60R15 84H or 175/65R14 82H 230
Rear Tire 185/60R15 84H or 175/65R14 82H 210
(4) Tire wear limits
When the wear limit mark on tire shows up as the tire wears, it must be replaced with new tires (wear limit mark
indicates the thickness of tire pattern is 1.6mm).
5. Maintenance of wiper and washer
Status of wiper and washer directly influences windshield and driver's view. So, pay attention to wipers and
washers.
(1) Wiper Check if the wiper blade has any damage, deformation, which affects windshield wiping quality
and if the wiper works well. If wiper blade does not wipe well or the wiper does not work well, fix or replace it
in time.
(2) Washer Check washing fluid level in the tank, and refill when necessary. To get best washing effects, use
specified washing fluid, refill slowly, and pay attention not to mix it with any dirt. Mix the washing fluid with some
alcohol in winter to avoid freezing.
6. inspect and adjust headlamp
Incorrect beam of the headlamps affects safety of driving in the dark. So they must be inspected regularly, and be
adjusted when necessary.
7. Maintenance of inside the vehicle
The major content of maintenance inside the vehicle is cleaning, to keep the vehicle clean and provide fresh and
pleasant driving circumstance. The key points of indoor cleaning are:
(1) Ways to remove stains Get rid of dust before trying to remove stains, and then apply appropriate cleansing,
and wipe the stains off with clean, soft, and not too wet cloth repeatedly.
(2) Cleansing It is better to remove stains on textile and man-made leather with hydro solvent made from soap
fluid and surface active agent. Be careful to avoid using any cleansing because they may corrode the synthetic
decoration materials more or less. Ball-pen and lipstick marks can be removed with alcohol, grease can be removed
with low Ron value gasoline, and chocolate and sugar stains can be cleaned with ammonia spirit, asphalt must be
cleaned with special cleansing.
2-20 Usage and Maintenance of MK Series - Daily Maintenance of MK Sedan

(3) Long time exposure to sun damages interior. So it is better to use covers on upper seat backs, and rear
separation board that are exposed to sun.
8. Maintenance of body exterior
Body exterior is to keep body cleanness and brightness to give the impression of beauty and comfort, and to avoid
rust and abnormal paint peeling off. The key points of body maintenances are:
(1) Wash body using the method below:
a. Wash the dirty things off the body by pressurized water, and then clean the body with
soft cloth of sponge from up to down.
b. Dry body surface with good white cloth. Apply brake pedal several times when driving
after the car is washed to get rid of water in braking system.
c. Do not wipe the body when it is dry. Do not clean paint surface and glass with gasoline,
coal oil, narkosid, strong lye or alcohol.
(2) Cleaning windshield glass
Do not use silicon-bronze radical products. To get better cleaning effects, use special glass cleanser.
(3) Cleaning asphalt on the body
Do not peel the asphalt off from body or bumper, but use special cleanser
(4) Paint
Scratches or slight damages can be fixed with special paint spray. It dries in the air.
(5) Cleaning exterior decoration parts and aluminum parts.
Wash with water with soap fluid or cleanser, and wash with clean water. To keep the gloss of painted surface,
wax on the surface after it is dry.
(6) Polish and wax the body paint polishing and waxing keeps the body bright and pretty, and protects the paint
as well.
a. Polish in winter. Make sure the vehicle body is absolutely clean and dry before
polishing, polish with fluid or milky wax.
b. Vehicle body must be absolutely dry and clean before waxing. Use waxing tools (soft
table tissue or smooth cotton cloth) to cover the body paint surface evenly with wax.
Check if the vehicle body is covered by wax: spray some water onto the paint surface,
if water drops are formed, that surface is waxed, otherwise, clean the surface and wax
it again. Attention: do not wax under sun, or in cold weather.
Attention
1) When using high pressure washing machine, do not point the washing sprayer to transmission, steering
mechanism and other rubber protection parts, or exterior decoration parts, roof welding lines, heat radiator
or engine compartment.
2) The bottom of vehicle body is made of anti-corrosion material,and has been through anti-corrosion process.
After the vehicle has been running frequently on roads de-frozen with salt for some time, clean engine
compartment and lower part of vehicle body and take some protection actions.
Engine - Engine Assembly 3-1

Part III Engine


Chpater 1 Engine Assembly
Information about engine accessories in MK-1 Car Maintenance Manual deals with only that concerned with a
complete car. Please refer to separated Maintenance Manual for information about the engine body. Engines
concerned are MR479Q, MR479QA and MR481QA.

Section 1 Engine Inspection


1. Check the engine oil
(1) Check the oil level.
(2) Start the engine, and reach warm-up temperature.
(3) Shut the engine down, wait for 3-5min, and check the oil level.
(4) Check whether the oil level is in within the range marked by the scale; if it is lower than the limit (mark
L), fill oil to mark F.
(5) Keep the oil clean without any coolant or petrol mixed in and with appropriate viscosity.
2. Change oil.
(1) Start the engine. When normal temperature is reached, shut down the engine.
(2) Open the oil cap, remove the oil drain plug, and drain the oil.
(3) Tighten the oil drain plug to a specified torque 54N.m.
(4) Fill fresh oil into the crank case with oil quantity 2.8L in case of the filter not changed, 3.0L in case of the
filter changed and 3.5L in case of the dry filter.
(5) Fit on the oil filling cap.
(6) Start the engine.
(7) Shut down the engine and check the oil quantity, and fill oil to the mark F on the oil scale if necessary.
3. Replace the oil filter.
(1) Remove the oil filter.
(2) Before mounting the oil filter, apply a small quantity of engine oil to the O-ring of the new oil filter.
(3) Tight the oil filter to a specified torque (12.7N.m).
(4) Start the engine, and check whether there is any leakage
(5) Shut down the engine, check the oil quantity and fill as required.
4. Oil selection
Oil over PAI SG grade is preferred.
SAE10W-30 or SAE10W-40 is preferred, and ASE5W-30 is used in cold region in the winter.
Note: For the best effect and the greatest safety, it is advisable to use the following lubrication oil.
a. Meet the requirements of API level.
b. Select proper SAE viscosity rating within expected ambient temperature.
The lubrication oil that can not meet the requirements of SAE viscosity and API label at the same time is not
allowed.
5. Check the coolant.
(1) After the engine is cooled down, remove the radiator cover.
3-2 Engine Assembly - Engine Inspection

(2) Make sure that the coolant level is above the neck of the radiator.
(3) Put the radiator cover in place, pressurize to 2.0Mpa, and keep the pressure for 1minute unless the coolant
leaks. (Mount a tester on the radiator cover, start the engine, and then shut down under a pressure 2.0Mpa).
(4) Check whether the coolant quantity in the dilatation can is between the mark "Low" and "Full".
(5) Check whether the radiator cover is clean; test whether the opening pressure of the main valve is 107.8KPa
with a radiator cover tester. The minimum opening pressure is 58.5KPa.
6. Check the battery.
(1) The terminal voltage of the battery is 12.5-12.9V at 20°C, and charge when the voltage value is less than
the specified value. Check whether the fusible cutout and the fuse are loose, corrosive or on.
7. Check the air filter.
(1) Whether the cover, the case or the element of the filter is distorted, corroded or damaged.
(2) Whether the air hose is damaged.
(3) Whether the air chamber is distorted or damaged.
(4) Whether the air filter element is blocked, polluted or damaged. If the filter element is blocked slightly,
remove the dirt by blowing the element from above.
(5) Whether there is any pollutant or dirt on the air filter support.
8. Check the spark plug.
(1) Spark generation.
a. Disconnect the coupling of the injector.
b. Remove the spark plug from the secondary wire.
c. Remove the spark plug.
d. Connect the spark plug to the secondary wire.
e. Ground the spark plug.
f. Start the engine, and check whether spark is generated.
Prompt: The starting time is not more than 1-2s.
(2) Clean the spark plug: The air pressure is not greater than 588kp and the time is not more than 20s.
(3) Check whether the thread and the insulator of the spark plug are damaged. Replace if necessary.
(4) Check the electrode gap of the spark plug: 0.8±0.1mm for MR479Q and MR479QA; 1±0.05mm for
MR481QA.
9. Check the driving belt.
Water
Belt distortion (see Table 1): pump
3 1 Alternator
Belt pressure: 98N
Table
Power steering
New belt mm Used belt mm pump
Generator drive belt 7~9 11.5-13.5 Compressor

Power steering belt 5~6 6~8 Crank


2
Air conditioner belt 6.5~7 8~9 Measure belt looseness
Note:
Figure 1-1
Check the belt distortion at the specified point (see Figure 1-1).
When mounting a new belt, set the tensioning force to specified value.
After the belt has been operated more than 5 minutes, check and ensure the distortion not exceeding specified
value.
Engine Assembly - Engine Inspection 3-3

After the belt is re-mounted and operates more than 5 minutes, check the distortion based on old belt
distortion.
Check the tensioning force and the distortion of the V-belt after the crankshaft of the engine has rotated 2
turns.
10. Check the ignition timing (see Figure 1-2).
(1) Start the engine for warming up.
(2) When using the portable tester:
Connect the portable tester to the fault diagnosis socket
(DLC3).
Ignition timing:
10°±20' before the top dead center when idling.
Prompt:
Please refer to the operating manual of the portable tester for Figure 1-2
detail.
(3) When not using the portable tester:
a.Short the terminals 13(TC) and 4(CG) of the fault diagnosis socket(DLC3) with special service tool(SST).
Attention:
Make sure to connect correctly, or else the engine can be damaged.
Switch off all the electric systems.
Check when the cooling fan motor is disconnected.
b.Check the ignition timing with a timing light.
Ignition timing: 10°±20' before the top dead center when idling.
Note:
(a) Check the ignition timing, and the transmission should be set to the neutral position.
(b) Keep the engine speed at 1,000-1,300r/min for 5s and check when idling.
(c) Remove the special tool on the fault diagnosis socket.
(d) When the engine speed rises, the advance angle of ignition timing will increase.
(e) Remove the timing light.
11. Check the engine idle (see Figure 1-3).
(1) The engine warms up.
(2) When using the portable tester: Connect the portable tester to the fault diagnosis socket (DLC3).
Tip: Please refer to the operating manual of the portable tester for
detail. Tachometer
(3) When not using the portable tester:
Connect the test pen of the tachometer to the terminal 9(TAC) of
the fault diagnosis socket (DLC3) with special tool (SST). (see
Figure 1-3).
(4) Check the idling speed: 800±50r/min.
Attention: Battery
Check idle when the cooling fan motor is disconnected.
Switch off all the electric accessories and air conditioners. Figure 1-3
3-4 Engine Assembly - Engine Inspection

12. Check the compressing pressure (see Figure 1-4).


(1) Warm up and switch off the engine.
(2) Remove the secondary wire.
(3) Remove the spark plug.
(4) Check the compressing pressure in the cylinder.
a.Insert the pressure gauge into the spark plug bore.
b. Throttle widely opens.
c. Rotate the engine crankshaft and measure the compressing Figure 1-4
pressure (see Table 2).
Table 2
MR479Q MR479QA MR481QA
Cylinder compressing pressure (KPa)
1250 1320 1360
Pressure difference range of cylinders of this model (KPa) 100
Minimum compressing pressure (KPa) 980

Attention:
The electric quantity in the battery should be always enough, and the engine speed should be not less than
250r/min.
Check the compressing pressure in other cylinders in the same way.
Measure as soon as possible.
(5) If the compressing pressure in more than one cylinder is relatively low, fill a bit engine oil to the cylinder
through the spark plug bore, and repeat step a to c to check.
Tip:
If the compressing pressure is increased after the oil is filled, the piston ring or the cylinder may be worn or
damaged.
If the pressure is still low, the valve may be jammed or badly sealed, or the washer may be leaked.
13. Check CO/HC.
(1) Start the engine.
(2) Keep the engine running at a speed of 2500 r/min for about 180s.
(3) During idling, insert the test bar of CO/HC instrument into the exhaust pipe about 40cm depth at least.
(4) Check the concentration of emission of CO/HC at idle speed and at a speed of 2500 r/min respectively.
Tip:
Measure within 3 minutes.
Test the concentration of emission and lambda value of CO/HC at idle speed and at a speed of 2500 r/min
respectively according to GB18352.3-2005 standard.
(5) If the concentration of CO/HC is not up to standard, carry out fault diagnosis by following the steps below.
(1) Check oxygen sensor.
(2) Refer to Table 3 to find possible causes, check and repair.
Engine Assembly - Removal of the Engine Assembly from the Vehicle 3-5

Table 3
CO HC Problems Causes
1. Ignition fault:
Incorrect ignition timing;
Normal High Bad idle speed Dirt, short circuit, or incorrect spark plug gap.
2. Incorrect valve gap.
3. Suction and exhaust valve leak.
4. Cylinder leaks.
1. Vacuum leaks.
PCV pipe . manifold;
Low High Bad idle speed Idle speed control valve;
(HC reading fluctuates) Brake booster pipeline.
2. Spark lacks since the mixed gas is too thin.
1. Air filter is blocked.
2. PCV valve is blocked.
3. EFI system fails.
ECU fails.
High High Bad idle speed Pressure regulator of fuel oil is out of order.
(Black smoke exhausts) Water temperature sensor does not work.
Suction pressure/temperature sensor fails.
Injector fails.
The throttle position sensor fails.

Section 2 Removal of the Engine Assembly from the Vehicle


1. Avoid petrol overflowing (Disconnect from the fuel tank).
2. Remove the front wheel.
3. Discharge the coolant completely.
4. Remove the air filter assembly with hose (see Figure 1-5).
(1) Disconnect the joint of the temperature sensor and the wire
plug.
(2) Disconnect the vent duct from the hose of the air filter.
(3) Release the wire clip bolt on the air filter.
(4) Disconnect the hose of the air filter from the throttle body.
(5) Remove 3 bolts and the air filter assemblies.
5. Remove the battery.
6. Remove the fuel pipe sub-assembly. Figure 1-5
7. Disconnect the water pipe; disconnect the water outlet pipe of the
heater from the air conditioner pipe.
8. Release the nut and remove the accelerator control cable.
3-6 Engine Assembly - Removal of the Engine Assembly from the Vehicle

9. Remove the oil tank assembly of the power steering pump (with power steering).
10. Remove the radiator assembly.
11. Disconnect the harness.
12. Disengage the steering column assembly.

13. Disengage No.2 steering countershaft assembly (see Figure 1-6).


Remove the cover sheet of the steering column on the car body.
14. Remove the exhaust pipe assembly in the front.
15. Remove the nut on the front hub (Parts on the other side are
Mark
disassembled in the same way).
16. Disconnect the speed sensor on the front wheel (with ABS).
17. Disengage the ball assembly of the steering tie rod.
18. Disengage the front suspension arm sub-assembly.
Figure 1-6

19. Disengage the front drive shaft assembly (see Figure 1-7).
20. Disengage the front drive shaft from the hub with a plastic
hammer.
21. Disconnect the shift cable or the tie-rod assembly of the
transmission.
22. Disconnect the clutch wheel cylinder assembly or the clutch
cable (M/T).
Figure 1-7

23. Remove the engine assembly together with the drive bridge:
(1) Hoist the engine a bit with lifting equipment;
(2) Remove 2 bolts, and disengage the right support of the engine
(see Figure 1-8);
(3) Remove 2 bolts, and disengage the left support of the engine;
(4) Remove one bolt, 3 nuts and disengage the rear support of the
engine;
(5) Remove the engine together with the drive bridge and place
Figure 1-8
them on the floor;
(6) Lift the body.
Engine Assembly - Drive Belt Replacement 3-7

Section 3 Drive Belt Replacement

1. Remove the V-belt of the generator (see Figure 1-9).


(1) Release bolts A and B.
(2) Release the bolt C and remove the V-belt.

2. Remove the V-belt (from the air conditioner compressor to the


Figure 1-9
crankshaft sheave (see Figure 1-10).
(1) Release the nut A.
(2) Release the bolt B, and remove the V-belt.
3. Remove the belt of the water pump.
Release bolts A and B, and remove V-belt.
4. Mount the V-belt of the water pump.
Mount the V-belt on the sheave briefly.

Figure 1-10

5. Adjust the V-belt of the steering pump (see Figure 1-11).


(1) Adjust the tension of the power steering belt, and fasten the
bolt B.
(2) Fasten the bolt A.
Torque: 39N.m

Figure 1-11

6. Mount No.1 V-belt (from the air conditioner compressor to the crankshaft sheave). (See Figure 1-10).
7. Adjust No.1 V-belt (from the air conditioner compressor to the crankshaft sheave).
(1) Adjust the tension of the belt of the air conditioner by fastening the bolt B.
(2) Fasten the nut A. Torque: 39N.m.
8. Mount the V-belt of the generator (see Figure 1-9).
9. Adjust the V-belt of the generator.
Fasten the bolt A, and then the bolt B.
Torque: 18N.m for bolt A, 58N.m for bolt B.
10. Check distortion and tension of the driving belt.
3-8 Engine Mechanical - Engine Components

Chapter 2 Engine Mechanical


Section 1 Engine Components
Component View

Air filter assembly with hose

Accelerator control cable assemble


Water inlet pipe of heater
Water outlet pipe of heater
Fuel oil sub-assembly

Upside of radiator support

Transmission control cable assembly

Clutch release assembly Transmission control cable assembly


Engine cover lock assembly
Water inlet pipe of radiator

Water outlet pipe of radiator

Starter assembly

Output pipe of oil cooler


Radiator assembly Battery
Input pipe of oil cooler
Suitable for 1.5L/1.6L(Tight coupling)

Suitable for 1.3L/1.5L(Non-tight coupling)

Figure 2-1
Engine Mechanical - Engine Components 3-9

Component View

V-belt of fan and generator


V-belt of vane pump (with power
steering mechanism)

No.1 V-belt

Separator of the right


engine support

Glove case door


assembly
Steering column
assembly
Steering
column
Mounting support of the left engine
cover

Left front speed sensor (with ABS)

Left nut on the front hub

Left front drive shaft assembly

Front exhaust pipe assembly Washer

Washer

: Non-reusable parts

Figure 2-2
3-10 Engine Mechanical - Engine Components

Component View
Fuel oil pipe subassembly

Fuel oil pipe clip Secondary wire


Vent duct

O-ring
Fastener of
No.1 Injector
injector Hex. flange
Washer
O-ring bolt M6¡Á50
Suction manifold
Throttle assembly

Ignition coil
Washer Ignition coil
adjusting support installation bracket
with power steering
Vane pump assembly with
power steering Bolt M8¡Á31

Pump support with Bypass hose


power steering

Water inlet pipe housing


Knock sensor

Water temperature sensor


Rear end housing

Crankshaft position sensor Water outlet


pipe housing
No.1 heat shield of
exhaust manifold

Oil filter assembly


Washer

Exhaust manifold

Support of exhaust
manifold

Generator assembly

No.1 support of compressor

Air conditioner compressor

Figure 2-3
Engine Mechanical - Engine Components 3-11

Component View

Secondary wire
Air filter assembly with hose

Vent duct

Gasket

Cylinder head

Support of the right engine

Washer
V-belt of vane pump with Washer of the cylinder head
power steering

V-belt of fan and generator


No.1 V-belt

No.3 Timing belt hood

Timing belt
Fan sheave

No.2 Timing belt hood

Timing belt guide pulley

No.1 Timing belt hood


Crankshaft
sheave Generator assembly

: Non-reusable parts

Figure 2-4
3-12 Engine Mechanical - Throttle Body

Section 2 Throttle Body


Component View

Accelerator cable

Washer

Throttle body

Bypass hose Throttle position sensor

Air filter case with pipe

Vent duct

Seal

Idle control valve assembly

: Non-reusable parts

Figure 2-5
Engine Mechanical - Throttle Body 3-13

Dismounting/mounting and disassembly and assembly (see Figure 2-1~2-5).


1. Drain the coolant.
Warning: Do not remove the radiator cover, liquid under pressure or steam (likely to eject) while the engine
and the radiator are still hot in order to avoid scalding.
(1) Remove the radiator cover.
(2) Remove the plug of the radiator, and discharge the coolant.
2. Remove the cable of the accelerator.
Release the nut and remove the cable of the accelerator.
3. Remove the air filter hood with hose.
(1) Disconnect the connector and the wire fastening device of the suction temperature sensor.
(2) Disconnect the vent duct from the air filter hose.
(3) Release the clamping collar bolt of the air filter hose.
(4) Release 2 clamps on the air filter hood.
(5) Disconnect the air filter hose from the throttle body, and remove the air filter hood together with the hose.
4. Remove the throttle body assembly (see Fig. 2-6).
(1) Disconnect the connector of the throttle position sensor.
(2) Disconnect the connector of ISC valve.

(3) Remove 2 bolts and 2 nuts, and remove the throttle body from
the suction manifold (see Fig. 2-7).

Figure 2-6

(4) Disconnect 2 bypass hoses, remove and check the throttle


body (see Fig. 2-8).
Check:
a. Check whether the throttle shaft shakes.
b. Check whether there is any block at each state.
c. Check whether the throttle can open and close smoothly.
d. Check whether there is a gap between the check screw and the
rod of the throttle when the throttle is at CLOSE position.
Figure 2-7
Attention:
Do not adjust the check screw of the throttle.
If the operation deviates from specifications, replace the
throttle.
(5) Remove the washer of the throttle body. Coolant Bypass Pipe
5. Dismantle throttle body idle speed control valve assembly.
Detach 4 screws, idle speed control valve and washer.
6. Detach throttle position sensor
Detach 2 screws and throttle position sensor. Figure 2-8
3-14 Engine Machinery - Valve Clearance Adjustment

Section 3 Valve Clearance Adjustment

Adjust the throttle gap (see Figure 2-9).


Calculate the thickness of new washer to allow the
Camshaft Top Up
gap of the exhaust valve to reach a specified value.
N=T+(A-0.2mm)
Note: where,
N -- Thickness of new washer
Vehicle Front
T -- Thickness of the washer removed
Notch
A -- Measured throttle gap
Calculation formula of the suction valve is: N= T+(A-0.3mm). Figure 2-9

(1) Remove the adjusting washer.


a. Rotate the crankshaft until the top of the cam is upwards.
b. The nick of the valve tappet faces toward the front.
c. Press the valve tappet down with a special tool, and place
the tool between the camshaft and the valve tappet (see
Figure 2-10).
Tip:
Place one end, with a mark "9", of the special tool to the position
shown in Figure 1-24 a bit aslant.
If the special tool (B) is put into a deep position too much, it will
be clipped by the washer. In order to avoid the special tool (B) being Notch

too hard to take out, put it into slowly by decreasing the inclination Figure 2-10

angle from the suction side.


It is difficult for the special tool (B) to insert due to the shape
No.3 Cylinder back side
of the cam when inserting it from the suction side to the back side of
No.3 cylinder (see Figure 2-10). When adjusting the washer, therefore,
it is advisable to insert from the exhaust side.
d. Press the valve tappet down alternately with the special tool
(A) and (B) to check the throttle gap.

Notch
(2) Re-mount the adjusting washer.
a. Mount a new adjusting washer on the valve tappet. Figure 2-11

b. Press the valve tappet down with the special tool (A), and
remove the special tool (B).
c. Re-check the throttle gap.
Fuel System - Check Fuel System Pressure 3-15

Chapter 3 Fuel System


Section 1 Check Fuel System Pressure
On-board inspection
1. Check the operation of the fuel pump.
(1) Connect the positive and the negative of the battery to
appropriate connector sockets of the fuel pump (see Figure 3-1).
Attention: Do not start the engine.
If there is pressure present, you will hear that the fuel is flowing.
If there is no pressure present, check the fusible cutout, fuse, EFI
open-circuit relay, fuel pump, ECM (Electronic Control Module) and
circuit joint. Battery
(2) Turn the ignition switch to "OFF". Figure 3-1
2. Check the pressure of the fuel.
(1) Check whether the battery voltage is more than 12V. T conector
(2) Disconnect the negative wiring cable from the battery.
(3) Mount a pressure gauge on the fuel input pipe
Hose
(see Figure 3-2).
Hose
(4) Connect the negative terminal of the battery.
(5) Measure the fuel pressure.
Fuel oil pressure: 265-304kPa
If the pressure is low, check the fuel pipe and connection, Fuel Inlet Pipe
fuel pump, and fuel filter. If the pressure is too high,
replace the regulator.
Fuel Pipe
(6) Start the engine. Measure the fuel pressure at idle speed. The Conector
fuel pressure is 265-304KPa. If the pressure is unsatisfactory, check
Figure 3-2
the fuel pump, pressure regulator, and injector, and replace if necessary.
(7) After shutting down the engine, check the fuel pressure and
keep the specified pressure for about 5 minutes. The fuel pressure is:
147KPa.
3. The fuel oil pressure regulator (DR) (see Figure 3-3).
Mounting position: On the distributing pipe for fuel.
Faults: Too low or too high fuel pressure, or hard to start.
General causes: Using poor fuel for a long time results in: 1.
strainer blocked; 2. serious leakage caused by particles and impurities. Figure 3-3
Other reasons: Man-made mechanical damage, etc.
Maintenance precautions: During maintenance: 1. Never impact the diaphragm element with high pressure
gas; 2. Never clean it with aggressively corrosive liquid; 3. No distortion caused by external force.
Easy measuring method: For the system with oil return, connect a pressure gauge for the fuel on the suction
pipe, start the engine, and run at idle speed. Now, the fuel pressure in the engine should be about 260KPa; pull out
the vacuum pipe of the fuel pressure regulator, and the pressure should be 300KPa approximately.
3-16 Fuel System - Fuel Pump Inspection

Section 2 Fuel Pump Inspection


1. Fuel pump
(1) Check whether the resistance of the fuel pump is 0.2~3.0 ohm¸ at 20°C. If not, replace the fuel pump (see Figure
3-4).
(2) Fuel oil pump running:
Switch on the fuel pump with a battery and check. If the operation is unsatisfactory, replace the fuel pump or
wires (see Figure 3-5).
The test should be done within 10s to protect the coil from burning out.
2. Fuel injector assembly
Oil injecting quantity: 40~50cm3/s.
Tolerance of each injector: not more than 10 cm3.
If the fuel injecting quantity is not up to the specification, replace the injector.
Check leakage: Under above conditions, disconnect the wire from the battery, the fuel should not drip one per
minute.

Ohm
meter

Battery

Figure 3-4 Figure 3-5


Fuel System - Fuel Pump Replacement 3-17

Section 3 Fuel Pump Replacement


Component View

Fuel tank cap

Fuel oil hose

Fuel pump with fuel sensor as-


sembly

O-ring
Fuel return hose

Fuel tank assembly

Figure 3-6

Replace
1. Operations avoiding petrol overflowing.
2. Disconnect the fuel oil hose from the oil tank.
3. Disconnect the oil return hose from the oil tank.
4. Disconnect the vapor discharge pipe from the oil tank.
5. Remove the fuel oil pump assembly with a filter (see Figure 3-7)
Loosen the oil tank cap with a tailored tool. Take care not to bend
the arm of the oil quantity sensor when taking the fuel oil pump out Figure 3-7

snap ring
6. Mount the fuel oil pump assembly (see Figure 3-8).Replace the
sealing ring. Align the boss on the oil pump with the nick on the oil
tank port; tighten the oil tank cap with special tool.
Torque: 40N.m
7. Mount the vapor discharge pipe.
(1) Mount the oil return hose;
(2) Mount the fuel oil hose; Figure 3-8
(3) Check leakage of the fuel oil.
3-18 Fuel System - Fuel Emission Control System

Section 4 Fuel Emission Control System


On-board Inspection
1. Check the operation when disconnecting the fuel supply.
(1) Warm the engine up to 2,500r/min at least, and check the noise of the injector with a sound level meter (see
Figure 3-9).
(2) When the throttle releases, the noise from the injector should stop immediately; repeat several times.
2. Check the fuel vapor discharge control system (see Figure 3-10).
(1) After starting the engine, disconnect the vacuum pipe.
(2) Make sure that there is vacuum present at the canister control valve (TEV) port when selecting ”ACTIVE
TEST" and "PURGE TEV" based on the display on the fault diagnosis instrument.
(3) After "ACTIVE TEST", connect the vacuum pipe.
(4) Carry out "ECM DATA MONITOR" on the fault diagnosis instrument, and then select "PURGE TEV"
for operation inspection.
(5) Start up the car after the engine warms up, and make sure the TEV ON from OFF (see Figure 3-11).
3. Check whether there is any distortion or damage on the filling cap and the washer (see Figure 3-12).

Sound level meter

Figure 3-9 Figure 3-10

Gasket

Figure 3-11 Figure 3-12


Fuel System - Carbon Canister Replacement 3-19

Section 5 Carbon Canister Replacement

1. Check and replace the canister.


(1) Check for crack or damage on the canister visually (see Figure 3-13).
(2) Check the operation of the canister.
a. Plug the discharge port (see Figure 3-14).
b. Blow air (4.71KPa, 48kgf/cm 2) into the absorption port when keeping the discharge port closed, and the
air should flow out from the exit port.
If the operation is unsatisfactory, replace the canister.
c.Blow air into the absorption port, the air should flow from other ports without any resistance.
If the operation is unsatisfactory, replace the canister.
(3) Clean the canister: Block the desorption port, blow air (4.71KPa, 48kgf/cm2) into the absorption port, and
the air should flow from the discharge port (see Figure 3-15).

Absorption port
Absorption port
Discharge port
Discharge port

Exit port
Exit port

Plug up

Figure 3-13 Figure 3-14 Figure 3-15

2. Canister control valve (TEV) (see Figure 3-16)


Mounting position: On the vacuum pipeline of the canister - suction manifold.
Faults: Bad idle speed, malfunction, etc.
General cause: Ingress of foreign materials into inside of the valve results in corrosion and Poor tightness.
Maintenance precautions: During maintenance:
1. Air flowing direction must conform to specifications;
2. If the control valve fails due to black particles in the valve body, and it is necessary to replace the control
valve, please check the condition of the canister;
3. Avoid liquid such as water and oil entering into the valve during maintaining as possible;
4. It is advisable to mount the canister control valve on the hose hanging in the air or fasten with soft rubber
to avoid transmission of solid borne noise.
3-20 Fuel System - Carbon Canister Replacement

Easy measuring method: (disconnect the connector) Set the digital multi-meter to ohm position, with two leads
connecting to two pins of the canister control valve respectively, rated resistance 22-30 ohm at 20°C

Figure 3-16

3. Vent valve (PCV) sub-assembly


Air should flow through the cylinder cap side freely.
Attention:
Do not suction air through the valve.
Never put anything into the valve. If the operation is unsatisfactory, replace PCV.
Blow air into from the suction side, and the air should be hard to flow through. If the operation is
unsatisfactory, replace PCV (see Figure 3-17).

Cylinder head side Manifold side

Cleaning pipe

Easy Hard

Figure 3-17
Exhaust System - Exhaust System 3-21

Chapter IV Exhaust System


Component View

Suitable for 1.5L/1.6L(Tight coupling)

Center Muffer
Front Muffer

Rear Muffer
Rear Rubber
Bracket
Three-way Catalytic Converter

Suitable for 1.3L/1.5L(Non-tight coupling)


Front Rubber Bracket

Figure 4-1

Replace
1. Remove the tail exhaust pipe assembly.
Remove 2 bolts and the tail exhaust pipe assembly.
2. Remove the middle exhaust pipe assembly.
Tail pipe side
Replace the exhaust system.
Remove 2 bolts and the middle exhaust pipe assembly.
3. Remove the front exhaust pipe assembly.
washer
Remove 2 bolts and the front exhaust pipe assembly.
4. Mount the front exhaust pipe assembly.
Measure the free length of the spring with a slide caliper.
Free length: 42mm Figure 4-2

Mount the front exhaust pipe on the exhaust manifold with new washer.
Notes:
Do not use the removed washer any more.
5. Mount the front exhaust pipe assembly.
Torque: 43N.m
6. Mount the middle exhaust pipe assembly.
Mount the middle exhaust pipe on the front exhaust pipe with new washer.
Torque: 44N.m
7. Mount the tail exhaust pipe assembly.
Mount the tail exhaust pipe on the middle exhaust pipe with new washer. (see Figure 4-2).
Torque: 43N.m
8. Check exhaust leakage.
3-22 Cooling System - System Inspection

Chapter 5 Cooling System


Section 1 System Inspection

1. Check leakage in the cooling system (see Figure 5-1).


(1) Fill coolant in the radiator, and mount the tester at the radiator Tester of radiator cap
cover port.
(2) Start the engine.
(3) Keep the pump pressure at 118KPa without drop. If the
pressure drops,check whether there is any leakage at the port,
radiator and water pump; if not, check the heating core,
cylinder and cap.
2. Check the engine coolant quantity in the compensating tank.
The coolant level should be between LOW and FULL. Figure 5-1

3. Check the coolant quality.


(1) Remove the radiator cover.
Do not remove the radiator cover when the engine and the radiator are still hot in order to avoid scalding
since the liquid vapor may inject.
(2) Check whether there are excessive deposit and rust or sundries around the radiator cover. The coolant is
not allowed to contact with oil.
(3) Remount the radiator cover.
4. Thermostat
Notes:
The temperature indicated on the thermostat is marked as open
temperature of the valve (see Figure 5-2).
(1) Submerge the thermostat into water and heat gradually.
(2) Check the open temperature of the valve.
Open temperature of the valve: 80-84°C
Figure 5-2
(3) Check the lift of the valve (see Figure 5-3 and Figure 5-4).
Lift of the valve: 8mm or more at 95°C

8.0mm or more

Figure 5-3 Figure 5-4

(4) When the thermostat is at low temperature (lower than 77°C), the valve should close completely.
Cooling System - System Inspection 3-23

5. Fan
(1) At low temperature (lower than 83°C), check the operation of
the cooling fan.
a. The ignition switch is set to ON.
b. The cooling fan should stop.
c. Disconnect the connector of the water temperature sensor.
disconnect
(see Figure 5-5)
d.Touch the ground with a wire. Figure 5-5
e.Check if the cooling fan rotates.
f. Re-connect the connector of the water temperature sensor.

Above 93°C
(2) At high temperature (more than 93°C), check the operation of
the fan (see Figure 5-6).
a. Start the engine, and enable the coolant temperature higher
than 93°C.
b.Check whether the cooling fan rotates.
If not, replace the water temperature switch.

Figure 5-6

(3) Check the cooling fan (see Figure 5-7). Amper meter
a. Disconnect the joint of the cooling fan.
b. Connect the battery and the ammeter with the connector.
c. The cooling fan should rotate stably and check the current
readings.
Standard current: 5.7-7.7A. Battery

d. Connect the connector of the cooling fan.


Figure 5-7
3-24 Cooling System - Radiator Replacement

Section 2 Radiator Replacement

1. Replace the radiator.


(1) Open the radiator cover.
(2) Open the water drain valve and discharge the coolant.
(3) Disconnect the water inlet pipe of the radiator.
(4) Disconnect the water outlet pipe of the radiator.
(5) Disconnect the input pipe of the oil cooler of the automatic transmission (automatic transmission).
(6) Disconnect the output pipe of the oil cooler of the automatic transmission (automatic transmission).
(7) Remove 4 bolts of the radiator mounting support (see Figure 5-8).

Figure 5-8

(8)Remove the radiator assembly, remove 4 bolts, and separate


the fan and the fan housing (see Figure 5-9).

Figure 5-9

(9) Mount the cooling fan assembly.


a. Secure the compensating tank assembly on the cooling fan support with bolts; torque: 16 N.m.
b. Mount the fan and the fan housing with 3 bolts; torque: 7.5N.m.
c. Mount the cooling fan assembly on the radiator assembly with 3 bolts; torque: 16N.m.
d. Connect the overflow pipe on the compensating tank assembly and the radiator assembly, and fasten
with the elastic ring.
e. Mount the radiator assembly in the reverse order of dismounting.
Manual Transaxle Assembly - Frequent Pr oblem Diagnosis 3-25

Chapter 6 Manual Transaxle Assembly


Section 1 Frequent Problem Diagnosis
Component View

Engine hood
Battery support

Battery
fixing bar
Battery

Control cable of
transmission
Harness of starter
Starter assembly Clamp
Starter Connector
Clamp
Bottom board
Washer
Clutch Connector of
Cylinder odometer sensor

Right front Rear Engine


drive shaft Vibration Absorber
assembly
Snap ring Rear support of
engine

Washer
5 Spead Manual Transmission
Drain Plug
(JL-S160/S160A)
Left front
Back-up lamp drive shaft Ball tie-rod
Filling plug
Connector Snap ring

Washer Clamp

Left support of engine Hub nut

Cotter pin

: Non-reusable parts

erugif 6-1
3-26 Manual Transaxle Assembly - Vehicle Speed Sensor Replacement

Table 6-1 Frequent problem diagnosis

Sympton Possible causes


Transmission or the engine is suspended loosely or damaged;
Axial gap is improper;
Vibration and noise Gear or bearing is worn or damaged;
Unsatisfactory transmission oil is used or oil level is low;
Engine idle is incorrect.
Oil leakage of the transmission The oil seal or the O-ring is damaged.
The control cable is unqualified;
Synchronizer is poorly contacted with gear or worn;
Hard to shift
Elasticity of the synchronous spring is insufficient;
Unqualified transmission oil is used.
Fork of the shift gear is worn or lifting spring is broken;
Trip stop Gap between the synchronizer bush and the sleeve spline is too large;
Gear or bearing is worn or damaged.

Section 2 Vehicle Speed Sensor Replacement


1. Disengage the vehicle speed sensor (see Figure 6-2).
2. Remove the bolt and the vehicle speed sensor.

Figure 6-2

3. Mount the vehicle speed sensor (see Figure 6-3).

Figure 6-3
4. Connect the vehicle speed sensor.
Manual Transaxle Assembly - Manual Transaxle Replacement 3-27

Section 3 Manual Transaxle Replacement

Replace
1. Open the engine cover.
2. Remove the battery.
3. Remove the clutch wheel cylinder assembly (see Figure 6-4).
4. Separate the transmission shift cable assembly (see Figure 6-5).
5. Disengage the joint of the backup lamp switch.
6. Disengage the speed sensor.
Disengage the speed sensor joint.
7. Remove the forepart of the exhaust pipe.
8. Discharge the drive bridge oil.
9. Remove the nut on the left and the right front hub.
Figure 6-4
10. Disengage the speed sensor on the left and the right front wheel
(ABS).
11. Disengage the front stabilizer bar.
12. Disengage the left and the right ball tie-rod.
13. Disengage the front stabilizer bar.
14. Disengage the left and the right lower cantilever.
15. Remove the left and the right front drive shaft assembly.
16. Hoist the engine from the machinery space according to "Point
24, Section 2, Chapter 1".
17. Remove the starter assembly. Figure 6-5

18. Disengage the engine support.


19. Remove the manual drive bridge assembly.
20. Mount the engine support.
21. Mount the manual drive bridge assembly.
22. Couple the vibration insulating pad of the engine.
23. Mount the starter assembly.
24. Mount the left and the right front drive shaft assembly.
25. Connect the left and the right lower cantilever.
26. Connect the left and the right ball tie-rod.
27. Connect the front stabilizer bar.
28. Connect the left and the right front speed sensor (ABS).
29. Mount the left and the right front shaft nut.
30. Mount the fore part of the exhaust pipe.
31. Connect the joint of the odometer sensor.
32. Connect the joint of the back-up lamp switch.
33. Connect the transmission shift cable assembly (see Figure 6-5).
34. Mount the clutch wheel cylinder assembly (see Figure 6-4).
3-28 Manual Transaxle Assembly - Transmission/Transaxle Case Oil Seal Replacement

Section 4 Transmission/Transaxle Case Oil Seal Replacement

I. Replace the oil seal of transmission housing


1. Remove the oil seal of the transmission housing (see Figure 6-6).

2. Mount the oil seal of the transmission housing (see Figure 6-7).
Figure 6-6
Attention:
Take care not to damage the lip surface of the oil seal.

Figure 6-7

II. Replace the Oil Seal of the Drive Bridge Housing


1. Remove the oil seal of the transaxle housing with special
maintenance tool (see Figure 6-8).

Figure 6-8

2. Mount the oil seal of the transaxle housing (see Figure 6-9).

Figure 6-9
Automatic Transaxle Assembly - Frequent Problems Diagnosis 3-29

Chapter 7 Automatic Transaxle Assembly


Section 1 Frequent Problems Diagnosis
Possible Cause
1. There is no scan information.
(1)The diagnosis system fails.
(2)The automatic transmission unit fails.
2. The engine can't start.
(1)The engine system fails.
(2)The fuel pump or torque meter fails.
3. The vehicle cant' runs forwards.
(1)The circuit voltage is improper.
(2)The rear clutch or single clutch fails.
(3)The valve fails.
4. The vehicle can't run backwards.
(1)The low speed brake or front clutch pressure is improper.
(2)The front clutch or low speed reverse gear fails.
(3)The valve fails.
5. The vehicle can't runs forwards or backwards.
(1)The pressure deduction is improper or the transmission signal fails.
(2)There is pressure in the oil pump or the valve body fails.
6. The engine stalls in gear shift.
(1)The engine system or clutch torque meter fails.
(2)The valve body or torque meter fails.
7. The vehicle vibrates and lasts for a long time when the gear is shifted from N to D.
(1)The rear clutch fails.
(2)The valve body clutch fails.
(3)The restrictor switch fails.
8. The vehicle vibrates and lasts for a long time when the gear is shifted from N to R.
(1)The front clutch pressure fails.
(2)The front clutch or valve body fails.
(3)The low speed reserve gear pressure or low speed reverse gear fails.
9. The vehicle vibrates and lasts for a long time when the gear is shifted from N to D/R.
(1)The pressure reduction fails.
(2)The oil pump fails.
(3)The valve body fails.
10. The gear shift impacts.
(1)The servo switch or restrictor position switch fails.
(2)The pressure is decreases abnormally.
(3)The clutch or brake fails.
11. All gear shift points are either too early or too late in the running status.
3-30 Automatic Transaxle Assembly - Hydraulic Torque Converter and Transaxle

The valve body fails.


12. The vehicle shifts before or after some gear points in the running status.
The vehicle switch or parking switch fails.
13. The vehicle has poor acceleration in running.
(1)The clutch or brake fails.
(2)The engine system fails.
14. The vehicle vibrates when it runs at a constant speed or accelerating speed.
(1)The hydraulic torque clutch pressure or hydraulic torque meter fails.
(2)The engine system or valve fails.
15. The acceleration switch system fails.
(1)The acceleration switch or ignition switch fails.
(2)The connector or automatic transmission control unit fails.

Section 2 Hydraulic Torque Converter and Transaxle


I. Automatic transmissions Removal
1. Put the select lever in "N" position
2. Remove 3 bolts of the flexibility plate (engine side)
3. Remove starter and 2 cooling hoses.
4. Disconnect neutral switch connector and odometer sensor.
5. Loosen the drain screw under the housing to bleed ATF and tighten the drain screw with sealing glue when
assembling. Tightening torque is 29~35N.m
6. Loosen the locking bolt for select lever cable.
7. Remove Drive Shaft LH&RH, using plastic stopper in the oil sealing of differential.
8. Detach suspension bolts.
9. Separate transmission from engine after bolts between engine and transmission remove.

II. Automatic Transmission Installation


1. Check whether torque converter of the transmission is in the right position, the methods as follows:
Check whether the distance from 3 anchor point of torque converter to front contact face of the transmission
box A 28mm , If the space A<28 mm, try install again. The way to install is that left hand catch hold of the
central anchor column of the converter and make it in alignment with input shaft as near as possible, push the torque
converter in rotating way by right hand until it gets to the bottom to meet the requirement of A 28 mm. (See
figure 7-1 and 2)
2. Install Flexibility plate and central plate on the crankshaft end face with 6 bolts in the direction of Figure 2.
Tightening torque is 45~55 N.m. Turn the longer hole of the Flexibility plate to the lowest of the engine position
in order to connect torque converter.
Automatic Transaxle Assembly - Hydraulic Torque Converter and Transaxle 3-31

Flexible plate
Front contact face Central
plate
Torque converter
anchor point Torque converter
housing end

Torque
converter

Central anchor col-


umn

Figure 7-1 Figure 7-2

3. Install transmission in the engine, its way like manual transmission. The torque converter cannot be allowed to
move in axial motion during operating (The dimension of A keeps constant). Install starter in the transmission
housing.
4. Connect Flexibility plate with torque converter, using 3 special bolts. The way is as follows. First, assemble one
bolt in the torque converter by the longer hole of the Flexibility plate, and then rotate engine belt pulley to install
the other bolts, finally use torque spanner to tighten the bolts. Tightening torque is 40~50N.m.
5. Install suspension bolt and drive shaft LH&RH, the assembling way like manual transmission.
6. Connect two cooling pipes as showed in the figure 7-3 with the corresponding pipe of transmission with clip.
7. Connect the cable between bracket of throttle and transmission actuator.
8. Throttle valve cable adjustment as follows:
First, use pliers to clip the hexangular position under throttle valve cable.Turn 60°~90°counterclockwise,
and lift throttle valve cable to make throttle valve cable adjustable move to top position, and then turn back
60°~90° clockwise, meanwhile, make it lock (See figure 7-4). Finally put accelerator pedal to end position.
When throttle valve makes "ka-ka" sound, the distance under the throttle valve should meet B=2~8mm. If not,
try again until the gap B=2~8mm under the throttle valve (see figure 7-5), if gap B=2-8mm, throttle valve cable
adjustment is finished.

Figure 7-4

Figure 7-3 Figure 7-5


3-32 Automatic Transaxle Assembly - Hydraulic Torque Converter and Transaxle

9. Put shift lever to "N" position, meanwhile, adjust the shift fork in
neutral position. Connect shift cable with bracket and fix by fastening
bolt. The tightening torque is 6.9~13.7 N.m (See figure 7-6).
10. Connect neutral switch connector.
11. Install odometer sensor (connect the sensor with the actuator of
odometer in the transmission)
12. Fill in ATF. Figure 7-6
"ATF " is the oil only for automatic transmission, its grade is DEXRONII or DEXRONIII. First, take
dipstick out of automatic transmission and fill in 3 liter ATF from dipstick pipe. Put select lever to "P" position
and start engine until AT temperature is up to 80°C, and then put select lever in "P" "R" "N" "D"
"2" "L" and "L" "2" "D" "N" "R" "P" step by step. Insert and take out dipstick,
wipe out the liquid in the dipstick. Repeat above-mentioned procedure without wiping to check oil level by
dipstick. If oil level is between the third and fourth hole in the dipstick, the level is normal. Filling in oil is over
and Insert dipstick tightly.
13. Wipe ATF in the A/T surface when filling.
14. A/T installation is completed.

III. Automatic Transmission Assembly JL-Z110 and JL-Z130

Central Plate

Throttle cable
Dipsitick

Flexible Plate Set

Install in the engine

Filling
Pipe

Hydraulic Torque
Corverter

Fluid Pan

Figure 7-7
Automatic Transaxle Assembly - Differential Front Oil Seal (ATM) 3-33

1. Check the hydraulic torque converter assembly.


(1)Measure the status of the hydraulic torque converter.
(2)Replace the ATF in the hydraulic torque converter.
(3)Wash and check oil freezer and oil pipe.
(4)Prevent the hydraulic torque converter being deformed and
the oil pump gear being damaged.
2. Check the drive disc and gear ring.
(1)Install a dial test indicator to measure the runout of the drive
disc. (See Fig.7-8)
Figure 7-8
(2)Check the damage of the gear ring.
Maximum runout: 0.25mm
If the runout is beyond the specified scope or the gear ring is
damaged, replace the drive disc.
Torque: 64N.m
3. Check the hydraulic torque converter. (See Fig.7-9)
Install the hydraulic torque converter on the drive disc temporarily,
and install a test indicator to measure the radial runout of the
hydraulic torque converter bushing.
Maximum radial runout: 0.20mm
If the radial runout is beyond the specified scope, readjust the
direction of installation.
Notes: Figure 7-9

Mark the position of the torque converter to install it properly.


Remove the hydraulic torque converter.

Section 3 Differential Front Oil Seal (ATM)

Replacement
1. Discharge the automatic transmission oil.
(1) Remove the discharge plug and washer to discharge the ATF oil.
(2) Install the discharge plug and new washer.
Torque: 25N.m
2. Remove the front wheel.
3. Remove the left/right front wheel hub nuts.
4. Unfix the front stabilizer bar.
5. Unfix #1 left/ring front suspension sub-assembly.
6. Unfix the left/right ball extension rod sub-assembly.
7. Unfix the left/right front axles.
8. Remove the differential front oil seal (on the transaxle housing).
3-34 Automatic Transaxle Assembly - Differential Front Oil Seal (ATM)

9. Pull out oil seal (on the transaxle housing) with a special tool.
(See Fig.7-10)

Figure 7-10
10. Remove the differential front oil seal on the transmission housing.
Pull out the oil seal on the transmission housing with a special
tool. (See Fig.7-11)

11. Install the differential front oil seal onto the transmission housing. Figure 7-11
(1) Install a new oil seal on the transmission housing with a
special tool and hammer. (See Fig.7-12)
(2) Apply MP lube on the flange of the oil seal.

12. Install the differential front oil seal onto the transmission housing. Figure 7-12

(1) Install a new oil seal onto the transmission housing with a
special tool and hammer. (See Fig.7-13)
(2) Apply MP lube on the flange of the oil seal.

Figure 7-13

13. Install all parts in the sequence of removal till the front wheel is installed, and then add transmission oil.
14. Check and adjust the alignment of the front wheel.
Automatic Transaxle Assembly - Neutral Switch Assembly 3-35

Section 4 Neutral Switch Assembly


Replacement
1. Remove the lower engine mud baffle assembly.
2. Disconnect shift cable.
(1) Detach the bolt and remove shift cable from the rocker arm.

(2) Detach E-shaped clip to remove shift cable from the rocker
arm.

3. Detach neutral switch assembly.


(1) Remove the connector from neutral switch.
(2) Loosen nut and rocker arm.
(3) Detach bolt to separate neutral switch.

4. Install neutral switch.


(1) Install neutral switch to the manual valve axle.
(2) Install bolt temporarily.
(3) Install neutral switch temporarily.
3-36 Automatic Transaxle Assembly - Neutral Switch Assembly

(4) Turn the rocker arm to the end counterclockwise and rotate 2
teeth clockwise.

(5) Make the position of neutral switch parallel to the basic


central line of neutral switch with a straight rule. Neutral Referenc
(6) Keep this position and tighten the bolt. line

(7) Tighten the shift rocker arm.


(8) Connect the harness of neutral switch.

5. Install transmission cable


(1) Put shift lever to "P" position, meanwhile, make neutral
switch at "P" position.
(2) Use a new E-shaped clip to fix shift cable on the bracket.

(3) Tighten the nut in the front of shift cable.


Torque: 6.9 ~ 13.7 N.m

6. Check and adjust neutral switch. The display should be clear and
correct.
7. Install the lower engine mud baffle.
Chassis - Transmission Control 4-1

Part IV Chassis
Chapter 1 Transmission Control
Section 1 Introduction of Transmission Control
I. Description on Transmission Control
This model is equipped with cable Transmission Controls, respectively used for 1.3L, 1.5L and 1.6L engine. Their
gears are: 5 forward gears + 1 reverse gear.

II. Symptom Table


Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the likely cause
of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.

Symptom Suspected Area


1. Transmission Control selector (position changing) cable
(improperly assembled)
Transmission out of gear 2. Cable or shift lever (worn)
3. Cable assembly (incorrect)
4. Transmission (faulty)
1. Transmission control selector (position changing ) cable
(improperly assembled)
Transmission shift difficult 2. Cable or shift lever (worn)
3. Cable assembly (incorrect)
4. Transmission (faulty)
4-2 Transmission Control - Introduction of Transmission Control

Component View

Floor gear shift lever handle

Control box
Gear shift lever shield decoration cover

E Clip E Clip Control


box hole

Floor storage box

Control box
rear part

12.0
Clip

Speed changer control cable


#
1 gear shift cable retainer

Clip
Snap Clip

5.0
Floor gear shift
12.0 Shift Bracket lever assembly
Clip
Washer

Washer Clip

Shift Bracket

N•m : Specified torque

: Non-reusable parts
Transmission Control - Cable Type Transmission Control 4-3

Section 2 Cable Type Transmission Control


Replacement
1. Remove the upper cover in dashboard panel.
2. Remove the lower cover in dashboard panel.
3. Remove the cup-holder in the middle console.
4. Loosen transmission control cover.
5. Remove the handle of the gear shift lever.
6. Remove the middle console body.
7. Remove the control cables assembly of the transmission.
(1) Remove the two cotter pins and unfix the head of the control
cables of the transmission (see the right figure).

(2) Remove the control cables assembly after loosening the shift
bracket with bolts.

(3) Remove the two cotter pins and two washers, and then unfix
the two control cables from the manual transmission.
(4) Remove the two spring clips and unfix the two control cables
from the bracket.

(5) Remove the bolt and unfix the control cables.

(6) Remove the two bolts.


(7) Pull the control cables out of the body.
(8) Remove the retainer from the control cables.
4-4 Transmission Control - Cable Type Transmission Control

8. Install the control cables assembly of the transmission.


(1) Install the retainer on the control cables.
(2) Push the control cables into the floor.
(3) Install the control cables assembly with two bolts.
Torque: 5.0N.m

(4) Connect the control cables assembly and fix the control cable
with bolts.
Torque: 5.0N.m

(5) Connect the ends of the two control cables, and then install
two washers and two new spring clips.
(6) Install two new spring clips on the cable bracket.

(7) Connect the control cables to gear shift lever.


Note:
Make sure the claws engage firmly.

(8) Connect the ends of the control cables to the gear shift lever
selectively, and then install the cotter pin.
Note:
When connecting the control cables, the dents of their ends
hall be made upwards.
The cotter pins are inserted in a direction as shown in the
figure.
(9) Connect the ends of the gear shift cables to the gear shift lever
assembly.
9. Install the middle console body.
10. Install the parking brake cover.
11. Install the handle of the gear shift lever.
12. Install the cup-holder.
13. Install the lower cover in dashboard panel.
14. Install the upper cover in dashboard panel.
Transmission Control - Manual Transmission Shift Mechanism 4-5

Section 3 Manual Transmission Shift Mechanism


Replacement
1. Remove the upper cover in dashboard panel.
2. Remove the lower cover in dashboard panel.
3. Remove the cup-holder in the middle console.
4. Loosen transmission control cover.
5. Remove the handle of the gear shift lever.
6. Remove the middle console body.
7. Remove the control cables assembly of the transmission.
(1) Remove the two cotter pins and unfix the head of the control
cables of the transmission

(2) Remove the spring clips and separate the control cables from
the bracket.

8. Remove the four bolts and floor gear shift lever assembly.

9. Install the floor gear shift lever assembly.


Install the floor gear shift lever assembly with four bolts.
Torque: 12N.m
4-6 Transmission Control - Manual Transmission Shift Mechanism

10. Connect the control cables assembly.


(1) Connect the control cables to floor gear shift lever assembly.
Note:
Make sure the spring clips engage firmly.

(2) Connect the ends of the control cables to the floor gear shift
lever assembly, and then install the cotter pins.
Sawcat part
Note:
When connecting the ends, the dents shall be made upwards.
The cotter pins are inserted in a direction as shown in the figure.
(3) Connect the ends of the gear shift cables to the floor gear shift
lever assembly.

11. Install the middle console body.


12. Install the parking brake cover.
13. Install the handle of the gear shift lever.
14. Install the cup-holder.
15. Install the lower cover in dashboard panel.
16. Install the upper cover in dashboard panel.
Transmission Control - Automatic Transmission Shift Mechanism 4-7

Section 4 Automatic Transmission Shift Mechanism

Component View

E Clip
Console Panel Upper
Cover Assembly

Console Panel Lower


Cover Assembly

Cup Holder

Park Brake Cover Plate

E Clip
E Clip

Key Retaining Cable

Shift Cable
12

Console Assembly

12
Automatic Shifter Assembly

Specified Torque 12
4-8 Transmission Control - Automatic Transmission Shift Mechanism

Component View

Automatic Shift Handle


Shift Lever Knob Cover
Automatic Shifter Panel
Spring
Inner Rod

Shift Lever Button

Spring

Dust-Proof Sliding Plate Gear Range Display


Handle Connecting Rod

Shift Lock Release Button

Cap Shift Lever Support

Bulb
Button Spring
Slot Pin
Gear Range Indicator
Wire Harness
Key Retaining
Cable Control
Arm

Control Shaft

Shift Lock Unit

Shift Lever Sub-Assembly

Solenoid

Shift Lock Control Arm

Precoated Part
Transmission Control - Automatic Transmission Shift Mechanism 4-9

Replacement
1. Remove CD cover
2. Remove console panel lower cover assembly
3. Remove cup holder
4. Remove console assembly
5. Remove key retaining cable.
(1) loosen the adjustment locking cap.
Tip:
Face the vehicle front and turn rotate it clockwise by 90°.
(2) Use screwdriver to remove the key retaining cable

6. Disconnect shift cable assembly


(1) Remove the nut, disconnect the shift cable from the shifter
assembly

(2) Use screwdriver to disconnect the shift cable from the shift
lever tray.

7. Remove automatic shifter assembly


(1) Remove the four bolts.
(2) Disconnect the two connectors.
(3) Remove the shifter assembly.
4-10 Transmission Control - Automatic Transmission Shift Mechanism

8. Install the automatic shifter assembly


Install it in place in the reverse order of removal.

9. Check and adjust the shift lever position


(1) Check that the starter works only when the shift lever is in P position, but doesn't work in other positions.
(2) Move the shift lever, check whether the display of the gear range indicator is consistent with the actual gear
range.
(3) Check that the key can be pulled out in P position.
(4) Except the P position, the ignition key can not be turned to LOCK position with the shift lever in other
positions.
(5) Check that when shift release button is pressed down, the shift lever can be transferred to other positions
from the P position.

10. Adjustment
(1) When moving shift lever among the positions, make sure to
move the shift lever in a stable way, operate properly and the
positive display is correct.
Gear positions able to be operated without pressing down the
knob button are:
R N D, L 2 D N
Gear positions able to be operated only when the knob button
is pressed down are:
Depress the brake pedal, press down the shift
2 L, N R P lever knob button to shift the gear position.
(2) Gear positions able to be operated only when the knob button (ignition switch must be turned ON)

is pressed down, the ignition switch is turned ON and the press the knob button to shift
the gear position
brake pedal is depressed are:
P R Normal shift

(3) Start the engine, make sure the vehicle drives ahead when the
shift lever is moved from N position to D position, and back
up when the shift lever is set to R position.
Accelerator Pedal Device - Introduction of Accelerator Pedal 4-11

Chapter 2 Accelerator Pedal Device


Section 1 Introduction of Accelerator Pedal

Component View

Accderator
Pedal Rotation Hex. flange nut
Assemloy 22~29N .m

Accelerator pedal Accelerator cable


bracket assembly
Speaial
Spring Clip

Lubrication
bushing

Accelerator cable assembly

Replacement
1. Disconnect the accelerator cables.
Loosen the accelerator cables and the bolts on the accelerator cable frame of the engine, and then disconnect
the accelerator cables from the rocker of the motor restrictor.
2. Remove the accelerator pedal.
(1)Remove the two bolts that connect the accelerator pedal and the body.
(2)Disconnect the accelerator cables.
3. Remove the accelerator cables.

4. Install the accelerator cables and accelerator pedal assembly in a reverse order.
Note:
(1)The torque of the bolt is 20~25N.m.
(2)Adjust the position of the accelerator cables properly to obtain a proper tension.
(3)Check that the acceleration runs freely and reliably.
4-12 Clutch Control System - Introduction of Clutch Centrol

Chapter 3 Clutch Control System


Section 1 Introduction of Clutch Centrol

I. Description
A hydraulic clutch control system is equipped which can be used in cars with various displacements (including
1.3L, 1.5L and1.6L).

II. Symptom Table


The table below lists the common symptoms and possible causes of the failures. The number means the
possible sequence of the causes. Check the parts, and replace the corresponding parts if necessary.
Symptom Suspected area
1. Engine fixture is loosened.
2. Clutch disc shakes seriously.
Clutch is trapped or shaken. 3. Clutch disc is contaminated by oil or wore down.
4. Torque spring of the clutch disc is damaged.
5. Clutch disc is hardened.
6. Diaphragm spring is not aligned on the top.
1. There is air in the clutch oil pipe.
Clutch pedal is loosened. 2. Cup of the master cylinder is damaged.
3. Cup of the wheel cylinder is damaged.
Abnormal noise occurs. 1. Clutch release bearing is worn out, contaminated or damaged.
2. Torque spring of the clutch disc is damaged.
1. Clutch pedal has maladjusted free stroke.
2. Clutch disc is contaminated by oil.
Clutch skids. 3. Clutch disc is worn.
4. Diaphragm spring is damaged.
5. Platen is deformed.
6. Flywheel is deformed.
1. Clutch pedal has maladjusted free stroke.
2. There is air in the clutch oil pipe.
3. Cup of the master cylinder is damaged.
4. Cup of the wheel cylinder is damaged.
Clutch can not be separated. 5. Clutch disc id deformed or wiggled.
6. Clutch disc is worn out.
7. Clutch disc is contaminated or burned out.
8. Clutch disc is contaminated by oil.
9. Clutch disc has no lube on its spline.
Clutch Control System - Clutch Pedal 4-13

Section 2 Clutch Pedal

Component View

Hydranlic clutch hose Clutch pedal bracket

ÒLÓClip 12
Clutch hose Bracket
Clip
Bolt Hex. flange nut 37

Master cylinder
Clutch pedal spring
Inlet hose
Sted Band Clamp Clutch pedal
bushing
Master cylinder
outtet pipeset
Clutch Peader Axis Absorber
Clutch pedal bushing

Clutch master cylinder cone


U-connector bushing
Clutch pedal
N•m :Specified torque Transimissin Rod
Non-reusable parts
Clutch pedal cover
Multi-function lube

Adjustment Pedal height


adjustment
1. Check and adjust the clutch pedal.
(1) Lift the carpet on the floor.
(2) Check the pedal’s height is proper.
Clutch
Pedal's height from oil felt: 134.3-144.3mm
pedal Travel
(3) Adjust the pedal's height.
Loosen the lock nut, and turn the bolt till the correct pedal's
height is reached, and then tighten the lock nut.
Torque: 16N.m
(4) Check whether the pedal's free travel and push bar travel are Push travel &
free travel adjustment Pedal height
proper. point
a. Step the pedal down till a resistance appears.
Pedal's free stroke: 5-15mm
b. Step the pedal down lightly till the resistance increase a
little.
Push bar (on the pedals top) travel: 1.0-5.0mm
(5) Adjust the pedal's free travel and push bar travel.
a. Loosen the lock nut, and turn the push bar till the pedal's
Pedal free travel
free travel and push bar travel are proper.
4-14 Clutch Control System - Clutch Pedal

b. Tighten the lock nut. 25mm or more


Torque: 12N.m
c. Check the pedal's height after adjusting the pedal's free
travel.
Separating point
(6) Check the clutch's separating point.
a. Tension the parking brake device and install a wheel Max. travel
stopper. end position

b. Start the motor and make it run idly.


c. DonÕt step the clutch pedal,and put the gear shift lever to the reverse gear slowly till the gears engage.
d. Step the clutch pedal down slowly,and measure the travel distance between the separating point to the
pedal travel end position.
Standard distance: 25mm or above (pedal travel end position to separating point)
If the distance doesn't meet standard, carry out the following steps:
Check the pedal's height.
Check the push par stroke and pedal's free travel.
Discharge the air in the clutch fluid pipe.
Check the clutch cover and clutch disc.
Check the pedal's travel.
Pedal travel: 120-130mm

Replacement
1. Remove the battery negative terminal.
2. Remove the upper cover in dashboard panel.
3. Remove the lower cover in dashboard panel.
4. Remove the pane of the control board.
5. Remove the clutch pedal spring.
6. Remove the U-connector with pin on the clutch master cylinder
push bar.
Remove the clips and pins.

7. Remove the clutch pedal bracket.


Remove the two nuts and bolts, and then remove the clutch pedal
bracket.

8. Remove the clutch pedal.


(1) Remove the bolts and nuts.
(2) Remove the clutch pedal from the clutch pedal bracket.
Clutch Control System - Clutch Pedal 4-15

9. Remove the clutch pedal gasket.


10. Remove the clutch pedal absorber.
Remove absorber from the clutch pedal.

11. Remove the clutch pedal bushing.


Remove the two bushings from the clutch pedal.

12. Remove the U-connector bushing on the clutch master cylinder's


push bar.
Remove the U-connector bushing from the clutch pedal with an
8mm hexagon wrench and hammer.

13. Install the U-connector bushing on the clutch master cylinder


push bar.
(1) Apply multi-function lube inside the new U-connector bushing.
(2) Install the U-connector bushing on the clutch pedal.
Tips: Install the U-connector bushing from the right side.

14. Install the clutch pedal bushing.


(1) Apply multi-function lube on both sides of the two new
bushings.
(2) Install the two bushings on the clutch pedal.
15. Install absorber on the clutch pedal.
Put absorber on the clutch pedal.

16. Install the clutch pedal.


Install the clutch pedal on the clutch pedal bracket with bolts and
nuts.
Torque: 37N.m
Tips: Install the bolts from the left side.
4-16 Clutch Control System - Clutch Pedal

17. Install the clutch pedal bracket.


Install the clutch bracket with two bolts and nuts.
Torque: 12N.m

18. Install the U-connector with pin on the clutch master cylinder
push bar.
(1) Apply multi-function lube on the surfaces of the pin and the
U-connector bushing.
(2) Connect the U-connector to the clutch pedal with clip.
Tips: Install the pin from the right side.
(3) Install the clip on the pin.
19. Install the clutch pedal spring.
20. Check and adjust the clutch pedal.
21. Connect the battery negative terminal.
Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Propeller Shaft, Driveshaft and Transaxle 4-17

Chapter 4 Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft


Section 1 Propeller Shaft, Driveshaft and Transaxle

I. Symptom Table
The table below can help find the causes of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the causes of the
problem. Replace the parts if necessary.

Symptom Inspection Area Reference


1. Wheel
2. Front wheel alignment
3. Rear wheel alignment
4. Front wheel hub bearing (worn)
Deviation
5. Rear wheel hub bearing (worn)
6. Front shock absorber with coil spring
7. Steering linkage (loose or damaged)
8. Stabilizer bar
1. Wheel balance
Front wheel vibration 2. Wheel hub bearing (worn)
3. Front shock absorber with coil spring
1. Outer joint (worn)
Noise (drive shaft)
2. Inner joint (worn)

II. On-board Inspection


1. Check front wheel hub bearing
(1) Remove front wheel.
(2) Remove front brake caliper assembly.
(3) Remove front brake disc.
(4) Check the bearing backlash.
Set a dial indicator near the front wheel hub center to check
the backlash.
Maximum: 0.05mm
If the backlash exceeds the maximum value, replace the front
wheel hub bearing.

(5) Check the front wheel hub deviation


Using a dial indicator, check the deviation of the surface of the
wheel hub outside the hub bolt.
Maximum: 0.07mm
If the backlash exceeds the maximum value, replace the front
wheel hub subassembly.
4-18 Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Propeller Shaft, Driveshaft and Transaxle

(6) Install front brake disc.


(7) Install front brake caliper assembly
(8) Install font wheel.
Torque: 103N.m

2. Check back wheel hub bearing


(1) Remove rear wheel.
(2) Remove rear brake drum subassembly.
(3) Check bearing backlash.
Set a dial indicator near the rear wheel hub center to check the
backlash.
Maximum: 0.05mm
If the backlash exceeds the maximum value, replace the rear
wheel hub and bearing assembly.

(4) Check rear wheel hub deviation


Using a dial indicator, check the deviation of the surface of
the rear wheel hub inside the hub bolt.
Maximum: 0.07mm
If the backlash exceeds the maximum value, replace the rear
wheel hub and bearing assembly.
(5) Install rear brake subassembly
(6) Install rear wheel
Torque: 103N.m
Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Front Driveshaft 4-19

Section 2 Front Driveshaft

Component View

right constant velocity drive


shaft assembly

snap ring
snap ring

with ABS LF vehicle speed sensor right constant velocity drive


shaft assembly

brake hose

Tie rod left end assembly

collar
gasket

front stabilizer bar

cotter pin

gasket
collar
set nut
cotter pin

N.m : specified torque left lower swing arm


Non-reusable parts
4-20 Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Front Driveshaft

Component View

outboard rzeppa joint

outboard joint big clamp


outboard joint boot

outboard joint small clamp

RH: drive shaft damper clamp

right front drive


shaft damper

inboard joint small clamp

inboard joint boot

inboard joint big clamp


tripod

retainer

tripod joint

Non-reusable parts
Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Front Driveshaft 4-21

Overhaul
1. Drain manual transmission oil (M/T transmission)
Torque: 39N.m
2. Drain automatic transmission oil (A/T transmission)
Torque: 25N.m
3. Remove front wheel
4. Remove engine bottom left shield (M/T transaxle)
5. Remove engine bottom right shield (M/T transaxle)
6. Remove engine bottom shield assembly (A/T transaxle)
7. Remove front wheel hub left bolt
(1) Using a hammer and a drive shaft nut chisel, unstake the
staked part of the left wheel hub nut.
(2) While applying the brake pedal, remove the left wheel hub
nut.
Notice: the staked part of the nut should be fully unstaked,
otherwise it may damage the thread of the drive shaft.

8. Remove left front vehicle speed sensor (with ABS)


(1) Remove the bolt and clip, remove vehicle speed sensor and
brake hose from left front shock absorber assembly.

(2) Remove the bolt, separate the left front vehicle speed sensor
from steering knuckle.

9. Remove front stabilizer bar


(1) Use a 10mm wrench to hold the bolt, remove the nut
(2) Remove two collars, No.1 and No.2 gaskets, remove front
stabilizer bar
4-22 Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Front Driveshaft

10. Separate left lower swing arm assembly


(1) Remove cotter pin and nut
(2) On steering knuckle, remove the left lower swing arm
assembly with ball joint puller.

11. Separate steering gear with tie rod assembly


(1) Remove cotter pin and nut
(2) On steering knuckle, remove the steering gear with tie rod
assembly with ball joint puller.

12. Separate LF steering knuckle assembly


Using a plastic hamper, separate left front drive shaft assembly from left front steering knuckle assembly
Notice:
Do not damage the boot.
With ABS:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle speed sensor rotor.

13. Remove left constant velocity drive shaft assembly


Using a differential side gear shaft remover, remove the left
constant velocity drive shaft assembly.
Notice:
Do not damage the boot and oil seal.
Be careful not to drop the drive shaft assembly.

14. Remove right constant velocity drive shaft assembly


Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the right constant
velocity drive shaft assembly.
Notice:
Do not damage the boot and oil seal.
Be careful not to drop the drive shaft assembly.
Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Front Driveshaft 4-23

15. Install LF steering knuckle assembly


Notice:
The hub bearing could be damaged if it is subjected to the vehicle
weight, such as when moving the vehicle with the drive shaft
bearing removed.
Therefore if it is absolutely necessary to place the vehicle weight
on the hub bearing, first support it with the special service tool for
front hub bearing.

16. Check left constant velocity drive shaft assembly


(1) Check the outboard joint for apparent looseness.
(2) Check that the inboard joint slide smoothly.
(3) Check the inboard joint for radial looseness.
(4) Check the boot for damage.
Notice:
Place the drive shaft assembly on level surface during the
inspection.
17. Remove inboard joint big clamp
Using a screw driver, loosen the inboard joint big clamp.

18. Remove inboard joint small clamp


Using a screw driver, loosen the inboard joint small clamp.

19. Separate inboard joint boot


Separate the outboard joint boot from the outboard Rzeppa joint
assembly.
Mark
20. Remove left tripod joint assembly
(1) Wipe off the old grease from the tripod joint assembly.
(2) Place the matchmarks between the tripod joint assembly and
the outboard Rzeppa joint.
Notice:
Do not punch the matchmarks.
4-24 Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Front Driveshaft

(3) Remove the tripod joint assembly from the Rzeppa joint
assembly.
(4) Using a snap ring plier, remove the left drive shaft inner snap
ring.

(5) Place matchmarks on the tripod joint assembly and outboard


Rzeppa joint assembly. brass bar
Mark
Notice:
Do not punch the matchmarks.
(6) Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the tripod joint from
the outboard Rzeppa joint assembly.
Notice:
Do not tap the roller.
(7) Remove the inboard joint boot clamp, boot, inner boot and left
boot small clamp.

21. Remove drive shaft damper clamp


Hint:
Perform the following operations only when disassembling the
right drive shaft.
Using a screwdriver, loosen the damper clamp.

22. Remove right drive shaft damper


Hint:
Perform the following operations only when disassembling the right drive shaft.
Remove the right driver shaft damper clamp.

23. Remove left constant velocity outboard joint boot big clamp
Using a screwdriver, loosen the left constant velocity drive shaft
outboard joint boot big clamp.
Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Front Driveshaft 4-25

24. Remove outboard joint boot small clamp


Using a screw driver, loosen the outboard joint boot small clamp.

25. Remove outboard joint boot


(1) Remove the outboard joint boot from the outboard Rzeppa joint assembly.
(2) Wipe off the old grease from the Rzeppa joint assembly.

26. Remove left front drive shaft tripod retainer


Using a screw driver, loosen the left front drive shaft tripod
retainer.

27. Install left front tripod retainer


Install the new tripod retainer.

28. Install outboard joint boot


(1) Wrap vinyl tape around the spline of the Rzeppa joint to prevent damaging the boots.
(2) Install the new parts on the tripod joint in the following sequence.
a. Outboard joint boot big clamp
b. Outboard joint boot
c. Outboard joint boot small clamp

(3) Coat the left Rzeppa joint assembly with grease.


Grease amount: 69-79g
(4) Install the outboard joint boot on the Rzeppa joint assembly.

29. Install outboard joint boot small clamp


As shown in the illustration, use a screwdriver to install the
outboard joint boot clamp.
4-26 Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Front Driveshaft

30. Install outboard joint boot big clamp


As shown in the illustration, use a screwdriver to install the
outboard joint boot big clamp.

31. Install right front drive shaft damper


Hint:
Perform the following operations only when disassembling the
right drive shaft.
Set the following distance:
Distance (A) 470 ± 4.0mm

32. Install drive shaft damper clamp


Hint:
Perform the following operations only when disassembling the
right drive shaft.
(1) Slide the damper clamp on the shaft.
Notice:
Make sure the clamp is correctly installed.
(2) As shown in the illustration, use a screwdriver to install the
damper clamp.

33. Install tripod joint assembly


Before installing the boot, wrap vinyl tape around the spline of the Rzeppa joint to prevent damaging the boots.
(1) Install the new parts on the tripod joint in the following sequence.
a. Inboard joint boot small clamp
b. Inboard joint boot
c. Inboard joint boot big clamp

(2) Align the matchmarks, install the tripod assembly on the


tripod joint outer shaft assembly.
(3) Using a brass bar and a hammer, install the tripod assembly.
Notice:
Do not tap the roller.
Mark
Make sure the tripod is correctly installed.
Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Front Driveshaft 4-27

(4) Using a snap ring plier, install the new retainer.


(5) Coat the tripod joint assembly with grease.
Grease amount: 99-109g

(6) Align the matchmarks, install the left intermediate shaft


Mark
assembly on the tripod joint assembly.

34. Install inboard joint boot


Install the inboard joint boot on the intermediate shaft and tripod joint outer shaft.
35. Install inboard joint boot small clamp
As shown in the illustration, use a screwdriver to install the
inboard joint boot small clamp.

36. Install inboard joint big clamp


As shown in the illustration, use a screwdriver to install the
inboard joint big clamp.

37. Check front drive shaft


(1) Check the outboard joint for apparent looseness.
(2) Check that the inboard joint slide smoothly.
(3) Check the inboard joint for radial looseness.
(4) Check the boot for damage.
Notice:
Place the drive shaft assembly on level surface during the
inspection.
4-28 Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Front Driveshaft

Hint:
Please refer to the following table for dimension (A).

LH mm RH mm
M/T manual transmission 528.3±5.0 859.3±5.0
A/T automatic transmission 527.0±5.0 860.0±5.0

38. Install left constant velocity drive shaft assembly


(1) M/T
Coat the spline of the tripod joint assembly with gear oil.
(2) A/T
Coat the spline of the tripod joint assembly with ATF
(Automatic Transmission Fluid).
(3) Align the spline, use a brass bar and hammer to install the left
drive shaft assembly.
Notice:
Face the retainer open end downward.
Be careful not to damage the boot and oil seal.
Hint:
You can find out whether the tripod joint shaft contact the pinion shaft by rotating the shaft assembly, listening
to the sound and feeling.
39. Install right constant velocity drive shaft assembly
Hint:
The installation of the right side is the same as that of the left side.
Notice:
Install the retainer with its open end facing downward.
Be careful not to damage the boot and oil seal.
40. Install left steering knuckle assembly
Install the left constant velocity drive shaft assembly on the left steering knuckle assembly.
Notice:
Be careful not to damage the outboard joint boot.
With ABS:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle speed sensor rotor.
41. Install left steering gear with tie rod assembly
(1) Install the steering gear with tie rod assembly on the steering knuckle assembly with nuts.
Torque: 33N.m
(2) Install the new cotter pins.
Notice:
If the pin holes are not aligned, further tighten the nut by 60°.
42. Install left lower swing arm assembly
(1) Install the left lower swing arm assembly on the steering knuckle assembly with nuts.
Torque: 98N.m
Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Front Driveshaft 4-29

(2) Install the new cotter pins.


Notice:
If the pin holes are not aligned, further tighten the nut by 60°.
43. Install front stabilizer bar
(1) As shown in the illustration, install the stabilizer bar with two
No.1 collars and two gaskets and nuts.
Notice:
Make sure the gaskets and collars are correctly installed.
(2) Tighten the nut with a 10mm wrench.
Torque: 18N.m

44. Install left front vehicle speed sensor (with ABS)


(1) Install the left front vehicle speed sensor and brake hose on the
front shock absorber with bolts and clps.
Torque: 29N.m

(2) Install the vehicle speed sensor on the steering knuckle with
bolts.
Torque: 8.0N.m
Notice:
Be careful not to damage the wheel speed sensor.
Keep the vehicle speed sensor clean.
When installing the sensor,do not twist the sensor wire harness.

45. Install left steering knuckle wheel hub nut


(1) Install new left steering knuckle hub nuts
Torque: 216N.m
(2) Using a chisel and hammer, stake the hub locking nut.

46. Install engine bottom left shield


47. Install engine bottom right shield
48. Install engine bottom shield assembly
49. Install front wheel
Torque: 103 N.m
50. Add oil into manual transmission
51. Check and adjust the manual transmission fluid
52. Refill automatic transmission fluid
53. Check and adjust the automatic transmission fluid
54. Check and adjust front wheel alignment
55. Check ABS vehicle speed signal (with ABS)
4-30 Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Front Wheel Hub

Section 3 Front Wheel Hub

Component View

With ABS

Left Front Vehicle


Speed Sensor
Left Tie Rod End Subassembly
Brake Hose
Left Constant Velocity
Drive Shaft Assembly
Left Front Axle Assembly

No. 1 Cushion Collar

Cotter Pin

Brake Disc

Front Stabilizer
Left Brake Caliper Assembly
Cushion
No. 1 Cushion Collar Clip

Left No.1 Front Lower


Suspension Arm Left Front Axle Hub Nut
Subassembly
Retainer

Dual Ball Bearing

Front Axle Hub Nut

Left Steering Knuckle Front Axle Hub

Left Front Brake Disc Dust Cover

N.m : specified torque

Non-reusable parts
Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Front Wheel Hub 4-31

Replacement
1. Remove front wheel
2. Using a drive shaft nut chisel, remove the front axle hub left nut

3. Remove left front vehicle speed sensor (with abs)


4. Remove left front brake caliper assembly
Remove 2 bolts, remove the left front brake caliper assembly
from the steering knuckle.

5. Remove front brake disc


6. Remove front stabilizer
7. Remove left no.1 front lower suspension arm subassembly with a ball joint puller

8. Remove left tie rod end subassembly with a ball joint puller

9. Remove left front axle assembly


10. Remove left front shock absorber assembly
Remove 2 sets of bolts and nuts, remove the left front shock
absorber from the left front axle assembly.

11. Remove left front axle hub snap ring


Using a snap ring plier, remove front axle hub left snap ring.

12. Remove left front axle hub subassembly


(1) Remove the left front axle hub subassembly with rear axle
puller.
4-32 Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Front Wheel Hub

(2) Using sst, remove inner race of the left axle hub bearing from
the left axle hub sub assembly.

13. Remove front left brake disc boot


Remove 3 bolts and front left boot.
14. Remove left front axle hub bearing
(1) Place the left axle hub bearing inner race into the left axle hub
bearing outer race.
(2) Remove the left axle hub bearing from the steering knuckle
with press and sst

15. Install left front axle hub bearing


Install the new left axle hub bearing on the steering knuckle with
press and sst

16. Install front left brake disc boot


Install the front left boot with 3 bolts.
Torque: 8.3N.m
17. Install left front axle hub subassembly
Install left axle hub assembly with press and sst.

18. Install left front axle hub snap ring


Install the new left snap ring with snap ring plier.
Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Front Wheel Hub 4-33

19. Install left front shock absorber assembly


Install the front left shock absorber assembly on the left front axle
assembly with 2 sets of bolts and nuts
Torque: 132N. m
Notice:
Only coat the thread parts of the new bolts and nuts with engine
oil.
20. Install left front axle assembly
21. Install left tie rod end subassembly
22. Install left no.1 front lower suspension arm subassembly
23. Install front stabilizer
24. Install front brake disc
25. Install left front brake caliper assembly
Install the front brake caliper assembly on the steering knuckle
with 2 bolts.
Torque: 88N.m

26. Install left front axle hub nut


Install new left axle hub nut.
Torque: 216N.m
27. Remove left front brake caliper assembly
28. Remove front brake disc
29. Check bearing backlash
30. Check axle hub deviation
31. Install front brake disc
32. Install left front brake caliper assembly
33. Install left front vehicle speed sensor (with ABS)
34. Install left front axle hub nut
Using a chisel and hammer, stake the left axle hub nut.

35. Install front wheel


Torque: 103N.m
36. Check and adjust front wheel alignment
37. Check abs vehicle speed sensor signal (with ABS)
4-34 Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Front Wheel Hub

Replacement
1. Remove front wheel
2. Remove left front brake caliper assembly
3. Remove front brake disc
4. Remove left front axle hub bolt
Using a ball joint puller and a screwdriver or similar, remove the
left axle hub bolt.

5. Install left front axle hub bolt


(1) As shown in the illustration, install the gasket and nut on the
new left axle hub bolt.
Washer
(2) Using a screwdriver or similar,hold the left axle hub subassembly, Nut
install the left axle hub bolt by tightening the nut.

6. Install front brake disc


7. Install left front brake caliper assembly
8. Install front wheel
Torque: 103N.m

The replacement of the right front axle hub subassembly is the same as that of the left one.
Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Rear Wheel Hub and Bearing Assembly 4-35

Section 4 Rear Wheel Hub and Bearing Assembly

Component View

Slip Control Sensor Wire Harness

With ABS

Left Rear Axle Hub Bolt

Brake Drum Assembly

Rear Axle Hub Unit

N.m : specified torque

Non-reusable parts
4-36 Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Rear Wheel Hub and Bearing Assembly

Replacement
1. Remove rear wheel
2. Remove rear wheel brake drum subassembly
3. Remove slip control sensor wire harness (with ABS)
4. Remove left rear axle hub and bearing assembly
Remove 4 bolts and left axle hub and bearing assembly.

5. Install left rear axle hub and bearing assembly


Install left axle hub and bearing assembly with 4 bolts
Torque: 63N.m

6. Connect slip control sensor wire harness (with ABS)


Notice:
Do not twist the sensor wire harness during connection.
7. Check bearing backlash
8. Check axle hub deviation
9. Install rear wheel brake drum subassembly
10. Install rear wheel
Torque: 103N.m
11. Check as vehicle speed sensor signal (with ABS)
Propeller Shaft/Driveshaft - Rear Wheel Hub and Bearing Assembly 4-37

Replacement
1. Remove rear wheel
2. Remove rear wheel brake drum subassembly
3. Remove left rear wheel axle hub bolt
Using a ball joint puller and a screwdriver or similar, remove the
left axle hub bolt.

4. Install left rear wheel axle hub bolt


(1) As shown in the illustration, install the gasket and nut on the
new left axle hub bolt.
Washer
(2) Using a screwdriver or similar, hold the left axle hub subassembly, Nut
install the left axle hub bolt by tightening the nut.

5. Install rear brake drum subassembly


6. Install rear wheel
Torque: 103N.m

The replacement of the right rear axle hub and bearing assembly is the same as that of the left one.
4-38 Front Suspension System - Front Suspension System

Chapter 5 Front Suspension System


Section 1 Front Suspension System
Description on front suspension structure
This model uses strut swing arm independent suspension with stabilizer bar.
The shock absorber upper end is flexibly connected to the body through the shock absorber mounting seat, the
lower end is rigidly connected to the steering knuckle. The coil spring encloses the shock absorber (coil spring
geometrical axial line does not coincide with that of the shock absorber piston rod), and is supported between the
upper and lower spring seats.
Both ends of the stabilizer bar are connected to the shock absorber through the strut bar ball pin and the intermediate
part is supported on the lower front body by the rubber bushing and support frame.
The front cushion sleeves the shock absorber piston rod head to restrict the wheel jump limit position and plays
the role of buffer.
The thrust ball bearing, installed between the spring upper seat and the shock absorber mount, is used for the
relative rotation upon steering of the shock absorber rigidly connected to the steering knuckle to the shock absorber
mount flexibly connected to the body.
"L" type lower swing arm is secured to the lower engine compartment with the press plate through elastic rubber
bushing and hinge, and its outer end is connected to the steering knuckle through the ball stud pin which is attached
to the lower swing arm by 3 high intension bolts. The ball stud pin can be removed and replaced when it is worn.
The ball seat material is saturated polyester containing oil, featured in comparatively high intensity and wearability
and good self-lubrication performance. Proper amount of grease has been added during the assembly and there is
no need for additional filling during the normal operation.

See the table for the front suspension technical parameters


Item Parameter
Shock absorber operating cylinder diameter /mm 45
Shock absorber piston rod diameter /mm 20
Shock absorber stroke/mm 160
Wheel camber -0°30'±45'
Wheel toe-in/mm 1±2
King pin inclination 10°0'±45'
King pin caster 2°0'±45'
Remark: the wheel alignment parameter in the table is at free load.
Front Suspension System - Front Suspension System 4-39

Symptom Table
Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the likely
cause of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace parts.

Symptom Suspected Area


1. Tires (Worn or improperly inflated)
2. Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
3. Steering system joint (Loose or worn)
Off track
4. Hub bearing (Worn)
5. Steering gear (Out of adjustment or worn)
6. Suspension parts (Worn or damaged)
1. Vehicle (Overloaded)
Body Descent 2. Spring (stiffness not comply with or damage)
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
2. Steering linkage (Loose or damaged)
Sways
3. Stabilizer bar (Bent or broken)
4. Shock absorber (Worn or damaged)
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
2. Tire (Dynamic balance is not as specified)
3. Shock absorber (Worn or damaged)
4. Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
Front wheel shimmy
5. Ball stud pin (Worn or damaged)
6. Hub bearing (Worn or damaged)
7. Steering linkage (Loose or worn)
8. Steering gear (Out of adjustment or worn)
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
2. Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
Abnormal tire wear
3. Shock absorber (Worn or damaged)
4. Suspension parts (Worn or damaged)
4-40 Front Suspension System - Front Suspension

Section 2 Front Suspension

Component View

left front suspension


bracket dust seal

left front suspension


bracket dust cover
left front suspension
suspension support bracket subassembly

left upper front


helical spring seat

left upper helical


spring pad

left front helical spring


front shock absorber with
helical spring

left front
spring
bumper

With/ ABS:
left front vehicle
speed sensor
left front shock absorber
brake hose
assembly

N.m : specified torque


Non-reusable parts
Front Suspension System - Front Suspension 4-41

Component View

engine hood

front stabilizer bar

rack and pinion power


steering gear

Retainer
front suspension cross beam
subassy

pad

left lower front suspension


Retainer arm subassy
pad
Retainer Retainer
pad

Front suspension Reinforcement clamp


Rod

Retainer
pad
Retainer

engine lower cover Right front suspension


subassy reinforcement beam
N.m : specified torque
Non-reusable parts
4-42 Front Suspension System - Front Suspension

Component View

right front stabilizer bar bracket

retainer
bushing
pad
left front stabilizer bar
bracket
pad bushing
retainer

Front stabilizer bar bolt


front stabilizer bar
retainer
pad
retainer
pad
retainer
pad pad
retainer left lower front suspension retainer
arm subassy
front stabilizer bar bolt

retainer
pad

clamp

retainer

pad

retainer

N.m : specified torque


Non-reusable parts
Front Suspension System - Front Wheel Alignment 4-43

Section 3 Front Wheel Alignment

Adjustment:
Front
1. Check tire
2. Measure the vehicle height
Vehicle height:

Tire size Front1(mm) Rear2 (mm)


175 / 65R14 82H 191 265
Rear
185 / 60R15 84H 192 265
1.
front measure point
Measure the distance between the ground and the front underside
suspension mounting bolt center
2.
rear measure point
Measure the distance between the ground and the rear axle beam mounting bolt center
Notice:
Before the wheel alignment,adjust the body to the specified height.If the body height is out of spec,adjustment
shall be done by pressing or raising vehicle body.
3. Check the Toe-in
Toe-in:
Front
If the toe-in is out of spec, adjust the ends of rack.

4. Adjust the Toe-in


(1)Remove the clamp of the rack boot
(2)Loose the jam nut of tie rod
(3)Adjust the Toe-in by rotating the same turns of both ends of
rack.
Tips: Adjust the toe-in to the intermediate value of spec.

(4)Make sure the same length for both ends


The length difference of left and right: 1.5mm or smaller
(5)Tighten the jam nut of the tie rod
Torque: 47N.m
(6)Seat the boot and crimp the clamp
Tips: rack boot must not be twisted
4-44 Front Suspension System - Front Wheel Alignment

5. Check the steering angle of wheel


Fully steer the wheel and measure the angle
The angle of wheel:
Front
Manual steering Power steering
Inside wheel 9-1 37.2°±2°
Outside wheel 32°±2° 32°±2° Inside
Outside

If there is deviation with spec for right and left wheel angle, check the rack length of left and right ends.

6. Check the camber, caster and steering axle inclination angle


Camber angle -0°30' ± 45' (-0.5° ± 0.75°)
Left-right wheel deviation 45'(0.75°) or smaller
Caster angle 9-1 meter
Manual steering 1°46' ± 45' (1.76° ± 0.75°) locator
Power steering 45' (0.75°) or smaller
Left-right wheel deviation
Kingpin inclination
Manual steering 9°54' ± 45' (9.90° ± 0.75°)
Power steering 45' (0.75°) or less
Left-right wheel deviation

If the kingpin caster angle and the kingpin inclination be out of spec, check the damage and abrasion of
suspension parts after the correct adjustment of camber angle.

7. Adjust the camber angle


Notice:
Check the toe-in after adjust the camber angle
(1)Remove the front wheel
(2)Remove the two nuts under the shock absorber
If you need to reuse the bolts and nuts, apply the engine oil on
the nut thread
(3)Clear the mounting surface of the knuckle and shock absorber.
Front Suspension System - Front Wheel Alignment 4-45

(4) Mount 2 nuts temporarily.


(5) Adjust the camber angle by pushing or pulling the underside
of shock absorber in the direction of required adjustment.
(6) Tightening the nuts
Torque: 132N.m
(7) Mounting the front wheel
Torque: 103N.m Adjusting bolt
(8) Check the camber
Tips:
Adjust the camber to the median of spec.
Adjustment value of positioning the bolts: 6' ~ 30'.
(0.1° ~ 0.5°)

Refer to the table below to fix the correct adjustment if the camber is out of spec, then select the bolts for camber
adjustment.
Notice: Tighten the adjustment nuts with washer and new nuts.

Location bolt Adjusting bolt


bolt A B C

1 point 2 point
11 .11 .11.

Adjustment
value 1 2 1 2 1 2
15'
30'
45'
1°00'

(9) Repeat the steps above, replace 1 or 2 bolts


Tips:
Only replace 1 bolt if 2 bolts are needed to be replaced.
4-46 Front Suspension System - Front Strut Assembly

Section 4 Front Strut Assembly


Replacement
1. Remove screen wiper arm cover
2. Remove right screen wiper
3. Remove left screen wiper
4. Remove hood and seals of vehicle neck
5. Remove upper right ventilation shield of vehicle neck
6. Remove upper left ventilation shield of vehicle neck
7. Remove the wiper linkage assembly of windscreen
8. Remove the hood of vehicle neck
(1) Remove the bolt and 2 clips, disconnect the harness
(2) Remove the hose and harness (wiper)
(3) Remove the 8 bolts of ventilation shield of vehicle neck
9. Remove the front wheel
10. Remove the brake hose
(1) Remove the bolts, brake hose and the clamp of ABS sensor
harness from the shock absorber bracket (with ABS)
(2) Remove the bolts and brake hose from the shock absorber
(without ABS)

11. Remove the front shock absorber with helical spring


(1) Remove the shock absorber from knuckle after remove the two
nuts and bolts.

(2) Remove the front shock absorber with helical spring, remove
the three bolts mounting suspension bracket

12. Fix the front shock absorber with helical spring


(1) Mount the two bolts and one bolt onto the bracket of shock
absorber underside, and fix it onto the vise
(2) Hold down the helical spring
Notice: Don't use the impact wrench which can damage the
special tool
Front Suspension System - Front Strut Assembly 4-47

13. Remove the duct cover of the bracket for left front suspension
Remove the end cap from the bracket of suspension
14. Remove the front bracket after removing the nuts of left front
shock absorber
Hold it by the two nuts and a screwdriver or analogue, then
remove centre nut
Notice: Don't damage the stud of suspension bracket.
15. Remove the bracket assembly of the left front suspension
16. Remove the seals of bracket dust hood for left front suspension
17. Remove the left upper front helical spring seat
18. Remove the left upper front helical spring insulator
19. Remove the left front helical spring
20. Remove the left front spring bumper
21. Remove the left front shock absorber assembly bumper
22. Check the left front shock absorber assembly
Check the abnormal resistance and noise in the operation by
compressing and extending the pushrod, replace it if abnormal.

23. Mount the left front shock absorber assembly


24. Mount the left front spring shock absorber pad
25. Mount the left front helical spring
(1) Compress the helical spring with special tool
Notice: Don't use the impact wrench which may damage the
special tool

(2) Load the helical spring into the shock absorber


Attention: tighten the helical spring lower side to the gap of
spring lower seat.

26. Mount the left upper front helical spring insulator


Mount the upper insulator, mark " "toward vehicle outside.
27. Mount the upper seat of left front helical spring
Mount the upper seat, mark " " toward vehicle outside
4-48 Front Suspension System - Front Strut Assembly

28. Mount the dust seals of left front suspension bracket


29. Mount the left front suspension bracket sub-assembly
30. Mount the front bracket onto the left front shock absorber nuts
(1) Hold the bracket by two bolts and a screwdriver or analogue.
Mount the new centre nut
Torque: 33N.m
Notice: DonÕt cause damage to the stud of suspension bracket.

(2) The special tool for remove


Multi-purpose grease
(3) Apply the multipurpose grease onto the suspension bracket

31. Mount the dust cap of left front suspension bracket


32. Mount the front stud assembly
(1) Mount the #2 suspension bracket
(2) Mount the front stud assembly by three nuts
Torque: 39N.m
(3) Mount the shock absorber onto the knuckle
(4) Film the engine oil onto the thread of two nuts
(5) Mount the two bolts and nuts
Torque: 132N.m
33. Mount the brake hose
Torque: 29N.m
34. Mount the front wheel
Torque: 103N.m
35. Mount the outside cover of vehicle neck
(1) Mount the outside cover of vehicle neck by 8 bolts
Torque: 5N.m
(2) Connect hose and harness (screen wiper)
(3) Mount the harness by bolts and two clips
36. Mount the linkage assembly of windshield wiper
37. Mount the ventilation hood of left vehicle neck
38. Mount the ventilation hood of right vehicle neck
39. Mount the engine hood and seals of vehicle neck
40. Mount the left front wiper arm
41. Mount the right front wiper arm
42. Check and adjust the front wheel alignment
Front Suspension System - Front Lower Swing Arm Assembly 4-49

Section 5 Front Lower Swing Arm Assembly

Disassemble
1. Remove the front wheel
2. Remove the subassembly of the engine #1 cover
3. Remove the engine hood
4. Sling the engine assembly
5. Remove the left front suspension cross beam
Remove the two bolts and left front suspension cross beam
6. Remove the right front suspension cross beam
Remove the two bolts and right front suspension cross beam
7. Disassemble the left lower subassembly of the front suspension
arm
(1) Remove the clips and nuts
(2) Remove the suspension arm from the knuckle by special tool

8. Disassemble the front stabilizer bar


(1) Remove the nuts, three retainers and two pads (left side) when
tightening the bolts of stabilizer rod
(2) Take the same steps on the other side as above.

(3) Remove the front stabilizer rod after removing four bolts

9. Disassemble the power rack & pinion gear assembly


Disassemble the power rack & pinion gear assembly by removing
two bolts
Tips: Pull up the power rack & pinion gear assembly.
4-50 Front Suspension System - Front Lower Swing Arm Assembly

10. Disassemble the subassembly of the front suspension beam


(1) Remove the bolt and two nuts.

(2) Lift the front suspension beam subassembly by lifting jack


(3) Disassemble the front suspension subassembly by removing
the four bolts.

11. Remove left lower front suspension subassembly


Remove left lower front suspension subassembly by removing
two bolts and nuts
Notice: Don't rotate the nuts

12. Check the left lower front suspension subassembly


(1) Swing the ball joint stud for 5 times before mounting the nuts,
as show in the figure.
(2) Continuously rotate the nuts with a speed of 2-4 seconds per
turn with the torque wrench,record the torque value at the 5th
turn.
Torque: 0.78~3.43 N.m

13. Temporarily tighten left lower front suspension subassembly


Temporarily tighten left lower front suspension subassembly
with two bolts and nuts.
Front Suspension System - Front Lower Swing Arm Assembly 4-51

14. Connect the front suspension beam subassembly


(1) Mount the front suspension beam subassembly by four bolts
Torque:
Bolt A: 70N.m
Bolt B: 116N.m

(2) Mount the bolt and two nuts


Torque: 52N.m

15. Mount the rack and pinion gear assembly


Mount the rack and pinion gear assembly with 2 bolts
Torque: 127N.m

16. Mount the front stabilizer bar


(1) Mount the front stabilizer rod with four bolts
Torque: 37N.m

(2) Mount the nuts, three retainers and two pads (left) when
tightening stabilizer rod bolts
Tip: Lift the lower controller arm by lifting jack
(3) Take the same steps on other side as above
4-52 Front Suspension System - Front Lower Swing Arm Assembly

17. Mount left lower front suspension subassembly


(1) Mount the lower suspension arm onto the knuckle by nuts
Torque: 98N.m
(2) Mount a new clip
Notice: Further tighten nuts for 60° if the holes are not in the
correct alignment

18. Mount the left front suspension cross beam


Mount the left front suspension cross beam with two bolts.
Torque: 47N.m
19. Mount the right front suspension cross beam
Mount the right front suspension cross beam with two bolts
Torque: 47N.m
20. Mount the front wheel
Torque: 103N.m
21. Stabilize the suspension
Stabilize the front suspension

22. Sufficiently tighten left front lower suspension arm subassembly


Tighten the lower suspension arm with two bolts
Bolt A: 88N.m
Bolt B: 132N.m
Attention: Don't rotate the nuts

23. Install engine hood.


24. Check and adjust front wheel alignment
Front Suspension System - Front Stabilizer Bar and Link Rod Assembly 4-53

Section 6 Front Stabilizer Bar and Link Rod Assembly


Disassemble
1. Remove the front wheel
2. Remove the front stabilizer bar bolts
(1) Remove two nuts, five retainers, four pads and stabilizer bolts when fixing bolts
(2) Take the same steps on other side as above.

3. Remove the front stabilizer bar


Remove four bolts and #1 front stabilizer bar bracket.

4. Mount the front stabilizer bar


Mount the stabilizer bar, two bushings, bracket and four bolts.
Torque: 37N.m
Notice:
Make the groove toward the vehicle rear
Tip:
Keep the bushing outside the paint line

Installation mark

5. Mount the front stabilizer bolts


(1) Mount the front stabilizer bolts, four pads and five retainers
Torque: 18N.m
(2) Take the same operations on other side as above process

6. Mount the front wheel


Torque: 103N.m
4-54 Rear Suspension System - Rear Suspension System

Chapter 6 Rear Suspension System


Section 1 Rear Suspension System
Component View

With ABS

Right rear helical spring

Side slip control sensor wire


Rear shock absorber assembly

Left rear helical spring

Upper washer
Lower washer

Left rear
helical spring
Brake hose

49
Washer Lower washer

82
Brake hose
9.0 Clip
98

Load-sensing valve Rear supension crossmember


bracket
N.m : specified torque
Non-reusable parts
Rear Suspension System - Rear Suspension System 4-55

I. Rear suspension structure description


This model uses strut independent rear suspension with stabilizer bar.
Rear suspension consists of the parallel front and rear double transverse arms, trailing rod, rear stabilizer bar
and rear strut assembly. The shock absorber and cone coil spring are arranged eccentrically.
See the table below for the major technical parameters of the rear suspension
Item Parameter
Shock absorber operating cylinder diameter /mm 38
Shock absorber piston rod diameter/mm 12.4
Shock absorber stroke /mm 250
Camber -0°56' ± 45'
Toe in/mm 3 ± 3
Remark: Wheel alignment parameter is at free load

II. Symptom Table


Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the likely
cause of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.

Symptom Suspected Area


1. Tires (Worn or improperly inflated)
2. Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
Off track
3. Hub bearing (Worn or damaged)
4. Suspension parts (Worn or damaged)
1. Vehicle (Overloaded)
Body descent 2. Spring (Stiffness small)
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
Sways 2. Wheel (not within specification)
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
2. Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
Rear wheel shimmy
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
4. Wheel (not within specification)
1. Tire (Worn or improperly inflated)
2. Wheel alignment (Incorrect)
Abnormal tire wear
3. Shock absorber (Worn)
4. Suspension parts (Worn or damaged)
4-56 Rear Suspension System - Rear Wheel Alignment

Section 2 Rear Wheel Alignment

Check
1. Check the tire
2. Measure the vehicle height
Notice:
Adjust the vehicle height to specified value before check the
wheel alignment Front

3. Check the rear toe-in

Toe in A+B: 0°19' ± 19' (0.31 ± 0.31°)


(assembly) C+D: 3.0 ± 3.0mm

Check and replace the related suspension parts if the toe in out of spec.
4. Check the camber
(1) Mount the camber-caster-kingpin measuring device, place the vehicle on the wheel position device
(2) Check camber

Camber -0°56' ± 45' (-0.93° ± 0.75°)


Left-right deviation 45' (0.75°) or smaller

Check the damage and performance decline of suspension parts and replace if necessary, if measurement out
of spec.
Rear Suspension System - LH/RH Rear Suspension Coil Spring 4-57

Section 3 LH/RH Rear Suspension Coil Spring

Replacement
1. Remove rear wheel
2. Remove the wire of the wheel speed sensor(with ABS)
(1) Remove the connector of wheel speed sensor.
(2) Remove bolts and wheel speed sensor from rear axle
frame.
Notes:
Remove the right sensor wire by using same process as left.

3. Remove the load-sensing valve bracket (without ABS)


Remove two nuts and load-sensing valve bracket from the axle
bracket

4. Remove the proportioning valve and rear right brake tube


(1) Remove the proportioning valve and rear right brake tube by
the special tool
(2) Remove the clips
Notes: Don't reuse the clips
5. Remove the proportioning valve and rear left brake tube
Notes: use the same operations of the proportioning valve and
rear right brake tube to remove #3 rear brake tube.
6. Remove right parking brake cable assembly
Remove nuts and right parking brake cable assembly
assembly from rear axle frame
7. Remove left parking brake cable assembly

8. Loose the rear axle assembly


Loose two 2 bolts
4-58 Rear Suspension System - LH/RH Rear Suspension Coil Spring

9. Remove the left rear shock absorber assembly


(1) Lift the rear axle at left sustainer by lifting jack
(2) Remove nuts, washers and left rear shock absorber assembly
10. Remove right rear shock absorber assembly
Notes: Remove right rear shock absorber assembly by using same
operations as left.
11. Remove left rear helical spring
Slowly lower lifting jack, remove helical spring and upper pads
and lower pads

12. Mount the left rear helical spring


(1) Mount the upper pad, let gap right on the helical spring
(2) Mount lower pad, let and load the left helical sprig into the rear
axle.

13. Temporarily tighten the left rear shock absorber assembly


(1) Mount the left rear shock absorber onto rear axle frame when
lift jack.
(2) Temporarily tighten nut and washer.
14. Temporarily tighten the right rear shock absorber assembly.
Notes: Mount the right assembly by using same operations as left.

15. Mount right parking brake cable assembly


Mount right parking brake cable assembly by nuts
Torque: 5.4 N.m
16. Mount left parking brake cable assembly.
Tips: Mount the right assembly by using same operations as left.

17. Mount the proportioning valve and rear right brake tube
(1) Connect the brake hose with brake tube by special tool.
Torque: 1 5 N.m
(2) Mount clips
Rear Suspension System - LH/RH Rear Suspension Coil Spring 4-59

18. Mount rear right brake tube


Tips:
Mount the right assembly by using same operations as left.
19. Mount sideslip control sensor wire (with ABS)
(1) Tighten sideslip control sensor wire by bolts
Torque: 8.0 N.m
(2) Mount sideslip control sensor wire
Attention: Mount the right wire by using same operations as left.

20. Mount load-sensing valve bracket (without ABS)


Mount load-sensing valve bracket by two buts

21. Sufficiently tighten the rear axle frame assembly


(1) Stabilize the shock absorber assembly
Use the lifting jack and add 90Kg force on rear luggage
carrier if bolts can not be tightened at this point.
(2) Sufficiently tighten bolts
Torque: 82 N.m

22. Sufficiently tighten the left rear shock absorber assembly


Sufficiently tighten nuts
Torque: 49 N.m
23. Sufficiently tighten the right rear shock absorber assembly
Tips: Mount the right rear shock absorber by using same opera-
tions as left.
24. Release the air in the brake hose
25. Mount the rear wheel
Torque: 103 N.m
26. Check rear the wheel alignment
27. Check the wheel speed sensor signal of ABS( with ABS)
4-60 Rear Suspension System - Rear Absorber Installation Assembly

Section 4 Rear Absorber Installation Assembly


Component View

Washer
Upper suspension carrier

Rear vibration cushion

Shock absorber upper cover

Left rear shock absorber assembly

washer

N.m : specified torque

Replacement
1. Remove the rear seat cushion assembly
2. Remove divided rear seat back assembly
3. Remove LH & RH rear seat back hinge (2 pieces)
4. Remove rear seat belt assembly
5. Remove left rear door molding
Rear Suspension System - Rear Absorber Installation Assembly 4-61

6. Remove rear left lower pillar interior panel


7. Remove the lower rear shelf interior panel
8. Remove rear left upper pillar interior pane
9. Remove rear right lower pillar interior pane
10. Remove the high brake lamp
11. Remove the rear shelf interior panel
12. Remove rear wheel
13. Remove the rear left shock absorber assembly
(1)Lift the rear axle frame by lifting jack (see right figure)

(2)Remove two nuts by clamping the piston push rod


(3)move the washer and upper suspension bracket

(4) Remove nut, washer and left rear shock absorber assembly
(5) Remove shock absorber upper cover

14. Check rear left shock absorber assembly


Check the abnormal resistance and noise in the operation by
compressing and extending the push rod, replace it if any abnormal.
15.Mount rear left shock absorber assembly
(1) Mount shock absorber upper cover
(2) Mount shock absorber, upper suspension bracket and washer
onto vehicle body
(3) After clamp piston push rod, mount lower nut and let piston
push rod higher 15-18mm than nut (see right figure)
(4) Mount upper nut according lower nut
Torque: 25N.m
(5) Mount shock absorber onto rear axle frame by washer and nut
at lifting jack
Torque: 49N.m
16. Mount rear wheel
Torque: 103N.m
17. Check rear wheel alignment
4-62 Rear Suspension System - Rear Suspension Crossmember

Section 5 Rear Suspension Crossmember


Component View

with ABS

Brake hose

Upper washer

Right rear helical spring

Wheel speed sensor wire


Lower washer
Rear shock absorber subassembly

Rear brake drum


subassembly

Clamp Upper washer

Right rear hub and Left rear helical spring


bearing subassembly
Rear stabilizer
bar bushing
Lower washer

Rear right support bushing


Brake hose

Rear brake assembly


Bracket Rear brake drum
subassembly
Rear suspension
Load-sensing valve bracket without crossmentber
ABS

Left rear hub&bearing


Rear left support bushing
subassembly

Parking brake cable assembly

N.m : specified torque

Non-reusable parts
Rear Suspension System - Rear Suspension Crossmember 4-63

Disassemble:
1. Remove rear wheel
2. Remove sideslip control sensor wire (with ABS)
3. Remove load-sensing valve bracket (without ABS)
4. Remove proportioning valve and right rear brake tube
5. Remove proportioning valve and left rear brake tube
6. Remove right parking brake cable assembly
7. Remove left parking brake cable assembly
Tips: Remove right parts by using same operations as left
8. Remove rear brake drum subassembly
9. Remove left rear hub and bearing assembly
(1) Remove nuts and right parking brake cable assembly from
rear axle frame

(2) Remove four bolts and left rear hub and bearing assembly
(3)Remove rear brake assembly from rear axle frame

10. Remove rear right hub and bearing assembly


Tips: Remove right parts by using same operations as left
11. Loosen rear axle frame assembly
12. Disassemble rear left shock absorber assembly
13. Disassemble rear right shock absorber assembly
Tips: Remove right parts by using same operations as left
14. Remove rear left helical spring
15. Remove rear right helical spring
Tips: Remove right parts by using same operations as left
16. Remove rear axle assembly
(1) Lift rear axle assembly by lifting axel
(2) Remove two bolts and rear axle frame assembly
4-64 Rear Suspension System - Rear Suspension Crossmember

17. Remove rear stabilizer bar bushing


18. Remove left rear axle frame bushing
(1) Bend two bushing shoulders by chisel and hand hammer
Tips: Bend bushing shoulder till hooked by special tool
(2) Remove bushing from axle by special tool
Tips: Apply protective paint if axle frame scratched

Bending
bushing shoulder

19. Remove rear right axle frame bushing


Tips: Remove right parts by using same operations as left Front
20. Mount rear left axle frame bushing
(1) As showed in graphic, Mount left rear axle carrier onto rear
axle frame

(2) Mount bushing onto axle frame


Tips:
fix the jaw of special tool onto bushing
Don't chafe rubber of bushing
Don't deform the shoulder of bushing

rubber part

21. Mount rear right axle carrier bushing


Tips: Mount right parts by using same operations as left
22. Mount rear stabilizer bar bushing
Rear Suspension System - Rear Suspension Crossmember 4-65

23. Temporarily fasten the rear axle frame assembly


(1) Lift rear axle frame by lifting jack
(2) Mount the rear axle frame by temporarily tightening two bolts

24. Mount rear left helical spring


25. Mount rear right helical spring
Tips:
Mount right parts by using same operations as left
26. Temporarily tighten rear left shock absorber assembly
27. Temporarily tighten rear right shock absorber assembly
Tips:
Mount right parts by using same operations as left
28. Mount rear left hub and bearing assembly
Mount rear brake assembly, rear left hub and bearing assembly by
four bolts

29. Mount rear right hub and bearing assembly


Tips: Mount right parts by using same operations as left
30. Mount rear brake drum subassembly
31. Adjust the gap between brake drum and brake shoe
32. Mount #3 parking brake cable assembly
Tips: Mount right parts by using same operations as left
33. Mount #2 parking brake cable assembly
34. Mount #4 rear brake tube
35. Mount #3 rear brake tube
Tips: Mount right parts by using same operations as left
36. Connect sideslip control sensor wire(with ABS)
37. Connect load-sensing valve braket(without ABS)
38. Sufficiently tighten rear axle frame assembly
39. Sufficiently tighten rear left shock absorber assembly
40. Sufficiently tighten rear right shock absorber assembly
Tips: Mount right parts by using same operations as left
41. Release air from brake tube
42. Mount rear wheel
Torque: 103N.m
43. Check rear wheel alignment
44. Check the speed signal of ABS sensor( with ABS).
4-66 Wheel - Tire Inspection and Wheel Replacement

Charpter 7 Wheel
Section 1 Tire Inspection and Wheel Replacement
Check
1. Check tire
(1) Check appearance of tire and its pressure
Cool tire pressure:

Front Rear
Tire size
(KPa) (KPa)
175/65 R14 82H
230 210
185/60 R15 84H

(2) Check the runout of tire by dial indicator


Runout of tire: less than 3.0mm

2. Tire replacement
Notes: As showed in graphic, replacement position of every tire Front
including and not including the spare tire.

3.Check tire dynamic balance


(1) Check and adjust wheel on the tire dynamic machine beside
vehicle
(2) Check and adjust wheel on the tire dynamic machine loaded
beside vehicle
Balance deviation after adjustment: less than 8.0g.
4. Check bearing gap
5. Check hub deviation.
Power Steering System - Power Steering System 4-67

Chapter 8 Power Steering System


Section 1 Power Steering System
1. Power Steering System Description
Power Steering System consists of the steering wheel, steering transmit device, power steering fixed device
and steering pipelines. The steering gear is rack and pinion type.

2. Major parameters for steering system:


Item Parameter
Steering Wheel total revolutions 3.58±0.1
Maximum Front Inner 37.2°±2°/ 32°±2°
Wheel Turn Angle Outer 37.2°±2°/ 32°±2°
Minimum Turning Diameter 10.4 m

3. Precaution:
(1) Precaution for steering system
Make sure of the correct replacement of parts, incorrect replacement might affect the performance of the
steering system and lead to driving accidents.
(2) Precaution for SRS System
This vehicle is equipped with SRS (Supplemental Restraint System), driver side air bag and front passenger
side air bag.
Failure to carry out service operations in the correct sequence could cause the unexpected deployment of
the air bag during servicing, possibly leading to a serious accident.

4. Symptom Table
The table below is helpful to find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the likely cause
of the problem. Check each part in order. Repair or replace these parts or assemblies if necessary.

Symptom Suspected Area


1. Tire (improperly inflated)
2. Power steering fluid (insufficient)
3. Front wheel alignment (incorrect)
4. Steering knuckle (worn)
Heavy steering
5. Swing arm ball stud pin joint (worn)
6. Steering column (bent or binding)
7. Power steering pump assembly
8. Power steering gear assembly
1. Tire (improperly inflated)
2. Front wheel alignment (incorrect)
Poor return
3. Steering column (bent or binding)
4. Power steering gear assembly
4-68 Power Steering System - Power Steering System

Symptom Suspected Area


1. Steering knuckle (worn)
2. Swing arm ball stud pin joint (worn)
Excessive clearance
3. Intermediate shaft, sliding yoke (worn)
and play
4. Front wheel bearing (worn)
5. Power steering gear assembly (worn)
1. Power steering pump fluid level (low)
2. Steering system ball joint (worn)
Abnormal noise
3. Power steering pump assembly (damaged)
4. Power steering gear assembly (damaged)

5. On-vehicle inspection
Max. free play
1 Check steering wheel free play
(1) Stop vehicle and keep the tires straight ahead.
(2) Rotate the steering wheel slightly, check the steering wheel
free stroke.
Maximum free play: 30mm
Power Steering System - Steering Drive and Control Mechanism 4-69

Section 2 Steering Drive and Control Mechanism

Component View

4-spoke steering wheel car


3-spoke steering wheel car
Steering wheel assembly (optional)
33-59

DriverÕs airbag module

33-59
Quncunx cap screw

Right combination switch Steering wheel assembly

Steering column upeer cover


Quincunx cap screw

Left combination switch

Clock spring Steering column assembly


A/T:Parking lock cable

#2 counter shaft

Steering column lower cover 22-29 22-29


16-26

Slidefork

Steering column spline dust shield


N.m : specified torque
4-70 Power Steering System - Steering Drive and Control Mechanism

Component View

Ignition switch cylinder


A/T lock cable
Conical head bolt

snap ring

Upper and lower Steering


column panel
Ignition switch bracket

Ignition switch assembly


Steering column

snap ring

Main shaft

¡ôMain shaft bearing

Non-reusable parts
Power Steering System - Steering Drive and Control Mechanism 4-71

Replacement
1. Precaution (refer to the steering system precaution)
2. Confirm that the wheel stays at a straight line running status.
3. Unfix the storage battery cathode terminal.
4. Remove the airbag assembly.
Remove the two screws on both sides, and pull out the cable connector.
Note: When removing the airbag assembly, never pull the airbag cables.
Caution: When put down the airbag assembly, make sure its top surface stays upward.
Never disassemble the airbag assembly.

Using
Socket

5. Remove the steering wheel assembly.


(1)Unfix the connector.
(2)Remove the set bolts of the steering wheel.
(3)Make a fit mark on the steering wheel assembly and main shaft assembly.
(4)Remove the steering wheel with special tool.
6. Remove the top shells and bottoms shell of the steering column shield.
(1)Remove the three screws.
(2)Remove the top part and bottom part of the steering column
shield.
7. Remove clock spring.
8. Remove the left combination switch assembly.
Separate the connector and remove the left combination switch
assembly. Installation mark
9. Remove the right combination switch assembly.
Separate the connector and remove the right combination switch
assembly.
10. Remove the splined tube cover.
11. Detach No. 2 steering countershaft(see right figure)
(1) Make a mark on the fit between slide splined tube and countershaft.
(2) Loosen bolts A and B.

12. Remove the steering column pipe assembly.


(1)Remove the cable connector on the steering column pipe assembly.
(2)Remove the 3 bolts and steering column assembly.
4-72 Power Steering System - Steering Drive and Control Mechanism

13. Remove the No.2 steering countershaft assembly.


(1) Make a mark on the fit between main shaft and countershaft.
(2) Remove bolt and countershaft.

Installation mark

14. Remove the ignition switch bracket.


(1) Use the punch pin to make a mark on the 2 conical head bolt.
(2) Drill the 2 conical head bolts with the diameter of 3-4mm drill
bit.
(3) Remove the bolts and bracket for the ignition switch with the
thread die. Thread die

15. Remove fixing panel on the steering column.


16.Remove the ignition switch lock core assembly.
(1) Turn the ignition switch to "ACC" position.
(2) press the stop pin and pull the lock core out.

17. After checking or replacing the steering column pipe assembly, install all parts in a reverse order.
Note:
(1)After installing the ignition switch lock core, check the operation of the steering locking function: when
pulling out the key, the steering device is locked; when the key is inserted and turned to ACC position, the
steering device is unlocked.
(2)Tighten the 3 bolts.
(3)Make sure all cables are connected reliably.
(4)After adjusting the combination switch as well as the top shell and bottom shell of the steering pipe shield,
fasten the three screws connecting the combination switch and the steering column assembly.
(5)Tighten the set bolt between the universal joint fork and the steering gear assembly with a torque of
22~39N. m.
(6)Install dust cover and its press plate.
(7)When installing the steering wheel assembly, align the steering wheel assembly and the fit mark of the
steering main shaft assembly. Tighten the special quincunx bolt with a torque of 33~59N.m.
(8)Check the airbag. It is not allowed to use a airbag part removed from another vehicle.
(9)Check the SRS warning lamp.
Power Steering System - Steering Pipeline Component 4-73

Section 3 Steering Pipeline Component

Component View

Drive belt

Power steering high pressure


pipe

Return line (connecting fluld tank) Return line(connecting steering gear)

Power steering pump with bracket

N . m : specified torque

I. Onboard Check
1. Check the transmission strap.
Check the transmission strap whether it is worn out. If necessary, replace a new transmission strap.
Tips: Crack at the edge of the strap teeth is acceptable. If the strap teeth fall, replace a new strap.
2. Discharge the air in the power steering system.
(1)Check the liquid level.
(2)Lift the front part of the vehicle with a jack in a safety manner.
(3)Rotate the steering wheel.
After the motor is shut down, rotate the steering wheel to the left/right limit position lightly. Repeat such
operation several times.
(4)Loosen the jack, and put down the vehicle.
(5)Start the motor, and make it run idly for several minutes.
(6)Rotate the steering wheel to one side limit position for 2-3 seconds, and then rotate it to the other side limit
position for 2-3 seconds. Repeat such operations several times.
4-74 Power Steering System - Steering Pipeline Component

(7)Shut down the motor, and check whether there is any foam or
emulsification in the oil storage. If so, discharge the air
repeatedly. Normal Abnormal
(8)Check the level height, and check whether there is any
leakage.
2. Check the level height.
(1)Park the vehicle on the horizontal road.
(2)When the motor stops running, check the level height in the oil
tank. If necessary, add some more ATF DEXRONII steering
liquid.
Tips: The level shall stay between the lowest level and the highest level.
(3) Check whether there is any foam or emulsification. If so, discharge the power steering liquid.

Replacement
1. Discharge the steering liquid in the power steering system.
2. Remove the power steering high & low pressure oil pipes.
3.Loosen the connector screws of the high & low pressure oil pipes on the steering gear assembly, and loosen the
oil pipe clip.
4. Loosen the drive belt.
5. Remove the power steering pump strap support assembly from the motor. Remove the 3 coupling bolts between
the power steering pump strap support assembly and the motor.
6. Install the power steering pump strap support assembly.
Fasten the steering pump strap support assembly on the motor, and tighten the M10 bolt with a torque of 45-
79N.m and M8 bolt with a torque of 16-26N.m.

7. Install the drive belt, and make sure the position is correct.
8. Install the high & lower pressure oil pipes of the power steering gear assembly.
(1) Connect the connector screw of the high and low pressure oil pipe to the steering gauge with a torque of
19-33N.m.
(2) Fasten the low pressure oil pipe on the body front baffle plate with clip.
(3) Connect the connector screw of the high pressure oil pipe to the power steering pump with a torque of
19-33N.m.
(4) Connect the connector screw of the low pressure oil pipe to the oil tank with a torque of 19-33N.m.
9. Discharge all air in the power steering pipe system, and check the pipe system whether there is any leakage.
10. Check the oil reservoir inner fluid level
Power Steering System - Power Steering Gear 4-75

Section 4 Power Steering Gear


Component View

125-152
25-32
*28-35

27-39

125-152

Gear rack power steering device


Pin

27-39

Pin

Front suspension crossmenber assembly

N.m : specified torque


* :Special tool
4-76 Power Steering System - Power Steering Gear

Component View

Left ball extension shaft


Lock nut
Steering rack # 1 dust shield

Steering hydraulic Clip


oil pipe

Hoop

O-ring

O-ring
O-ring

Steering rack end sub-assembly

Steering rack end sub-assembly


Hoop

Clip

Left ball extension shaft

Steering rack # 2 dust shield

Lock nut
Specified torque
Non-reusable parts
Power steering oil
Special tool
Power Steering System - Power Steering Gear 4-77

Replacement
1. Drain the power steering system fluid
2. Loosen the high pressure pipes.
Loosen the high pressure pipes with special tool

3. Loosen the low pressure pipes


Loosen the low pressure pipes with special tool

4. Separate the tie rod from the steering knuckle


(1) Remove the cotter pin, loosen the groove type lock nut
(2) Separate the tie rod ball stud joint from the steering knuckle
taper hole

5. Loosen the thread screw of the high and low pressure pipe on the steering gear assembly
6. Remove the boot and press plate
7. Disconnect the power steering gear assembly from the steering column
Remove the steering gear pinion shaft spline lock bolt on the universal joint yoke
8. Remove power steering gear assembly
Remove 2 steering gear assembly set bolts. Remove the power steering gear assembly
9. Installation is in the reverse order of the removal
Notice:
(1) Insert the steering gear pinion shaft spline into the spline hole of the universal joint yoke, make sure that
the positions of the notch of the steering gear pinion shaft and the lock bolt of the universal joint yoke are
correct
(2) Secure the power steering gear with 2 bolts, torque: 125~152N.m
(3) Tighten the steering gear pinion shaft spline lock bolt on the universal joint yoke, torque: 22~34N.m
(4) Install the boot and press plate
(5) Install the threaded connector of the power steering high and low pressure pipe to the power steering gear,
torque: 25~32N.m
4-78 Power Steering System - Power Steering Gear

(6) Connect the tie rod ball stud pin with the steering knuckle, make sure that the mating surface of the tie rod
ball stud pin and the steering knuckle is clean, tighten the slot nut, torque: 27~39N.m. Install the cotter pin,
make sure of the correct installation
(7) Add appropriate amount of specified power steering fluid, bleed the power steering system
(8) Check the power steering pipeline system for leakage
(9) Check the front wheel alignment and front wheel left and right limit turn angle, adjust the toe in if
necessary and tighten the tie rod lock nut
(10) Check the position of the steering wheel. It is required that the steering wheel spokes are basically
symmetrical when the vehicle is driven straight ahead, reassemble the steering wheel if necessary
Brake System - Brake System 4-79

Chapter 9 Brake System


Section 1 Brake System
I. Precaution
1. It's very important to keep the parts and area clean when repairing the brake system.
2. Care must be taken to replace each part properly as it could affect the performance of the brake system and
result in a driving hazard.
3. Do not let brake fluid remain on a painted surface when repairing any parts. Wash it off immediately.
4. If any work is done on the brake system or air in the brake pipelines is suspected, bleed the system of air.
5. Check the brake system for leakage after repairing the brake system.
6. Use specified brake fluid. Do not mix with other brand of brake fluid.

II. Symptom table


Use the table below to help you find the cause of the problem. The numbers indicate the priority of the likely
cause of the problem. Check each part in order. If necessary, replace these parts.

Symptom Suspected Area


1 Brake system (fluid leaks)
2 Brake system (air in)
3 Piston Cup in Sub-pump (worn or damaged)
4 Rear brake shoe clearance (out of adjustment)
Low brake pedal or recoil
5 Master cylinder (faulty)
6 Booster push rod (out of adjustment)
7 Brake shoe or lining (oily)
8 Disc/Drum scratched
1. Brake pedal free stroke is too small
2. Parking brake lever stroke (out of adjustment)
3. Parking brake cable (sticking)
4. Rear brake shoe clearance (out of adjustment)
Brake Stagnation 5. Brake pad or lining (cracked or distorted)
6. Wheel cylinder piston (stuck or frozen)
7. Return spring (faulty)
8. Vacuum booster (faulty)
9. Brake master cylinder (faulty)
4-80 Brake System - Brake System

Symptom Suspected Area


1. Wheel cylinder piston (stuck)
2. Brake shoe lining (oily)
3. Disc (scratched)
Brake Deviation
4. Brake shoes or lining (cracked or distorted)
5. Wheel hub bearing (worn or damaged)
6. Tire pressure (not as specified)
1. Brake shoe lining (damaged)
2. Installation bolt (loose)
3. Disc (scratched)
Noise from brake 4. Brake shoe (bad in quality)
5. Brake shoes lining (oily)
6. Sound isolating shim damaged
7. Hold spring of brake shoe (damage)
Brake System - Brake Fluid 4-81

Section 2 Brake Fluid

Bleeding
1. Fill brake reservoir with brake fluid
Brake fluid: HZY4 complying with GB12981

2. Bleed brake pipeline system


(1) Connect the vinyl pipe to the wheel cylinder bleeder plug port
(2) Depress the brake pedal several times, and then loosen the bleeder plug with the pedal held down.
(3) At the point when fluid stops flowing out, tighten the bleeder plug, and then release the brake pedal.
(4) Repeat (2) and (3) until all the air in the fluid has been bled out.
(5) Repeat the above procedure to bleed the brake pipeline of the air for each wheel cylinder.
Notice: Fill brake fluid into the reservoir all the time when bleeding.

3. Check fluid level in reservoir


Check the fluid level and fill fluid if necessary.
Tips: Do not mix and use with other brand of brake fluid.
4-82 Brake System - Brake Pedal

Section 3 Brake Pedal


Component View

Brake master cylinder


handspike U-connector Brake pedal bracket

Brake light switch

Brake pedal axis


25
Lubrication bushing

Brake pedal return spring

Brake light bushing


Handspike pin

Pad

Clip

Brake pedal pad

Brake pedal
Specified torque
Non-reusable parts
Lithium soap-base glycol lube
Brake System - Brake Pedal 4-83

Adjustment
1. Check and adjust the height of brake pedal.
(1) Check the height of brake pedal.
Height from the floor: 124.3-134.3mm
Braking lamp switch
(2) Adjust the height of brake pedal.
a. Remove the cover of the console.
b. Remove the coupler from the brake light switch.
c. Loosen the lock nut of the brake light switch, and remove
the brake light switch.
d.Loosen the lock nub of the U-connector.
e.Turn the pedal push bar to adjust the height of brake
pedal. Push par
f. Tighten the lock nub of the push bar.
Torque: 26N.m
g. Install the brake light switch.
Braking pedel
h. Insert the connector of the brake light switch.
height
i. Push the brake pedal (5-15ram), and turn the brake light
switch till it goes out. Lock the nut in this position.
j. After installation, step down the brake pedal (5-15mm),
and check the brake light is bright.

2. Check the pedal free stroke.


(1) Shut down the motor, and step on the brake pedal repeatedly
till the booster is not vacuum.
(2) Step down the pedal till resistance appears, and measure the
distance as shown in the figure.
Pedal free travel: 1-6mm
If the clearance does not meet the requirement, check the
clearance of the brake light switch. If the clearance is correct,
make diagnosis on the braking system.
Free travel for
Clearance: 0.5-2.4mm
braking pedal

3. Check the pedal reserved distance.


Loosen the parking brake extension rod.
When the motor is running, step down the pedal, and measure the
pedal reserved distance as shown in the figure.
When stepping on the pedal 490N, the reserved distance from the
asphalt floor is larger than 55mm
If the distance doesn't meet the requirement, make diagnosis on
Reverse of braking
the braking system.
pedal
4-84 Brake System - Brake Pedal

Removal
After the installation, check and adjust the height, free stroke and reserved distance of the brake pedal.
1. Remove the combination instrument component (see figure 1).
2. Unfix the brake master cylinder push bar U-connector.
Remove the clip and pin, and unfix the master cylinder handspike from the brake pedal.
3. Remove the brake pedal bracket.
(1) Remove the bolt from the brake pedal bracket (see figure 1).
(2) Unfix the brake light coupler.
(3) Remove the four nuts and brake pedal bracket (see figure 2).

4. Remove the brake pedal sub-assembly. 1


(1) Remove the bolt and nut from the brake pedal bracket.
(2) Remove the brake pedal and the two bushings.
5. Remove the brake light switch component.
(1) Loosen the lock nut of the brake light switch.
(2) Remove the brake light switch from the brake pedal bracket.
6. Remove the brake pedal pad.
Remove the brake pedal pad from the brake pedal.
7. Install the brake pedal pad. 2
Install the brake pedal pad on the brake pedal.
8. Install the brake light switch component.
Install the brake light switch on the brake pedal bracket.
9. Install the brake pedal.
(1) Apply lithium soap-base glycol lube on the end surface and side surface of the two new bushings.
(2) Install the brake pedal and the two bushings on the brake pedal bracket with bolts and nuts.
Torque: 37N.m
10. Install the brake pedal bracket.
(1) Install the brake pedal bracket with four nuts.
Torque: 25N.m
(2) Connect the connector of the brake light switch.
(3) Install the bolt on the brake pedal bracket (see figure 3).
Torque: 20N.m
11. Connect and install the brake cylinder push bar U-connector.
(1) Apply the lithium soap-base glycol lube on the handspike pin.
(2) Connect the master cylinder handspike with pins and clips.

12. Install the combination instrument components.


13. Check and adjust the brake pedal height.
14. Check the brake pedal's free travel.
15. Check the brake pedal's reserved distance. 3
Brake System - Brake Master Cylinder Assembly 4-85

Section 4 Brake Master Cylinder Assembly


Component View

Brake master cylinder Vacuum booster


sub-assembly
Vacuum tube

No ABS

Manual Transmission Fluid level indicator lamp connector


#1 clutch fluidr tank pipe

N.m : specified torque


4-86 Brake System - Brake Master Cylinder Assembly

Component View

With ABS:
Cover
Brake fluid reservoir

Strainer Automatic Transmission


O-ring

Pin Retaining ring

Piston guide
Straight pin Hole block
connector Cup
Washer
Hole connector
#1 piston & Spring

Master cylinder #2 piston


Spring
Without ABS
Cover

Strainer

Pin Manual Transmission


O-ring
Retaining ring

Hole connector
Piston guide block

Cup
Hole connector

Master cylinder #1 piston & Spring

#2 piston & Spring

Washer

Piston limit bolt

Specified torque
Non-reusable parts
Lithium soap base glycol lube
Brake System - Brake Master Cylinder Assembly 4-87

Repair
1. Discharge the brake fluid.
With ABS:
Note: Never spray the brake fluid on the paint surface, otherwise
wash it immediately.
2. Remove the brake master cylinder.
(1) Pull out the connector of the level alarm light switch.
(2) Slide the clip, and pull out #1 clutch storage tank pipe (manual
transaxle).
Without ABS
(3) Remove the two brake pipes from the brake master cylinder
with special tool.(with ABS)
(4) Remove the three brake pipes from the brake master cylinder
accessory with special tool. (without ABS)

(5) Remove the two lock nuts, and pull out the brake master
pump.

3. Remove the storage tank.


(1) Put the brake master cylinder on the bench clamp.
(2) Remove the pin from the brake master cylinder body with
punch and hammer.
(3) Pull out the Brake fluid reservoir.
(4) Remove the cover and strainer from the storage tank.
(5) Remove the storage tank and the two hole connectors.

4. Remove the brake master cylinder.


(1) Put the brake master cylinder on the bench clamp.
(2) Remove the O-ring.
(3) Push the piston with hand, and remove the snap ring with
snap ring pliers.
4-88 Brake System - Brake Master Cylinder Assembly

(4) Push the piston with hand, and turn the cylinder body to
remove the straight pin. (with ABS)

(5) Push the piston with hand, and remove the piston bolt and
washer. (without ABS)

(6) Pull out #1 piston, piston guide block, spring, cup and washer
straightly.
Note: If angle appears in the pulling process, it may cause
damage to the cylinder wall.

(7) Put two blocks and cloth on the workbench. Put the flange of
the master cylinder against the block edge and knock it till #2
piston and spring get out of the cylinder.
Tips:
Make sure the distance (A) between the working cloth and the block's top is at least 100mm.
Note:
If angle appears in the pulling process, it may cause damage to the cylinder wall.
5. Check the brake master cylinder.
(1) Check the cylinder wall whether there is any rust or nick.
(2) Check the cylinder wall whether there is any abrasion or damage.
Note:
If necessary, clean or replace the brake master cylinder.
Tips:
Clean the assembled parts with compressed air.
6. Install the brake master cylinder.
(1) Fix the brake master cylinder on the bench clamp.
(2) Apply the lithium soap-base glycol lube on the rubber parts with arrow.
(3) Install # 2 and # 1 pistons, spring, piston guide block, cup and washer.
Note:
If angle appears in the installation process, it may cause damage to the cylinder wall. Be careful not to
damage the edge of the cup on the piston.
Brake System - Brake Master Cylinder Assembly 4-89

(4) Push the piston, and install the straight pin on the cylinder
body. (with ABS)

(5) Push the piston, and install the new washer and piston bolt.
Torque: 10N.m

(6) Push the piston, and install the snap ring with snap ring pliers.
(7) Install the O-ring on the brake master cylinder.

7. Install the Brake fluid reservoir.


(1) Apply the lithium soap-base glycol lube on the Brake fluid reservoir connector, and install it on the brake
master scylinder.
(2) Install the pin on the brake master cylinder with punch and hammer.

8. Check and adjust the vacuum booster push bar.


(1) Install a special tool on the brake master cylinder,and lower
the special tool mandril till it touches the piston.

(2) Mark the mandril top surface of the special tool with chalk.
(3) Overturn the special tool, and leave a clearance between the
special tool and the vacuum booster.

Tips:
If there is clearance between the special tool body and the booster hull, it means that the clearance is
standard value. If there is no chalk trace on the booster push bar, it means that the clearance exceeds the
standard value.
4-90 Brake System - Brake Master Cylinder Assembly

(4) Adjust the length of the vacuum booster push bar with the
special tool till the push bar touches the mandril head.

9. Install the brake master cylinder.


(1) Install the brake master cylinder on the booster with two bolts.
Torque: 13N.m

(2) Connect the two brake oil pipes to the brake master cylinder
with a special tool. (with ABS)
With ABS:
Torque: 15N.m
(3) Connect the three brake oil pipes to the brake master cylinder
with a special tool. (without ABS)
Torque: 15N.m
(4) Connect # 1 clutch storage tank oil pipe with clip. (Manual
transaxle type)
(5) Insert the brake fluid level alarm switch connector. Without ABS

10. Add the brake fluid to the Brake fluid reservoir.


11. Discharge the air in the brake master cylinder.
12. Discharge the air in the brake pipeline.
13. Check the level height in the Brake fluid reservoir.
14. Check the brake fluid whether there is any leakage.
Brake System - Vacuum Booster 4-91

Section 5 Vacuum Booster


Component View

Battery

#2 relay box, engine chamber

Return spring
Pin
Master cylinder
Vacuum tube
15 Clip 26

Clip
Without ABS
15
Push bar
U-connector
25
Vacuum booster assembly
Manual Transmission
#1 clutch fluid tank oil pipe Gasket
13 Fluid level indicator lamp connector

15 15

19

Clip

19 HECU assembly

Specified torque
Non-reusable parts
Lithium soap base glycol lube
4-92 Brake System - Vacuum Booster

Check
1. Check the brake booster.
(1) Air tightness check Good Poor

a. Start the motor, and shut it down after one or two minutes,
then step on the pedal several times slowly.
Tips:
If the pedal goes down greatly at the first step, but it gradually Positiom 3
Positiom 2
goes up after the second and third steps, it means the air Positiom 1
tightness is good.
b. When the motor is running, step down the brake pedal, and then shut down the motor.
Tips:
If the reserved distance does not change thirty seconds after
the pedal is stepped down, it means the air tightness is good.
(2) Operation check
a. When the ignition switch stays in OFF position, step on the
pedal several times, and then check that the reserved
distance should not change.
b. Step down the pedal, and start the motor.
Tips:
If the pedal goes down a little, it means the operation is ok.

2. Check the vacuum one-way valve.


(1) Check the vacuum one-way valve. ON OFF

a. Slide the clip to unfix the vacuum tube.


b. Remove the vacuum one-way valve.
c. Check the booster is ventilated to the motor.
d. In case of any failure, replace the vacuum one-way valve.
Brake System - Vacuum Booster 4-93

Replacement
1. Discharge the brake fluid.
Note:
Never spray the brake fluid on the paint surface, otherwise wash it immediately.
2. Unfix the clutch fluid tank pipe (manual transaxle).
3. Remove the brake master cylinder.
4. Remove the HECU assembly (with ABS).
5. Remove the vacuum booster.
(1) Unfix the vacuum tube from the brake booster.
(2) Remove the return spring, clip and pin.
(3) Remove the four nuts and U-clip.
(4) Pull out the vacuum booster and washer.

6. Install the vacuum booster.


(1) Install the vacuum booster and new washer.
(2) Install and fasten the vacuum booster nut.
Torque: 25N.m
(3) Install the return spring, clip and pin.

7. Install the vacuum booster push bar.


8. Install the brake actuator. (with ABS)
9. Install the brake master cylinder.
10. Connect the clutch fluid pipe.
11. Add the brake fluid to the reservoir.
12. Discharge the air in the brake master cylinder.
13. Discharge the air in the brake pipeline.
14. Check and adjust the height of the brake pedal.
15. Check the free stroke of the pedal.
16. Check the reserved distance of the pedal.
17. Discharge the air in the clutch tank pipe (manual transmission).
18. Check and adjust the clutch pedal (manual transmission).
19. Check the level height in the brake reservoir.
20. Check the brake fluid whether there is any leakage.
21. Check the clutch fluid whether there is any leakage (manual transmission).
4-94 Brake System - Front Brake Disc

Section 6 Front Brake Disc


Component View

88

Front disc brake cylinder


sliding pin Dust shield
Left cylinder support

88

Front disc brake


cylinder sliding pin #1 muffle pad

Dust shield #2 muffle pad

#2 muffle pad
Tube #1 muffle pad

8
Brake pad
Connector bolt
30 Brake pad
34
Left front disc
brake cylinder accessory
Support piece
Front brake pad I
Washer Support piece
Piston oil seal
Front brake pad II
Discharge screw
plug cap
Dust shield
34
Set ring

N . m : specified torque Front disc brake piston


Non-reusable parts
Lithium soap base glycol lube
Disc brake lube
Brake System - Front Brake Disc 4-95

Repair
1. Remove the front wheel.
2. Discharge the brake fluid.
Note:
Never spray the brake fluid on the paint surface, otherwise wash it immediately.
3. Remove the front disc brake cylinder.
(1) Remove the connector bolt and washer from the front disc
bake cylinder, and unfix the tube.

(2) Fasten the sliding pin on the front disc brake cylinder, and
remove the two bolts.

4. Remove the front brake pad package (only the pad).


(1) Remove the two brake pads with muffle washers.
(2) Remove muffle and heat isolation washers from the brake
pads.
5. Remove the support pad of the front brake pad.
Remove the two friction block from the brake cylinder support.
6. Remove the sliding pin of the front disc brake cylinder.
7. Remove the two dust shields
Braking Disc Cylinder Bracket
Remove the two dust shields from brake cylinder support.

Sliding Pin Dust Shields

8. Remove the left front disc brake cylinder support.


Remove the two bolts, and then take out the left front disc brake
cylinder support.
9. Remove the dust shield of the brake cylinder.
Remove the retaining ring and dust shield with screwdriver.
4-96 Brake System - Front Brake Disc

11. Remove the front brake piston.


(1) Put a piece of cloth or equivalent between the brake cylinder
and the piston.
(2) Blow the piston out of the brake cylinder with compressed air.
Warning:
In the blowing process, the finger shall not be placed before the
piston.
Note:
Don't spray the brake fluid.
12. Remove the piston oil seal.
Take out the oil seal from the brake cylinder with screwdriver.
13. Check the brake cylinder and piston.
Check the cylinder wall and piston whether there is rust or scar.

14. Check the lining thickness of the brake pad.


Measure the lining thickness with ruler.
Standard Thickness: 10.0mm
Minimum Thickness:1.0mm

15. Check the abrasion indicator steel strap of the front brake.
Make sure the abrasion indicator steel strap has adequate flexibility and has no deformation, crack or damage.
All rust, dirt and other impurities shall be cleaned out.

16. Check the thickness of the brake disc.


Measure the thickness of the brake disc with screw micrometer.
Standard Thickness: 20.0mm
Minimum Thickness: 18.0mm

17. Remove the front brake disc.


(1) Make mark on the brake disc and wheel hub.
(2) Remove the brake disc.

18. Install the brake disc.


Tips:
Install the disc at the minimum swing position.
Brake System - Front Brake Disc 4-97

19. Check the swing of the brake disc.


(1) Fasten the brake disc temporarily.
Torque: 103N.m
(2) Measure the swing of the brake disc at the 10mm from the disc
edge with a dial test indicator.
Maximum Swing: 0.05 mm
(3) If the swing of the brake disc reaches or exceeds the limit,
check the bearing's axial clearance and the wheel hub's swing.
If the bearing and wheel hub run normally, adjust the swing
of the brake disc, or finish it with onboard finishing machine.

20. Tighten the brake discharge bolt temporarily.


Tighten the brake discharge screw plug on the front brake cylinder temporarily.
21. Install the piston oil seal.
(1) Apply the lithium soap-base glycol lube on the new piston oil seal.
(2) Install the new piston oil seal on the brake cylinder.
22. Install the brake piston.
(1) Apply the lithium soap-base glycol lube on the brake piston.
(2) Install the piston on the front disc brake cylinder.
Note:
Don't tighten the piston into the brake cylinder forcefully.
23. Install the dust shield of the brake wheel cylinder.
(1) Apply the lithium soap-base glycol lube on the dust shield of
the new brake wheel cylinder, and install it on the brake
cylinder.
Tips:
Install the dust shield in the groove of the brake wheel cylinder
and piston reliably.

(2) Install the set ring with screwdriver.


Note:
Be careful not to damage to the dust shield of the brake wheel cylinder.

24. Install the left front disc brake wheel cylinder support.
Fasten the front disc brake wheel cylinder support with two blots.
Torque: 88N.m
25. Install the dust shield of the front disc brake bushing.
Apply the lithium soap-base glycol lube on the surface of the two new dust shields.
Install the two dust shields on the front disc brake cylinder support.
26. Install the sliding pin of the front dist brake cylinder.
Apply the lithium soap-base glycol lube on the surface of the two sliding pin and oil seal.
Install the two sliding pins on the front disc brake cylinder support.
4-98 Brake System - Front Brake Disc

27. Install the support piece of the front brake pad.


Remove the two support pieces of the brake pad from the front disc brake cylinder support.

28. Install the brake lining block component.


Note:
When replace the abrasion brake lining block, replace the muffle
pad simultaneously.
(1) Apply the disc brake lube on both sides of all muffle pads
(2) Install muffle pads on all brake lining blocks.
(3) The abrasion indicator face upwards. Install a inner brake
lining block, then install a outer lining block.
Note:
Don't apply the oil or lube on the friction surface of the brake pad and brake disc.

29. Install the front disc brake wheel cylinder.


(1) Install the front disc brake wheel cylinder with two bolts.
Torque: 34N.m

(2) Install the new washer and tube with bolt.


Torque: 30N.m
Tips: Fasten the tube in the lock hole of the brake wheel
cylinder reliably.

30. Add the brake fluid to the storage tank.


31. Discharge the air in the brake cylinder.
32. Discharge the air in the brake pipeline.
33. Check the level height in the storage tank.
34. Check the brake fluid whether there is any leakage.
35. Install the front wheel.
Torque: 103N.m
Brake System - Rear Brake Drum 4-99

Section 7 Rear Brake Drum

Component View

Discharge plug
Piston Discharge plug
Dust Dust shield
cover
Hole plug
Pin plug
Pin Piston
Cup
Spring
Cvlinder
Extension rod
Cup

Rear bake shoe


Left parking brake shoe pad post C-ring

Parking brake Locating spring


inhaul cable
Pin Baseboard

Return spring
Extension spring
Rear brake automatic Front brake shoe
adjustment rod

Adjustment rod spring Shoe pad positioning spring cover

Shoe pad positioning spring cover


Shoe pad positioning spring

N . m : specified torque
Rear brake drum
Non-reusable parts
Lithium soap base glycol lube
Heat-resistant lube
4-100 Brake System - Rear Brake Drum

Repair
Repair the right side as the steps in the left side.
1. Check the thickness of the brake shoe lining.
Remove the hole plug, and check the thickness of the brake shoe
lining through the hole.
If the thickness is less than the minimum thickness, replace a new
brake shoe.
Minimum Thickness: 1.0mm
2. Remove the rear wheel.
3. Discharge the brake fluid.
Note:
Never spray the brake fluid on the paint surface, otherwise wash
it immediately.

Rotate
4. Remove the rear brake drum.
(1) Loosen the parking brake rod, and remove the brake drum.
Tips: If the brake drum can't be removed easily, carry out the
following steps.
(2) Remove the hole plug, and insert a screwdriver through the
backboard to separate the brake automatic adjustment rod
and the adjustor.
(3) Rotate the adjustment wheel to reduce the length of the
adjustor with another screwdriver.
5. Check the inner diameter of the brake drum.
Measure the inner diameter of the brake drum with a brake drum
gauge or equivalent.
Standard Inner Diameter: 200.0mm
Maximum Inner Diameter: 201.0mm
6. Separate the left positioning post of the parking brake shoe.
Remove the extension spring from the front/rear brake shoe with
a special tool, and separate the left positioning post of the parking
brake shoe.
Note:
Be careful not to damage to the dust shield of the brake cylinder.

7. Remove the front brake shoe.


(1) Remove the end cap, set spring and pin with a special tool.
(2) Unfix the return spring, and remove the front brake shoe.
(3) Remove the left positioning post of the parking brake shoe.
Brake System - Rear Brake Drum 4-101

8. Remove the left brake automatic adjustment rod.


Remove the brake adjustment rod and its spring.

9. Remove the return spring of the brake shoe.


Remove the return spring from the brake shoe.
10. Remove the rear brake shoe.
(1) Prize the end cover with a special tool, and remove the set
spring and pin.

(2) Remove the parking brake cable from the parking brake
extension rod with a pair of pinchers.

11. Remove the parking brake shoe extension rod accessory.


Remove the C-washer and parking brake shoe extension rod with
screwdriver.

12. Check the thickness of the brake shoe lining.


Measure the thickness of the brake shoe lining with ruler.
Standard Thickness: 5.0mm
Minimum Thickness: 1.0mm
If the thickness reaches the minimum thickness or below, or
serious/uneven abrasion occurs, replace a new brake shoe.
4-102 Brake System - Rear Brake Drum

13. Check the brake shoe and the brake shoe lining whether they
touch normally.
Mark the inner surface of the brake drum with chalk, joint and
abrade the brake shoe and the inner surface.
If the drum and the lining touch poorly, abrade the brake shoe or
replace a new one.

14. Remove the left front or top brake wheel cylinder.


(1) Unfix the brake oil pipe with a special tool, and collect the
brake fluid with a container.
(2) Remove the bolt and brake wheel cylinder.

15. Remove the brake cup.


(1) Remove the two dust shields from the brake cylinder.
(2) Remove the two pistons and springs.
(3) Remove the two brake cylinder caps from every piston.
16. Check the brake cylinder.
Check the cylinder wall and piston whether there is any rust or nick.
17. Remove the rear discharge screw plug of the brake drum.
18. Tighten the rear discharge screw plug of the brake drum
temporarily.
19. Install the brake wheel cylinder cup.
(1) Apply the lithium soap-base glycol lube on the two brake
wheel cylinder cups and the piston.
(2) Install two brake cylinder caps on every piston.
(3) Install the compression spring and the two pistons on the
brake wheel cylinder.
(4) Install two new dust shields on the brake wheel cylinder.

20. Install the left front or top brake cylinder.


(1) Install the brake cylinder with bolt.
Torque: 9.8N.m
(2) Connect the brake oil pipe with a special tool.
Torque: 15N.m

21. Apply the heat-resistant lube.


Apply the heat-resistant lube on the touch surface of the brake
backboard and the brake shoe.
Brake System - Rear Brake Drum 4-103

22. Install the parking brake shoe extension rod accessory.


Install a new C-washer, and install the parking brake shoe
extension rod.

23. Install the brake shoe.


(1) Connect the parking brake cable to the parking brake
extension rod with a pair of pinchers.

(2) Install the brake shoe, pin, set spring and set spring cap with
a special tool.

24. Install the return spring of the brake shoe.


Install the return spring on the brake shoe.
25. Install the left brake automatic adjustment rod.
Install the automatic adjustment rod and its spring on the front
brake shoe.

26. Install the parking brake shoe post.


(1) Apply the heat-resistant lube on the adjustment bolt.
4-104 Brake System - Rear Brake Drum

(2) As shown in the figure, install the parking brake left post.
Braking Plate

parking brake left post

27. Install the front brake shoe.


(1) Install the return spring on the front brake shoe.
(2) Install the front brake shoe, pin, set spring and set spring cap
with a special tool.

28. Connect the parking brake shoe left post.


Connect the extension spring to the front/rear brake shoe with a
special tool.
Note:
Be careful not to damage to the dust shield of the brake wheel
cylinder.

29. Check the installation of the brake drum.


(1) Check all parts whether they are installed properly.
Brake System - Rear Brake Drum 4-105

(2) Measure the inner diameter of the brake drum and the
diameter of the brake shoe, and check the difference of them
whether it is a proper brake shoe clearance.
Brake Shoe Clearance: 0.3mm
Note:
Don't apply the oil or lube on the friction surface of the brake shoe
lining and brake drum.

30. Adjust the shoe clearance of the brake drum.


(1) Install two wheel hub nuts temporarily.
(2) Turn around eight teeth of the adjustor.
(3) Install the hole plug.

Extend

31. Install the rear brake drum sub-assembly.


32. Add the brake fluid to the storage tank.
33. Discharge the air in the master cylinder.
34. Discharge the air in the brake pipeline.
35. Check the level height in the storage tank.
36. Check the brake fluid whether there is any leakage.
37. Install the rear wheel.
Torque: 103N.m
38. Check the stroke of the parking brake extension rod.
39. Adjust he stroke of the parking brake extension rod.
4-106 Brake System - Parking Brake System

Section 8 Parking Brake System


Component View

Parking brake extension rod accessory


Parking brake switch component

Parking brake extension rod

Parking brake balance port


Inhaul cable #1 adjustment nut

#3 parking brake extension rod


Parking brake balance port

N . m : specified torque
Lithium soap base glycol lube
Brake System - Parking Brake System 4-107

Parking Brake System


The table below can help you find out the possible failure reasons. The number means the possible sequence
of the reasons. Check the parts, and replace the corresponding parts if necessary.

Symptom Suspected location


1. The stroke of the parking brake extension rod is misadjusted.
2. The parking brake inhaul cable is trapped.
Brake is blocked. 3. The clearance of the parking brake shoe is misadjusted.
4. The parking brake lining is cracked or deformed.
5. The return or extension spring is damaged.

Adjustment
1. Remove the rear wheel.
2. Adjust the clearance of the brake shoe.
3. Install the rear wheel.
Torque: 103N.m
4. Check the stroke of the parking brake extension rod.
Pull the parking brake extension rod, and count the number of sound.
Parking Brake Extension Rod Stroke: Pull with 196N force till 6-9 clicks.
5. Adjust the stroke of the parking brake extension rod.
(1) Remove the glove box cover.
(2) Turn #1 adjustment nut inhaul cable till the stroke is ok.
(3) Install the glove box cover.

#1 adjustment nut inhaul cable

Parking Brake Tension Rod Component


1. Remove the accessories of the console.
2. Remove the middle console.
3. Remove #1 adjustment nut wire.
Remove #1 adjustment nut wire.
4. Remove the accessories of the parking brake extension rod.
(1) Remove the connector of the parking brake extension rod
switch.
(2) Remove the two bolts, and remove the parking brake exten
sion rod.

5. Remove the parking brake switch component.


Remove the screw and parking brake switch component.
4-108 Brake System - Parking Brake System

6. Install the parking brake switch component.


Install the parking brake switch component with screw.
7. Install the accessories of the parking brake extension rod.
(1) Install the extension rod on the parking brake inhaul cable, and install #1 adjustment nut wire.
(2) Fasten the parking brake extension rod with two bolts.
Torque: 13N.m
(3) Connect the connector of the parking brake switch.
8. Install the accessories of the console.
9. Install the middle console.
10. Check the stroke of the parking brake extension rod.
11. Adjust the stroke of the parking brake extension rod.

Parking System Component

Brake shoe baseboard

Parking brake shoe Rear Brake shoe


Left positioning post

Left rear brake automatic Shoe pad set spring


Adjustment rod

Rear brake automatic adjustment Shoe pad set spring cap


rod spring

Shoe pad set spring Return spring


Rear brake shoe

Shoe pad set spring cap

Brake drum

Replacement
For left parking brake inhaul cable component, carry out the same steps as the right side.
1. Remove the accessories of the console.
Brake System - Parking Brake System 4-109

2. Remove the middle console.


3. Loosen #1 inhaul cable adjustment nut.
Remove #1 inhaul cable adjustment nut.
4. Remove the front floor extension rod.
Remove the two bolts to take out the front floor extension rod.
5. Remove the front exhaust pipe component.
6. Remove #2 front floor hot pad.
Remove the two bolts to take out the front floor hot pad.
7. Remove #3 parking brake inhaul cable component.
(1) Remove the four bolts to remove # 3 parking brake inhaul cable from the body.
(2) Remove #3 parking brake inhaul cable component from the parking brake balancer, and remove the inhaul
cable component.
8. Remove the rear wheel.
9. Remove the accessories of the brake drum.
10. Remove the front brake shoe.
11. Remove the left rear automatic adjustment rod.
12. Remove the rear brake shoe.
13. Remove parking brake inhaul cable component.
Remove the bolt, and remove parking brake inhaul cable
component from the baseboard.

14. Install parking brake inhaul cable component.


(1) Install parking brake inhaul cable component on the parking brake inhaul cable balancer.
(2) Fasten parking brake inhaul cable with four bolts.
Torque: 5.4N.m
4-110 Brake System - Parking Brake System

15. Install #3 parking brake inhaul cable component.


Fasten #3 parking brake inhaul cable component to the baseboard.
Torque: 7.8N.m
16. Apply the heat-resistant lube.
17. Install the brake shoe.
18. Install the return spring of the brake shoe.
19. Install the left rear brake automatic adjustment rod.
20. Install the front brake shoe.
21. Check the installation of the brake drum.
22. Install the accessories of the brake drum.
23. Adjust the clearance of the brake shoe.
24. Install the rear wheel.
Torque: 103N.m
25. Fasten #1 adjustment nut wire temporarily.
Install #1 adjustment nut wire.
26. Install #2 front floor hot pad.
Fasten #2 floor hot pad with two bolts.
Torque: 5.5N.m
27. Install the front exhaust pipe component.
28. Install the front floor extension rod.
Install the front floor extension rod with two bolts.
29. Check the stroke of the parking brake extension rod.
30. Adjust the stroke of the parking brake extension rod.
Electric System & Accessory - Starting and Charging System 5-1

Part V Electric System & Accessory


Chapter 1 Starting and Charging System
Section 1 Starting System (MR479Q MR479QA MR481QA)

I. Starter inspection
Note:
These tests must be completed within 5s, so as to prevent coil from burning out.
1. Electromagnetic switch test
(1) As shown in the figure, use wire to connect starter.
(2) As shown in the figure, connect electromagnetic switch with
storage battery.

(3) Disconnect exciting coil from binding post A.

Terminal 50 Terminal C
(4) Check whether clutch pinion moves outboard.
Battery
If clutch pinion does not move, replace electromagnetic switch.

(5) As shown above, connect battery, disconnect positive


pole (+) of battery from binding post, disengage
clutch pinion.

(6) Check whether clutch pinion returns.


If clutch pinion does not return, replace electromagnetic switch.

Battery Disconnect

2. Starter no-load test


(1)Connect field coil and binding post.
(2) As shown in the figure, connect ammeter and battery
to starter.
(3) When check whether clutch pinion moves outwards, starter
Battery
should rotate slowly and smoothly.
Terminal 50
(4) Check whether current reading of ammeter is normal or not. Ammeter
Normal current: less than 90 A at 11. 5 V Terminal 30
If current is abnormal, replace starter.
5-2 Starting and Charging System - Starting System

3. Wiring

Please Refer to "MK WIRING DIAGRAM"

(1) Check that connecting wire between positive pole of storage battery and starter must be firm and reliable,
outside shroud must be in good condition, so as to prevent generating electric spark and causing fire.
(2) Check whether wire is conducted, whether sheath is broken, if wiring harness is damaged, replace wiring
harness.

II. Starter assembly replacement (MR479Q, MR479QA, MR481QA)


1. Remove starter assembly
(1) Disconnect starter connector.
(2) Remove nuts, disconnect starter cable.
(3) Remove 2 bolts and starter assembly.

2. Install starter assembly


Installation should be conducted in reversed direction of removal
Torque:
Bolt 37N.m
Wire harness 9. 8N.m
Starting and Charging System - Charging system 5-3

Section 2 Charging system (MR479Q MR479QA MR481QA)


I. Battery
Maintenance-free battery is applied in this vehicle. Its termination voltage is 12V. It is connected inline by six
2V single cell in tandem with walls between every pole.
1. Battery warning signs

Be care of Read the Away from No smoke Wear protective Be care of


sulfuric acid instruction children glasses explosion

1 2 3 4 5 6 7

1- Danger of corrosion
The battery electrolyte is very corrosive. DO NOT overturn the battery.
2- Read the instructions for battery
3- Children are forbidden to touch the battery
4- Avoid fire, electromagnetic wave and strong light.
Avoid electric spark while repair; avoid short.
5- Wear protecting glasses
6- Danger of explosion
The explosive mixed gas will be produced while charging.
7- How to deal with a scrapped battery
The scrapped battery should be delivered to the collection station.

2. Battery removal and installation


Hint:
(1) The battery is not allowed to contact lubricating grease.
(2) The battery terminal is only allowed to be softly pulled out, in order to void damaging the battery.
Removal
(1) Remove the negative (-) ground cable
(2) Remove the battery positive (+) cable
(3) Loosen the fixing clamp on the battery.
Installation
Install according to the inverted order of removal.
Tighten the torque
Tighten the battery cable clip to 6N.m
Tighten the fixing clamp to 12N.m
5-4 Automobile Starting, Power Supply System - Charging system

II. Charging system inspection


1. Check battery working voltage
(1) After having driven the vehicle and in the case that 20 minutes
have not passed after having stopped the engine,turn the ignition
switch ON and turn on the electrical system (headlight,blower
motor) for 60 seconds to remove the surface charge.
(2) Turn the ignition switch OFF and turn off the electrical
systems. Then measure the battery voltage between the nega
tive and positive terminals of the battery.
Standard voltage: 12.5-12.9V at 20°C
Hint:
If the voltage is less than specification, charge the battery.
2. Check battery terminals, fuse box and fuse
(1) Check that the battery terminals are not loose or corroded.
(2) Check if fuse box and fuse for continuity.

3. Inspect drive belt


(1) Check the belt for excessive wear, frayed cords etc.
Hint:
If any defect has been found, replace the drive belt.
Cracks on the rib side of a belt are considered acceptable. If the
belt has chunks missing from the ribs, it should be replaced.

(2) Check that the belt fits properly in the ribbed grooves.
Hint:
Check with your hand to confirm that the belt has not slipped out
of the groove on the pulley.

4. Check alternator wiring


Check that the wiring is in good condition.
5. Listen for abnormal noises from alternator
Check that there is no abnormal noise from the alternator while the engine is running.

6. Inspect charge warning light circuit


Turn the ignition ON. Check that the charge warning light comes on. Start the engine. Check that the light goes
off.
Hint:
If the light does not work as normal, troubleshoot the charge warning light circuit.
Automobile Starting, Power Supply System - Charging system 5-5

7. Inspect charging circuit without load


(1) If a battery/starter tester is available, connect the tester to the
charging circuit as per instructions.
Ampere Meter
(2) If a tester is not available, connect an ammeter and voltmeter
Disconnect the Cable
to the charging circuit as follows. of B terminal
a. Disconnect to the wire from terminal B of the alternator
Battery
and connect it to the negative (-) pole of the ammeter.
b. Connect the positive (+) pole of the ammeter to terminal B
Alternator
of the alternator. Voltage Meter

c. Connect the positive (+) pole of the voltmeter to terminal B


of the alternator.
d. Ground the negative (-) pole of the voltmeter.
(3) Check the charging circuit
With the engine running from idle to 2,000 rpm, check the reading on the ammeter.
Standard amperage: 10A or less
Standard voltage: 12.9V-14.9V
8. Inspect charging circuit with load
(1) With the engine running at 2,000 rpm, turn on the high beam headlights and place the blower switch at "4".
Check the reading on the ammeter.
Standard amperage: 20A or more
(2) Hint:
If the ammeter reading is less than standard amperage, repair the alternator.
If the battery is fully charged, the indication value will sometimes be less than standard amperage.
III. Alternator inspection
1. Inspection of alternator

Bearing cover
Rotor
Bearing spacer

Bearing
Stator

Pully Bearing

Back end cover

Brush
IC Rugulator
Wire clip

Brush holder cover


Brush holder

Insulator at wiring end


Washer
Rectifier frame
Rectifier end frame
5-6 Automobile Starting, Power Supply System - Charging system

(1) Inspection of rotor winding


a. Check resistance value of rotor winding
Set multimeter on R x 1 position, so two meter pens may
contact with two slip rings of rotor.
Standard: 2. 7 - 3. 1 ohm
b. Rotor bow inspection:
Standard: radial wobble is less than 0. 5 mm
If abnormal, correct or replace rotor. Rotor winding inspection

(2) Stator winding inspection


a. Winding resistance value inspection
Set multimeter to R x 1 position, connect two meter pens
with any two leads of armature winding respectively. They
should be powered on, if resistance is infinitely great, there
is open circuit.
b. Winding earth inspection
Set multimeter on R x 1 position, connect a meter pen
with any lead of armature winding respectively, contact Armature winding earth inspection
one meter pen with stator core, if resistance is infinitely
great, it shows that armature winding insulation is good.
Otherwise repair or replace.

IV. Alternator assembly replacement (MR479Q, MR479QA, MR481QA)


1.Removel of Alternator
(1) Disconnect generator connector
(2) Loosen bolts A, B, C
(3) Loosen V-belt, remove generator.

2. Install generator assembly


Torque:
M 10 x 1.25 bolt 15 N.m
Tension adjustment of V-belt:
Deflection is about 10mm when belt middle part bears pressure of about 50N.
Combination Instrument System - Wiring diagram of Combination Instrument and Location of Multi-pin Plug-in Terminal 5-7

Chapter 2 Combination Instrument System


Section 1 Wiring diagram of Combination Instrument and
Location of Multi-pin Plug-in Terminal

1. Schematic circuit diagram of combination instrument (see the figure)


2. Distribution of digital combination instrument plug-in unit terminals

combination instrument

combination instrument

combination instrument
5-8 Combination Instrument System - Wiring diagram of Combination Instrument and Location of Multi-pin Plug-in Terminal

Wiring diagram of Combination Instrument

Please Refer to "MK WIRING DIAGRAM"


Combination Instrument System - Wiring diagram of Combination Instrument and Location of Multi-pin Plug-in Terminal 5-9

3. Definition of multi-pin plug-in unit terminal

Terminal Conductor Terminal Conductor


Definition of terminal Definition of terminal
number Color number Color

1 MIL C 10 NA
2 Engine oil pressure switch YG 1 P
3 Brake fluid GR 2 R
4 Park G 3 N
5 Right turn light GB 4 D
6 NA 5 2
7 EBD 6 L
A 8 Charge WR 7
9 NA 8 NA
10 NA 9 Sidelight GW
11 Safety belt YR 10 Start BR
12 NA 11 B+
13 Engine GY 12 IG ( + ) Y
14 Safety gasbag RY 13 GND
C
15 NA 14 NA
16 IG ( + ) 15 Speed sensor earthing B
1 NA 16 Speed signal input YR
2 Left turn light GW 17 Speed sensor power supply RY
3 High beam (+) RB 18 Key (ODO/TRIP) G
4 High beam (-) RW 19 Key (adjust brightness) YG
B 5 Foglight Gr 20 Key COM B
6 Rear defrost YB 21 Fuel gauge V
7 NA 22 ABS R
8 NA 23 Tachometer BBL
9 Door-lock warning lamp RBL 24 Coolant temperature gauge YW

1. Prompt:
R- red Bl- blue Y - yellow B- black P- pink G- green W- white
O- orange Gr - gray Br- brown V- purple Lg- olive drab
The first letter indicates primary color
The second letter indicates stripe color
5-10 Combination Instrument System - Malfunction Symptom Table and Troubleshooting

Section 2 Malfunction Symptom Table and Troubleshooting


I. Symptom table
The table below lists the typical malfunction symptoms of the combination meter. These malfunctions can be
troubleshot step by step in the section of the malfunction diagnosis.
Serial No. Symptom
1 The whole combination meter does not work
2 Speedometer fault
3 Tachometer fault
4 Water temperature gauge fault
5 Fuel gauge fault
6 Odometer fault
7 Instrument illumination fault
8 Instrument warning light fault

II. Specific troubleshooting steps


The entire combination instrument does not work (1) Check safety wire (refer to schematic diagram of
combination instrument)
a. Check GAUGE (10 A) safety wire in fuse box of instrument desk is on
b. Check AM 1 (30 A) safety wire in fuse box of engine room is on
c. Check MAIN (80 A) safety wire in fuse box is on
Result and measures: if there is any blowout, replace with a safety wire of the same capacity
(2) Check team whole instrument socket connector
a. Inspect continuity
Disconnect connector from combination instrument assy.
Check connection between terminals
Standard:
Tester connection Condition Standard condition
C13 - ground Normal ON

b. Check voltage
Disconnect connector from combination instrument assy.
Turn ignition switch to ON
Check voltage between terminals
Standard:

Tester connection Conditions Standard condition


C 12- ground Turn ignition switch to ON position 10-14 V
Combination Instrument System - Malfunction Symptom Table and Troubleshooting 5-11

Result and measures:


Normal, replace combination instrument assy.
Abnormal, repair or replace wiring harness or connector
2. Speedometer fails
Check
(1) Check combination instrument assy.
a. Remove combination instrument assy. , keep connection of connector.
b. Check on state
Check connection between terminals
Standard:

Tester connection Condition Standard condition


C 15-ground Normal ON

c.Check voltage between terminals


Standard:

Tester connection Conditions Standard condition


C 17- ground Turn ignition switch to ON position 7. 5-9V

Result and measures:


Abnormal, go to (2) Check combination instrument assy. speed input signal
Normal, go to (3) Check combination instrument assy.
(2) Check combination instrument assy. speed input signal
a. Check voltage
Prop up two front wheels
Push transmission lever to neutral position
Turn on ignition switch
turn front wheel slowly, measure the voltage between terminal C15 and terminal C16
Standard voltage is shown in the figure below:

Voltage changes alternatively

7.5-9V

Below 0.5V
0
Rotating wheel

Result and measures:


Normal, replace combination instrument assy.
Abnormal, check speed sensor
5-12 Combination Instrument System - Malfunction Symptom Table and Troubleshooting

b. Check speed sensor


Check on state
Check connection between terminals
Standard:
Tester connection Condition Standard condition
2- ground Normal ON

Check voltage between terminals


Standard:

Tester connection Conditions Standard condition


3- ground Turn ignition switch to ON position 7. 5-9V

Result and measures:


Abnormal, repair or replace wiring harness or connector
Normal, check speed sensor output signal
c. Check speed sensor output signal
Check voltage
Prop up two front wheels
Push transmission lever to neutral position
Turn on ignition switch
Turn front wheel slowly, measure the voltage between terminal 1 and terminal 2
Standard voltage is shown in the figure below:

Voltage changes alternatively

7.5-9V

Below 0.5V
0
Rotating wheel
Result and measures:
Normal, repair or replace wiring harness or connector
Abnormal, replace speed sensor
(3) Check combination instrument assy.
a. Remove combination instrument assy. , disconnect connector.
b. Check on status
Check connection between terminals
Standard:

Tester connection Condition Standard condition


C 13- ground Normal ON
Combination Instrument System - Malfunction Symptom Table and Troubleshooting 5-13

c. Check voltage between terminals


Standard:
Tester connection Conditions Standard condition
C 12- ground Turn ignition switch to ON position 7. 5-9V

Result and measures:


Abnormal, repair or replace wiring harness or connector
Normal, replace combination instrument assy.
3. Tachometer fails
combination instrument assy
Checkout procedure engine ECU

(1) Check combination instrument assy. rotating speed input Engine Speed Signal
signal
a. Remove combination instrument assy. , keep connection of
connector.
b. Connect oscillograph to terminal C23 and ground.
c. Start up engine

d. Check signal waveform


Standard:
Display correct waveform
Result and measures:
Normal, check and replace combination instrument assy.
Abnormal, check engine ECU rotating speed output signal

(2) Check engine ECU rotating speed output signal


a. Remove engine ECU ware, keep connection of connector.
b. Connect oscillograph to terminal ECU 8# pin and ground.
c. Start up engine
d. Check signal waveform
Standard:
Display correct waveform
Result and measures:
Normal, repair or replace wiring harness or connector
Abnormal, check revolution speed transducer and engine
control system
combination instrument assy
coolant Temperature Sensor
4. Water thermometer fails
Circuit diagram coolant Temperature Signal
5-14 Combination Instrument System - Malfunction Symptom Table and Troubleshooting

(1) Use diagnostic instrument to read engine water temperature value


a. Connect diagnostic instrument to diagnostic interface
b. Turn on ignition switch
c. Read water temperature value displayed on diagnostic instrument
Standard: the same as actual engine cooling water temperature
Result and measures:
Normal, water thermometer does not fail
Abnormal, check combination instrument assy.
(2) Check combination instrument assy.
a. Check resistance
Remove combination instrument assy. , disconnect connector.
Check connection between terminals
Standard:

Tester connection Conditions Standard state


C(60°C) 164.5±5 ohm
C 24- ground 1/2C(90°C) 56±3 ohm
H(115°C) 28.7±2 ohm

Result and measures:


Normal, replace combination instrument assy.
Abnormal, check water temperature sensor
b. Check water temperature sensor
Remove water temperature sensor and put it in thermostat.
Adjust temperature of thermostat and measure resistance value of water temperature sensor
Standard:

Conditions Standard state


C(60°C) 164.5±5 ohm
1/2C(90°C) 56±3 ohm
H(115°C) 28.7±2 ohm

Result and measures:


Normal, repair or replace wiring harness and connector
Abnormal, replace water temperature sensor
combination instrument assy
Fuel Sensor
5. Fuel gauge fails
Fuel Signal
Circuit diagram
Combination Instrument System - Malfunction Symptom Table and Troubleshooting 5-15

(1) Check combination instrument assy.


a. Check resistance
Remove combination instrument assy. , disconnect connector.
Check connection between terminals
Standard:

Tester connection Conditions Standard state


E 110±6 ohm
C 21- ground 1/2 32.5±3 ohm
F 3±2 ohm

Result and measures:


Normal, replace combination instrument assy.
Abnormal, check fuel sensor
b. Check fuel sensor
Remove fuel sensor.
Adjust the height of fuel sensor and measure its resistance value.
Standard:

Conditions Standard state


C(60°C) 164.5±5 ohm
1/2C(90°C) 56±3 ohm
H(115°C) 28.7±2 ohm

Result and measures:


Normal, repair or replace wiring harness and connector
Abnormal, replace fuel sensor

6. Odometer fails
Firstly check according to speedometer problem, if speedometer is normal, odometer fails, replace combina-
tion instrument assy.

7. Illuminating lamp fails

Symptom Suspected area


1. Brightness control switch
All illuminating lamps do not illuminate 2. Wiring harness or connector
3. Combination instrument
Only one illuminating lamp does not illuminate 1. Combination instrument assy.
5-16 Combination Instrument System - Malfunction Symptom Table and Troubleshooting

8. Warning lamp fails

Symptom Suspected area


Check that engine warning lamp does not 1. Wiring harness or connector
illuminate 2. ECM
3. Combination instrument assy.
Charge warning lamp does not illuminate 1. Wiring harness or connector
2. Alternator
3. Combination instrument assy.
Park braking warning lamp does not 1. Wiring harness or connector
illuminate 2. Manual brake switch
3. Combination instrument assy.
Brake failure warning lamp does not 1. Wiring harness or connector
illuminate 2. Brake fluid level switch
3. Combination instrument assy.
1. Wiring harness or connector
ABS warning lamp does not illuminate 2. ABS ECU or ABS warning lamp driving module
3. Combination instrument assy.
1. Wiring harness or connector
SRS warning lamp does not illuminate 2. Airbag ECU controller
3. Combination instrument assy.
Passenger's airbag indicator lamp does 1. Wiring harness or connector
not illuminate 2. Airbag ECU controller
3. Combination instrument assy.
High beam indicator lamp does not 1. Wiring harness or connector
illuminate 2. Front head light dimmer switch
3. Combination instrument assy.
Rear foglight indicator lamp does not 1. Wiring harness or connector
illuminate 2. Front head light dimmer switch
3. Combination instrument assy.
Rear defrost indicator lamp does not 1. Wiring harness or connector
illuminate 2. Rear defrost switch
3. Combination instrument assy.
Combination Instrument System - Malfunction Symptom Table and Troubleshooting 5-17

Symptom Suspected area


1. Harness or connector.
Front fog switch lamp does not illuminate 2. Front fog switch
3. Combination instrument assy.
Water temperature warning indicator lamp 1. Wiring harness or connector
does not illuminate 2. Cuolant temperature sensor
3. Combination instrument assy.
Safety belt warning indicator lamp does 1. Wiring harness or connector
not illuminate 2. Safety belt buckle switch
3. Combination instrument assy.
5-18 Combination Instrument System - Malfunction Symptom Table and Troubleshooting

III. Inspection on vehicle


1. Use speedometer detector to check indication error permitted by speedometer, check odometer service
condition.

Analog instrument (Km/h)


Instrument indication Displayed value of detector
20 17-23
40 35-40
60 55-60
80 75-80
100 95-100
120 114-120
140 133-140
160 152-160
180 171-180

Note:
Insufficient or too high tire pressure will increase error.
2. Check input signal
(1) Connect positive pole (+) of voltmeter with terminal C 16, connect negative pole (-) with terminal C15.
(2) When vehicle runs at 10km/h, check the voltage between terminal C15 and C16 of combination instrument
assy.
Standard: 7 high low level fluctuation waveforms per second.
Note:
To check, keep ignition switch in ON position, connector in on state
3. Check tachometer
Check service condition
Start up engine, use hand revolution counter for comparison.
Displayed value of hand revolution counter and indicated value of tachometer are shown in the table on
next page.
Analog instrument

Tachometer (r/min) Hand revolution counter (r/min)


800 740-860
1000 900-1100
2000 1850-2150
3000 2800-3200
4000 3800-4200
5000 4800-5200
6000 5750-6250
Combination Instrument System - Malfunction Symptom Table and Troubleshooting 5-19

4. Check fuel gauge


(1) Check resistance
Check resistance between C21 terminal and C13 terminal on combination instrument connector.
Standard:

Standard indication Resistance (ohm)


E 104-116
Reminder point 90-100
1/2F 29-35
F 1-5

Note:
To measure, disconnect the connector.

5. Check water thermometer


(1) Check resistance
When water thermometer indicates water temperature to red area, check the resistance between C24
terminal and C13 terminal on combination instrument connector.
Standard
Standard indication Resistance (ohm)
C 159. 5-169. 5
1/2H 53-59
Alarm point 26. 7-30. 7
H 20-24

Note:
To measure, disconnect the connector.
6. Check water temperature warning lamp
(1) Disconnect water temperature sensor connector.
(2) Turn ignition switch to ON, water temperature warning lamp should go out.
(3) Ground instrument connector C24 terminal, water temperature warning lamp should illuminate.
7. Check engine oil pressure warning lamp
Disconnect engine oil pressure transducer connector.
Turn ignition switch to ON, engine oil pressure warning lamp should go out.
Use conductor to short connector terminal to earth, engine oil low pressure warning light should illuminate.
8. Check engine oil pressure transducer
Disconnect connector from engine oil pressure transducer
Check connection between terminal and ground
Engine stall: on state
Engine running: off state.
5-20 Combination Instrument System - Malfunction Symptom Table and Troubleshooting

9. Check park warning lamp


(1) Disconnect connector from park switch
(2) Turn ignition switch to ON, park brake warning lamp should go out.
(3) Use conductor to short connector terminal to ground, park brake warning lamp should illuminate.
10. Check park switch
(1) Disconnect connector from park switch
(2) Pull up manual brake, check whether its terminal is connected with ground
Pull up manual brake: on
Manual brake release: off
11. Brake fluid level warning lamp
(1) Disconnect connector from brake fluid level sensor
(2) Turn ignition switch to ON, brake fluid level warning lamp should go out.
(3) Use conductor to connect its connector terminal wiring harness terminals directly, brake fluid level
warning lamp should illuminate.
12. Check brake fluid level warning switch
(1) Remove tank cap
(2) Disconnect connector from tank
(3) Check whether terminals are connected.
Floater on top: off
(4) Use sucker to suck out liquid from tank
(5) Check whether terminals are connected.
Floater down: on state
(6) Pour liquid back into tank
13. Rear defrost indicator lamp
(1) Turn ignition switch to ON, and start up engine
(2) Push down defrost switch, now rear defrost indicator lamp should illuminate
(3) Turn ignition switch to OFF, rear defrost indicator lamp should go out
14. Rear foglight indicator lamp
When rear foglight illuminates, rear foglight indicator lamp should illuminate, now A5 terminal should be high
potential.
15. Safety belt warning indicator lamp
(1) Disconnect safety belt switch connector from driver side, now safety belt warning indicator lamp should
go out.
(2) Short connector terminal to ground, safety belt warning indicator lamp should illuminate.
Wiper and Washer System - Wiper and Washer System Inspection 5-21

Chapter 3 Wiper and Washer System


Section 1 Wiper and Washer System Inspection

Remark:
The table below can help you find the causes of malfunction. These figures show the most possible
malfunctions in order of priority. Inspect each part in the order given. If necessary, repair or replace these parts.

Symptom Suspected Area


1. Wiper fuse
Front wiper does not work. 2. Wiper switch assembly
3. Harness
1. Wiper switch assembly
2. Wiper motor assembly
Front wiper in intermittent shift does not work.
3. Harness
4. Central controller
1. Wiper fuse
2. Wiper switch assembly
Front washer motor does not work
3. Wiper motor assembly
4. Harness
1. Wiper switch assembly
When the washer switch is placed ON, front 2. Wiper motor assembly
wiper does not work 3. Harness
4. Central controller
Washer fluid dose not jet out 1. Washer hose and nozzle
1. When the washer switch places on OFF, wiper
blade can not return, or stay in a wrong place. 1.Wiper motor assembly (The position of wiper arm)
2. The wiper blade scratches the body

II. Trouble shooting


1. Check work of washer pump
(1) Install washer pump on tank system, pour cleaning fluid into
the tank.
(2) Disconnect connector of washer pump.
(3) As shown in the figure below, connect No. 1 terminal of
washer pump with positive pole (+) of storage battery; con
nect No. 2 terminal with negative pole (-) of storage battery.
Check whether cleaning fluid flows from tank.
(4) If there is no outflow, replace washer pump.
5-22 Wiper and Washer System - Wiper and Washer System Inspection

2. Wiper, washer switch assembly


(1) Channel check
Check whether terminals on connector are on.

Standard:
Front wiper switch

Switch motion Testing terminal Specified state


MIST 8-10 ON
OFF 3-10 ON
INT 8-6 3-10 ON
LO 8-10 ON
HI 8-11 ON

Note: No. 2. and No. 4 terminals are always ON.


Front washer switch

Switch motion Testing terminal Specified state


OFF OFF
ON 8-7 ON

If in OFF state, replace switch


(2) Check work (washer switch)
a. Turn washer switch to OFF position.
b. Connect positive pole (+) of storage battery with No. 8 ON(10-14V)
terminal of connector,connect negative pole (-) with No.
2 terminal of wiper connector.Turn washer switch to ON
and OFF,measure the voltage between No. 8 terminal and
OFF(OV)
wiper motor connector No. 2 terminal.
Standard: see the figure in the left
If it doest not meet stipulation, replace the switch.

3. Wiper motor assembly


(1) Low speed gear inspection
Connect positive pole (+) of storage battery and No. 3
terminal of connector, connect negative pole (-) and No.
2 No. 2 terminal (E) of connector, check motor speed at
low speed gear.
If it does not meet stipulation, replace the motor.
Wiper and Washer System - Replacement and Adjustment 5-23

(2) High gear inspection


Connect positive pole (+) of storage battery with No. 4 terminal of connector, connect negative pole
(-) with No. 2 terminal (E) of connector, check motor speed at high speed gear.
If it does not meet stipulation, replace the motor.
(3) Automatic reset inspection
a. Connect positive pole (+) of storage battery with No. 3 terminal of connector, connect negative pole (-)
with No. 2 terminal (E) of connector. Rotate motor at low speed gear, disconnect No. 3 terminal (+) to
stop motor at any position.
b. Connect No. 5 terminal and No. 3 terminal, connect positive pole (+) of storage battery with No. 1
terminal, restart the motor at low speed gear.
c. Check whether automatic reset works normally.
If it does not meet stipulation, replace the motor.

Section 2 Replacement and Adjustment


I. Replace wiper motor assembly
1. Remove wiper motor
(1) Remove wiper arm doctor blade assembly
(2) Remove ventilation cover board

Nut
Nut cap

(3) Disconnect socket connector


(4) Remove wiper motor connecting rod assembly

Wiper Motor

Wiper motor connecting rod


5-24 Wiper and Washer System - Replacement and Adjustment

Fixed Bolt Loosen

(5) Remove 2 fixed bolts on wiper connecting rod


(6) Use special tool to uncouple motor crank arm shaft and wiper connecting rod
2. Replace with new wiper motor
(1) Use special tool to press motor crank arm shaft and wiper connecting rod into right position
(2) Fasten 4 bolts according to specified torque
(3) Connect socket connector
(4) Start wiper, spray cleaning fluid onto glass, check wiping state, whether original position of wiper arm is
normal, Otherwise remove wiper arm doctor blade assembly and make appropriate adjustment
Notes: crank arm shaft head of newly replaced wiper motor must always be filled with lubricating oil

II. Wiper blades replacement


1. Remove doctor blade of No. 1 and 2 wiper arm blade assembly
Remove doctor blade from No. 1 and 2 wiper arm blade assembly respectively

2. Replace new blade


Replace new blade No. 1 and 2 wiper arm blade assembly respectively
Wiper and Washer System - Replacement and Adjustment 5-25

III. Wiper switch assembly


Replacement
1. Detach steering wheel assembly
(1) Disconnect the main power source of the vehicle.
(2) Remove the passenger SRS module assembly, and cautiously put it in a safe place.
(3) Loosen steering wheel lock-bolts and remove the assembly.
2. Remove wiper switch

(1) Disconnect the connector.


(2) Remove the 2 tapping screws that are for mounting the wiper switch, take out the wiper switch from the
bracket of the combination switch.

IV. Washer nozzle


Adjustment
1. Inspect washer nozzle
(1) Start the engine, check if the position where the washer fluid from the nozzle sprays the windshield is in
the upper center wiped by the blades.
(2) Change the height (left/right) of the nozzle hole to adjust the point where washer fluid sprays the windshield.
5-26 Light System - Light System Introduction

Chapter 4 Light System


Section 1 Light System Introduction
I. Composition
Light system comprises external illumination and signal system and internal illumination system.
The function of the external illumination and signal system is to illuminate the road ahead and send signals
to other vehicles.
The internal illumination system provides internal illumination for driver and passengers.

II. Precaution for service


1. Precaution when repairing electrical equipments
Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Precaution when replacing a headlamp bulb
(1) Before replacing a halogen bulb, turn the headlamp OFF to make it cool.
(2) When installing a new halogen bulb, do not touch the glass part of the bulb with bare hands.
(3) If there is oil stain on the surface of halogen bulb (headlamp and front fog lamp) when the lamps are
turned ON, its service life will be shortened.
(4) Halogen bulbs (headlamp and front fog lamp) have pressurized gas inside and require special handling.
They can explode if dropped to ground. The glass fragments will splash up.
(5) When replacing, make sure to use the bulbs with the same power, same model.
(6) After the bulb is installed, make the lamp holder tight.

III. Bulb specifications


Name Specifications
Headlamp (High beam and Low beam) H1 12V 55W
Turn signal lamp PY21W 12V 21W
Position lamp W5W 12V 5W
Front fog lamp H3 12V 55W
Rear combination lamp (Turn signal lamp) PY21W 12V 21W
Rear combination lamp (Brake / Position lamp) P21/5W 12V 21/5W
Rear combination lamp (Rear fog lamp) P21W 12V 21W
Rear combination lamp (Back-up lamp) P21W 12V 21W
Interior lamp (dome lamp) R5W 12V 5W
Rear row reading lamp C5W 12V 5W
Side turn signal lamp W5W 12V 5W
High mounted stop lamp (incl. rear trunk lamp) W5W 12V 5W
License plate lamp W5W 12V 5W
Door courtesy lamp W5W 12V 5W
Remark: All bulbs are made by Philips Corp..
Light System - Light System Introduction 5-27

IV. Location of light system

Rear reading light

High-mount stoplight

Rear combination light

Rear Radar
Sensor

Rear license light

Front reading light ( power sunroof )

Front combination light

Side turn light

Front foglight
5-28 Light System - Light System Malfunction Inspection

Section 2 Light System Malfunction Inspection


I. Light system problem symptoms table:
Description:
The table below can help you find the causes of malfunction. These figures show the most possible
malfunctions in order of priority. Inspect each part in the order given. If necessary, repair or replace these parts.
1. Headlamp and tail lamp
Symptom Suspected Area
1. Bulb
"Low beam" dose not light (One side) 2. LH or RH headlamp fuse
3. Harness
1. Lamp switch assembly
"Low beam" dose not light (All)
2. Harness
1. Bulb
"High beam" dose not light (One side) 2. LH or RH headlamp fuse
3. Harness
1. Lamp switch assembly
"High beam" dose not light (All)
2. Harness
1. Lamp switch assembly
Light dose not flash (Dimmer)
2. Harness
1. Bulb
Headlamp is dim
2. Harness
1. Bulb
Only one side tail lamp lights
2. Harness
1. Fuse
Tail lamps on both sides do not light (Headlamp
2. Light control switch
is normal)
3. Harness
Tail lamps on both sides do not light (Headlamp 1. Beam control switch
is abnormal) 2. Harness

2. Front fog lamp system

Symptom Suspected Area


1. Fog lamp fuse
Front fog lamp dose not light up with light control 2. Front fog lamp relay
switch HEADLAMP (Head lamp is normal). 3. Light switch assembly
4. Harness
1. Bulb
Only one side front fog lamp dose not light
2. Harness
Light System - Light System Malfunction Inspection 5-29

3. Rear fog lamp system


Symptom Suspected Area
Rear fog lamp dose not light up with light control 1. Bulb
switch on FRONT FOG LAMP (Small lamp is 2. Light switch assembly
normal). 3. Harness
Rear fog lamp dose not light up with light control 1. Bulb
switch on FRONT FOG LAMP (Small lamp is 2. Tail lamp fuse
abnormal). 3. Harness
1. Bulb
Only one side rear fog lamp dose not light
2. Harness

4. Turn signal and hazard warning system

Symptom Suspected Area


1. HAZARD Fuse
"Hazard" and "Turn" does not work 2. Central controller
3. Harness
Hazard warning lamp does not work (Turn is 1. Hazard warning switch
normal) 2. Harness
Hazard warning lamp is abnormal (Hazard is 1. Turn signal switch
abnormal) 2. Harness
1. Turn signal switch
Turn signal dose not light up in one direction
2. Harness
1. Bulb
Only one bulb dose not light up
2. Harness

5. Brake lamp system

Symptom Suspected Area


1. Brake lamp fuse
Brake lamps on both sides do not light up 2. Brake lamp switch
3. Harness
1. Brake lamp switch
Brake lamp remains always ON
2. Harness
1. Bulb
Brake lamp dose not light (One side)
2. Harness
High mounted Brake lamp dose not light up 1. Bulb
(Stop lamp is normal) 2. Harness
5-30 Light System - Light System Malfunction Inspection

6. Back-up lamp system


Symptom Suspected Area
1. Back-up lamp fuse
Back-up lamps on both sides do not light up 2. Back-up lamp switch assembly
3. Harness
Back-up lamps on both sides remains always ON 1. Back-up lamp switch assembly
2. Harness
Back-up lamp dose not light (One side) 1. Bulb
2. Harness

7. Interior light system

Symptom Suspected Area


1. ROOM Fuse
Interior lamp dose not light (All)
2. Harness
1. Bulb
Room lamp dose not light up Rear row reading
2. Room lamp assembly
lamp assembly is normal
3. Harness
1. Door courtesy lamp switch
One door is ajar, room lamp dose not light up on
2. Central controller
DOOR, (It is normal on ON)
3. Harness
1. Bulb
Central LH/RH room lamps do not light up
2. Switch
1. Bulb
Rear row reading lamp is abnormal (Room lamp
2. Rear row reading lamp assembly
assembly is normal)
3. Harness

8. License light
Fault symptom Possible parts
License light does not illuminate (taillight is 1. Bulb
normal) 2. Wire harness

9. Trunk lamp

Fault symptom Possible parts


1. Bulb
Trunk lamp does not illuminate (room lamp is
2. Trunk lamp switch
normal)
3. Wire harness
Light System - Light System Malfunction Inspection 5-31

II. Lighting system troubleshooting


1. Headlight combination switch assembly

Headlight combination switch position drawing

Headlight combination switch shifting diagram


Terminal FU TL TR Terminal EL2 FF RF
Turn Handle position Foglight
Handle position
light R switch OFF
switch
NL FF

L RF

Terminal EL1 HL HU PASS Terminal


Handle position Handle position EL TNS HEAD
Headlight,
PASS small OFF
light
Light P
switch
switch HL

HU

(1) Check whether headlight light control switch is ON


Check whether terminals are connected when switch is in each position according to the table.

Switch position Testing terminal Status


OFF EL-TNS OFF
Position light EL-TNS ON
Headlight EL-HEAD ON
If it doest not meet stipulation, replace the switch.
5-32 Light System - Light System Malfunction Inspection

(2) Check whether headlight dimmer switch is connected


Check whether terminals are connected when switch is in each position according to the table.

Switch position Testing terminal Status


Low beam EL1-HL ON
High beam EL1-HU ON
PASSING EL1-HU-PASS ON
If it does not meet stipulation, replace the switch.
(3) Check whether direction indicator switch is connected
Check whether terminals are connected when switch is in each position according to the table.

Switch position Testing terminal Status


Left turn FU-TL ON
Straight ahead FU-TL-TR OFF
Right turn FU-TR ON
If it doest not meet stipulation, replace the switch.
(4) Check whether front and rear foglight switch is connected
Check whether terminals are connected when switch is in each position according to the table.
Switch position Testing terminal Status
OFF EL2-FF-RF OFF
Front foglight EL2-FF ON
Rear foglight EL2-FF-RF ON
If it doest not meet stipulation, replace the switch.
2. Reversing light switch assembly
Check whether reversing light switch assembly is connected
Check whether two terminals are connected when switch works
according to the table 1

Switch motion Testing terminal Status ON


ON OFF 2
1-2 ON
(gear lever is in reverse gear)
OFF 1-2 OFF
If it doest not meet stipulation, replace the switch.
3. Brake lamp switch assembly
Check whether brake lamp switch assembly is connected
Check whether two terminals are connected when brake lamp
Release Push
switch works
1 2
Switch motion Testing terminal Status
Step down brake pedal 1-2 ON
Release brake pedal 1-2 OFF

If it doest not meet stipulation, replace the switch.


Light System - Light System Malfunction Inspection 5-33

4. Danger alarm lamp switch assembly


Check whether danger alarm lamp switch is connected.
1
Check whether two terminals are connected when switch works.
Switch motion Testing terminal Status
ON 1-2 ON
2
OFF 1-2 OFF
If it doest not meet stipulation, replace the switch.
5. Door lamp switch (on fastener)
Check whether door lamp switch is connected
When switch works, check whether connection is established 1
between terminal and bodywork earthing.
Switch motion Testing terminal Status
ON (door is closed) 1- GND ON
OFF (door is not closed) 1- GND OFF

If it doest not meet stipulation, replace the switch.


6. Trunk lamp switch assembly
Check whether trunk lamp switch is connected
When switch works, check whether connection is established between terminal and bodywork earthing.

Switch motion Testing terminal Status


ON 1- GND ON
OFF 1- GND OFF
If it doest not meet stipulation, replace the switch.
7. Front reading light assembly (with power sunroof)
Check whether terminals of indoor roof lamp assembly are
connected
Switch motion Testing terminal Status
ON 1-2 ON
OFF 1-2 OFF

If it does not meet stipulation, replace roof lamp or switch.


8. Rear reading light assembly
Check whether back row reading light assembly is connected
When switch works, check whether two terminals are connected

Switch motion Testing terminal Status


ON 1- 2 ON
OFF 1- 2 OFF

If it doest not meet stipulation, replace the switch.


5-34 Light System - Headlamp Replacement

9. Front foglight relay


Check whether front foglight relay is connected
86
(1) Check whether terminals are connected
30 87
check terminal Testing terminal Status
86
86-85 ON
30-87 OFF

If it doest not meet stipulation, replace the relay.


(2) Apply storage battery voltage (10V-14V) between terminal 86 and 85, then check whether terminal 30 and
87 are connected, if not connected, replace the relay.

Section 3 Headlamp Replacement

I. Removal
1. Remove front bumper (see bumper replacement).
2. Remove 4 setscrews of front head light (as shown in the figure).

3. Remove electrical connector.

4. Move carefully forward, upward, remove front head light assembly.

Electrical connector

II. Installation
1. Install electrical connector of front head light assembly.
2. Install front head light assembly and 4 setscrews.
3. Install front bumper.
4. Adjust vehicle state.
5. Adjust front head light beam.
Light System - Front Fog Lamp Replacement 5-35

III. Replacement of front head light bulb

Remove dust shield by rotating anticlockwise


Pull out bulb plug
Press and loosen steel wire clip
Pull out lamp holder, take off bulb
Replace bulb
1-Turn light dust shield
2-Low beam dust shield
3-High beam, front position lamp dust shield

Section 4 Front Fog Lamp Replacement


I. Removal
1. Remove front bumper. (see bumper replacement)
2. Remove electrical connector.
3. Remove fixed bolt (as shown in the figure).
4. Remove front foglight assembly.

II. Installation
1. Install front foglight assembly.
2. Mount fixed bolt.
3. Mount electrical connector.
4. Mount front bumper.
5. Adjust vehicle state.
6. Adjust front foglight beam.

III. Replacement of front foglight bulb


1. Press and rotate anticlockwise, take off dust hood
2. Take out bulb
3. Replace bulb

IV. Adjustment of front foglight beam


1. Adjust tire pressure in standard value
2. Start up engine
3. Turn on foglight switch
4. Adjust foglight beam turn screw to adjust foglight beam in the vertical direction.
Description:
Turn screwdriver anticlockwise to make beam upward, or turn screwdriver clockwise to make it downward.
5-36 Light System - Rear Combination Lamp Replacement/High-mounted Stop light Replacement

Section 5 Rear Combination Lamp Replacement


I. Removal
1. Remove trunk weather strip and trim.
2. Remove 3 installation nuts (as shown in the figure).

3. Remove rear combination light electrical connector.


4. Pull out rear combination light assembly towards vehicle backside.

II. Installation
1. Mount rear combination light, mount 3 installation nuts.
2. Mount electrical connector.
3. Mount trunk trim.
4. Mount weatherstrip.

III. Replacement of rear combination light bulb


1. Take off seal ring
lamp
holder

2. Turn lamp holder anticlockwise, take off lamp holder


3. Take off bulb, replace bulb

Section 6 High-mounted Stop light Replacement

Disconnect the connector.


Remove the High mounted stop lamp in direction 1 and 2. (as shown Rear
above in the illustration) shelf

High-mount stoplight
Light System - Front Reading Lamp Replacement/Rear Reading Lamp Replacement/License Plate Lamp Replacement 5-37

Section 7 Front Reading Lamp Replacement

1. Use a screwdriver to slightly pry off lamp shade at position a (gap)


Lamp body
a
Lamp
shade

2. Use a screwdriver to remove two screws (be careful not to


contact bulb)
3. Disconnect the connector

Section 8 Rear Reading Lamp Replacement

1. Use a screwdriver to slightly pry off rear reading light


2. Use a screwdriver to remove two screws (be careful not to
contact bulb)
3. Remove the connector

Section 9 License Plate Lamp Replacement


1. Remove license light with a screwdriver from A & B point as
shown in the figure
A B
2. Change bulb
5-38 Audio System - Audio System Description

Chapter 5 Audio System


Section 1 Audio System Description
Description:
1. Radio wave band
Wave bands used in radiobroadcast are as follows:
Frequency 30KHZ 300KHZ 3MHZ 30MHZ 300MHZ
Wave band LF MF HF VHF
Radio wave AM FM
Modulation Amplitude modulation Frequency modulation
LF: low frequency MF: medium frequency HF: high frequency VHF: very high frequency

2. Area coverage
Scope of AM and FM broadcasting coverage area differs greatly.
Sometimes although AM broadcast may be received clearly, FM
binaural broadcasting cannot be received. Not only listening zone of
FM (stereo)
FM binaural broadcasting is small, but also static noise or other
FM (non-stereo)
cacophony (noise) tends to occur. AM

3. Receiving problem
Interference Ionosphere
Notes:
Besides static noise problem, there is also interference, multiplex
and attenuation. These problems are not caused by electric cacophony,
but the problem of radio wave itself.
(1) Interference
Besides static noise problem, AM broadcast tends to receive
other types of noise, especially at night. This is because ionosphere
reflects AM radio wave at night, these interference electric waves Multiplex
interfere with signals from the same signal source while entering into
vehicle antenna directly, this kind of noise is called "interference".
(2) Multiplex
Noise caused by radio wave reflected from barrier is called
"multiplex". When radio signal emitted by broadcast antenna is
reflected by high buildings or high mountains, and disturbs directly
received other signals, multiplex phenomenon occurs.
Attenuation
(3) Attenuation
Since its frequency is higher than AM, FM wave is more easily
reflected by high buildings or high mountains. Therefore, FM signal
often disappears gradually, or when vehicle is blocked by barrier, it
cannot receive any signal, such phenomenon is called "attenuation".
Audio System - Audio System Description 5-39

4. Noise problem
Detailed description of noise problem fed back by customers is of great importance for analyzing and
eliminating noise interference, the table below may be used for diagnosis.
Radio wave Noise condition Cause
Noise occurs in special position Most probably external noise
Broadcast from local station might broadcast the same
AM Noise occurs when receiving small
program. If program is the same, one of them might be
signal
disturbed
Noise only occurs at night Most probably from remote interference
FM Noise occurs in special position Most probably is multiplex interference due to FM
during driving frequency change

Notes:
If noise occurred does not belong to any of the above-mentioned situations, please find out the cause according
to "receiving problem".
5. CD phonograph
CD phonograph (hereafter referred to as CD) uses laser beam to read digital signals recorded on CD, then revert
to analog signal of music.
Notes:
Don't attempt to break down or apply oil to any component of the phonograph. Do not insert anything other
than a CD into optical disk cartridge.
Notes:
CD phonograph uses invisible laser beam, could generate harmful radialization, always operate phonograph
according to instructions.
6. Maintenance
(1) Cleaning of magnetic tape phonograph, magnetic head:
a. Open tape cartridge gate with your finger, use a pencil or a similar article to insert guider.
b. use cleaning pen or cotton swabs with detergent to wipe magnetic head surface, idler wheel or guide
pulley.
(2) CD phonograph, CD cleaning:
If CD is dirty, use soft cloth to wipe the surface from CD center radially outwards.
Notes:
Don't use ordinary recorder detergent or antistatic protectant.

Example: Magnetic head


Guide pulley

Idler wheel
5-40 Audio System - Audio System Connector Terminal Layout

Section 2 Audio System Connector Terminal Layout


1. Connector terminal layout on wire harness

Terminal No. Function Wire color Condition Standard Voltage


A1 FR+ Lg The audio system is on Wave form is synchronized with the output sound
A2 FL+ WB The audio system is on Wave form is synchronized with the output sound
A3 ACC RY Ignition switch turned to ACC 10~14V
A4 B+ R Constant Status 10~14V
A5 FR- LgR The audio system is on Wave form is synchronized with the output sound
A6 FL- W The audio system is on Wave form is synchronized with the output sound
A7 GND B Normal Status ON
A8 Null
A9 Mute V
A10 TAIL GW Position lamp switch turned to ON 10~14V
B1 RR+ PB The audio system is on Wave form is synchronized with the output sound
B2 RL+ YR The audio system is on Wave form is synchronized with the output sound
B3 RR- P The audio system is on Wave form is synchronized with the output sound
B4 Null
B5 Null
B6 RL- YW The audio system is on Wave form is synchronized with the output sound
C1 B+ Normal Status 10~14V
C2 BUS Audio system is On Pulse Signal
C3 GND Normal Status ON
C4 ACC Ignition switch ACC 10~14V
C5 Null
C6 R-OUT The audio system is on Wave form is synchronized with the output sound
C7 L-OUT The audio system is on Wave form is synchronized with the output sound
C8 GND(Audio Frequency) Normal Status ON
2. Connect terminal definition
Audio System - Audio System Inspection 5-41

Section 3 Audio System Inspection


I. Symptom analysis

Symptom Suspected Area


1. Radio assembly circuit faulty
The system doesn't work when power is ON.
2. Radio assembly
The radio backlight does not light up with the 1. Radio assembly backlight terminal
illumination switch ON 2. Radio assembly
1. Speaker circuit
Speaker soundless in all modes 2. Radio assembly power circuit faulty
3. Radio assembly
1. Speaker circuit
Poor sound quality in all modes (Volume faint) 2. Radio assembly power circuit faulty
3. Radio assembly
Unable to receive radio broadcast (poor 1. Antenna circuit
reception) 2. Radio assembly
1. Tape
The cassette could not be inserted or played 2. Radio assembly power circuit faulty
3. Radio assembly
1. Tape
Cassette tape will not be ejected
2. Radio assembly
Poor sound quality only when playing cassette 1. Tape
tape 2. Radio assembly
Tape jammed, malfunction with tape speed or 1. Tape
auto-reverse 2. Radio assembly
1. Wire between CD box and main unit
CD could not be inserted or ejected after in- 2. CD Player main unit power supply circuit fault
serted 3. CD box
4. CD Player main unit
1. Wire between CD box and main unit
2. CD box
CD player doesn't work even if power is on
3. CD bag
4. CD Player main unit
5-42 Audio System - Audio System Inspection

Symptom Suspected Area


1. Wire between CD box and main unit
2. CD box
CD can not be taken out
3. CD bag
4. CD PLAYER main unit
Sound quality poor only when playing CD 1. Wire between CD box and main unit
(Volume faint) 2. CD box
1. CD box
CD sound jump
2. CD box installation

II. Trouble shooting


1. Power switch system does
not work
Circuit diagram

Fuse Box under


Instrument Panel
Fuse Box in Engine
Compantment

MAIN
60A

(1) Check radio assembly (+ B, ACC, GND)


a. As shown in the table below, check connection between terminals in each operating condition.
Standard:

Tester connection Condition Standard state


GND and vehicle earth Normal status ON
b. As shown in the table below, check voltage between terminals in each operating condition.
Standard:

Tester connection Condition Standard state


+B and GND Normal status 10-14V
ACC and GND Ignition switch is in ACC or ON 10-14V
Abnormal, repair or replace wiring harness, connector
Normal, check and replace radio assembly
Audio System - Audio System Inspection 5-43

2. Turn on light switch, radio backlight


does not illuminate
Circuit diagram

lamp switch

(1) Check radio assembly (TAIL)


As shown in the table below, check voltage between terminals in each operating condition.
Standard:

Tester connection Condition Standard state


TAIL and GND Combination switch (light switch) 10-14V
Abnormal, repair or replace wiring harness, connector
Normal, check and replace radio assembly
3. Loudspeakers is silent in all modes
Circuit diagram

Please Refer to "MK WIRING DIAGRAM"


5-44 Audio System - Audio System Inspection

(1) Check LCD Illumination


a. Turn the ignition switch to ACC
b. Turn on radio assembly
c. Turn on the position light
Standard: The LCD indicator of the radio assembly goes on
Abnormal: go to step (7)
Normal: go to the next step
(2) Control volume and adjust the volume balance
Adjust the volume and its balance of the radio assembly to find out the inaudible speaker.
If all speakers are mute, check and replace the radio assembly
If individual speaker is mute, then respectively check and replace the inaudible speaker.
(3) Tweeter assembly inspection
a. Disconnect the speaker connector
b. Check the resistance
Notice:
Do not remove the speaker during inspection.
Standard Value: 4 ohm
Abnormal: Replace tweeter speaker assembly
Normal: Check wire harness and connector
(4) Check front speaker assembly
a. Disconnect speaker connector
b. Check resistance
Standard Value: 4 ohm
Abnormal: Replace front speaker assembly
Normal: Check wire harness and connector
(5) Check rear speaker assembly
a. Disconnect speaker connector
b. Check resistance
Standard Value: 4 ohm
Abnormal: Replace rear speaker assembly
Normal: Check wire harness and connector
(6) Check wire harness and connector
Abnormal Repair or replace wire harness and connector
Normal Check and replace radio assembly
(7) Check and replace radio assembly (+B, ACC, GND)
a. Check the continuity between terminals under each operating condition as shown in the table below.
Standard:

Tester connection Condition Standard Status


GND Normal ON
Audio System - Audio System Inspection 5-45

b. Check the voltage between terminals under each operating condition as shown in the table below.
Standard:

Tester Connection Condition Standard Status


+B - GND Normal 10~14V
ACC - GND Ignition switch ACC or ON 10~14V

Abnormal: Repair or replace wire harness and connector


Normal: Check and replace radio assembly

4. Unable to receive radio broadcast (poor reception)


(1) Check if the radio auto-research function works
Perform the radio auto-research function to see if it works
Normal: Check and replace radio assembly
Abnormal: Check the antenna for noise
(2) Check the antenna for noise
a. Turn on radio to AM with the ignition switch ACC.
b. Touch the antenna of the seated antenna assembly with the tip of the screwdriver.Check the speaker for
noise.
Standard: There is noise
Normal: Check and replace radio assembly
Abnormal: Check antenna assembly
(3) Check antenna assembly
a. Remove the antenna plug from the antenna assembly
b. Check for noise
Connect the radio assembly connector and turn the ignition switch to ACC.
Turn on the radio to AM
Insert a flat pan screwdriver or metal object similar to thin wire into the hole in the antenna coaxial
cable. Check the speaker for noise.
Standard: There is noise.
Normal: Check and replace radio assembly
Abnormal: Check and replace antenna coaxial cable sub-assembly

5. Cassette tape can not be inserted or played.


(1) Check for foreign object
Check the radio assembly and cassette recorder for foreign object or defect.
Abnormal: Clean foreign object
Normal: Check cassette tape
(2) Check cassette tape
Check if the cassette tape is used to record music or sound.
Replace the tape with another tape and re-check if it is faulty.
5-46 Audio System - Audio System Inspection

(3) Replace it with another tape and re-check


Replace the faulty tape with working tape to see if the same fault will re-occur.
Standard: The function is normal
Normal: The tape is faulty
Abnormal: Check if the radio auto-research function works
(4) Check if the radio auto-research function works
Perform the radio auto-research function to see if it works
Standard: The operation works.
Normal: Check and replace radio assembly
Abnormal: Check radio assembly (+B, ACC, GND)
(5) Check the radio assembly (+B, ACC, GND)
a. Check the continuity between terminals under each operating condition as shown in the table below.
Standard:

Tester connection Condition Standard Status


GND Nomal ON

b. Check the voltage between terminals under each operating condition as shown in the table below.
Standard:

Tester Connection Condition Standard Status


+B - GND Nomal 10 ~ 14V
ACC - GND Ignition switch ACC or ON 10 ~ 14V

Abnormal: Repair or replace wire harness and connector


Normal: Check and replace radio assembly

6. The tape doesn't eject


(1) Press "EJECT" and check the operation
Press "EJECT" of the radio assembly. Check if the tape ejects.
Standard: The tape is ejected.
Abnormal: Check and replace radio assembly
Normal: Check cassette tape
(2) Check cassette tape
Check the ejected tape for trademark peeled off or tape box distortion or other issues
Standard: There is nothing wrong with the tape
Abnormal: There is something wrong with the tape
Normal: Replace it with another tape and re-check
(3) Replace it with another tape and re-check.
Replace the faulty tape with working tape to see if the same fault will re-occur.
Standard: The fault is cleared
Normal: There is something wrong with the tape
Abnormal: Check and replace the recorder assembly
Audio System - Audio System Inspection 5-47

7. Poor sound quality only when playing tape


(1) Replace it with another tape and re-check
Replace the faulty tape with working tape to see if the same fault will re-occur.
Standard: The fault is cleared
Normal: There is something wrong with the tape
Abnormal: Check for foreign object

(2) Check for foreign object


Check the radio assembly and the cassette player for foreign objects or defects.
Abnormal: Clean foreign objects
Normal: Clean the magnet head and check operation

(3) Magnet Head Cleaning


a. Raise the cassette door with your finger. Next, using a pencil or similar object, push in the guide.
b. Using a cleaning pen or cotton applicator soaked in cleaner,clean the magnet head surface,pinch rollers
and tape press wheel.
c. Check if the same fault reoccurs.
Normal: The magnet head is dirty
Abnormal: Check and replace radio assembly

8. Tape jammed, malfunction with tape speed or auto-reverse


(1) Check for foreign objects
Check the radio assembly and tape player for foreign objects and defects
Standard: No foreign objects or defects
Abnormal: Clean foreign objects
Normal: Replace it with another tape and re-check

(2) Replace it with another tape and re-check


Replace the faulty tape with working tape (less than 90min) to see if the same fault will re-occur.
Standard: The fault is cleared.
Normal: There is something wrong with the tape
Abnormal: Clean the head

(3) Clean the magnet head


a. Raise the cassette door with your finger. Next, using a pencil or similar object, push in the guide.
b. Using a cleaning pen or cotton applicator soaked in cleaner, clean the magnet head surface, pinch rollers
and capstans.
c. Check whether the same fault re-occurs.
Normal: The magnet head is dirty
Abnormal: Check and replace radio assembly
5-48 Audio System - Audio System Inspection

9. The CD box can not eject after inserted


(1) Check if the CD box power supply is NORMAL
a. Turn the ignition switch to ACC
b. Check the continuity between the CD box terminals under each operating condition as shown in the
table below
Standard:

Tester connection Condition Standard Status


GND Nomal ON
c. Check the voltage between terminals under each operating condition as shown in the table below.
Standard:

Tester Connection Condition Standard Status


+B - GND Nomal 10~14V
ACC - GND Ignition switch ACC or ON 10~14V

Normal: Replace CD, DVD box


Abnormal: Check if the head unit side C socket voltage output is NORMAL
(2) Check if the head unit side C socket voltage output is NORMAL _
a. Turn the ignition switch to ACC
b. Check the continuity between the magnet head unit C socket terminals under each operating condition
as shown in the table below
Standard:

Tester connection Condition Standard Status


GND Nomal ON

c. Check the voltage between terminals under each operating condition as shown in the table below.
Standard:

Tester Connection Condition Standard Status


+B - GND Nomal 10 ~ 14V
ACC - GND Ignition switch ACC or ON 10 ~ 14V

Normal: Replace the signal wire connecting magnet head unit and CD box
Abnormal: Check the radio assembly (+B, ACC, GND)
(3) Check the radio assembly (+B, ACC, GND)
a. Check the continuity between terminals under each operating condition as shown in the table below.
Standard:

Tester connection Condition Standard Status


GND Nomal ON
Audio System - Audio System Inspection 5-49

b. Check the voltage between terminals under each operating condition as shown in the table below.
Standard:
Tester Connection Condition Standard Status
+B - GND Nomal 10~14V
ACC - GND Ignition switch ACC or ON 10~14V

Abnormal: Repair or replace wire harness and connector


Normal: Check and replace radio assembly

10. Power coming in, but CD player doesn't work.


(1) Press CD player OPEN to see if CD ejects.
No: CD does not eject for inspection after being inserted
Yes: Check if the right CD is inserted
(2) Check if the proper CD is inserted
a. Check if the proper CD is inserted
b. Make sure the working CD is music and it is not distorted, cracked, dirty, scratched or defected.
Standard: Working music CD
Description:
Semi-transparent CD or CD of strange shape can not be played.
Music CD recorded in PC CD-ROM and recorded CD-R can not be played.
Adapter is not needed to play 8cm CD.
Abnormal: There is something wrong with CD
Normal: Check and insert a proper CD
(3) Check and insert a proper CD
a. Check and insert a proper CD
b. Check if CD is installed in reverse order.
Standard: Not installed in reverse order
Abnormal: Install the disc correctly
Normal: Clean the disc
(4) Clean the CD
If the CD is dirty, use soft cloth to wipe the CD surface in the arrow direction.
Notice:
Do not use cleanser for normal radio or anti-static-electricity repellent to clean the CD.
Normal: Dirty CD
Abnormal: Replace it with another CD and recheck it
5-50 Audio System - Audio System Inspection

(5) Replace it with another CD and re-check.


Replace the faulty CD with working CD to see if the same fault re-occurs.
Standard: The fault is cleared
Abnormal: There is something wrong with CD
Normal: Check if the radio auto-research function works
(6) Check if the radio auto-research function works
Perform the radio auto-research function
Standard: The fault is cleared.
Abnormal: Go to Step (9)
Normal: Has sudden temperature change occurred inside vehicle?
(7) Has sudden temperature change occurred inside vehicle
Check if sudden temperature change has occurred inside vehicle
Standard: Sudden temperature change has occurred inside vehicle.
Description:
Formulation of dew condensation inside the CD player is due to temperature changes. CD may not play.
Abnormal: Formulation of dew condensation due to temperature changes (Leave it for a while before using it)
Normal: Check the signal wire between the radio and disc box
(8) Check the signal wire for short circuit or open circuit.
Yes Replace the signal wire
No Replace the disc box
(9) Replace the disc box
Standard: The faulty is cleared
Normal: Box faulty
Abnormal: Check the radio assembly (+B, ACC, GND)
(10) Check the radio assembly (+B, ACC, GND)
a. Check the continuity between terminals under each operating condition as shown in the table below.
Standard:
Tester connection Condition Standard Status
GND Nomal ON
b. Check the voltage between terminals under each operating condition as shown in the table below
Standard:

Tester Connection Condition Standard Status


+B - GND Nomal 10~14V
ACC - GND Ignition switch ACC or ON 10~14V

Abnormal: Repair or replace wire harness and connector


Normal: Check and replace radio assembly

11. Sound quality poor only when playing CD (Volume faint)


(1) Replace it with another CD and re-check
Normal: CD failure
Audio System - Audio System Inspection 5-51

Abnormal: Replace the disc box


(2) Replace the disc box
Normal: Box damaged
Abnormal: Check and replace radio assembly

12. CD sound jump


(1) Disc cleaning
If the disc gets dirty, clean the disc by wiping the surface from the center to outside in the radial directions
with a soft cloth.
Notice:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or anti--static preservative.
Standard: The fault is cleared.
Normal: The disc is dirty
Abnormal: Replace it with another CD and re-check.
(2) Replace it with another CD and re-check. Standard: The fault is cleared.
Normal: CD failure
Abnormal: Check when it will happen
(3) Check when it will happen
Check where sound jump will happen Standard: Drive on bumpy road
Normal: Replace CD box
Abnormal: Compare with other vehicles of the same model
(4) Compare with other vehicles of the same model
Compare with other vehicles of the same model of no fault. Check for any difference when faulty occurs.
Standard: No difference is found.
Normal: Make sure there is no difference
Abnormal: Check CD box installation
(5) Check CD box installation
Check CD box installation
Standard: Installation correct
Abnormal: Install CD box correctly
Normal: Has sudden temperature change occurs inside the disk cabin?
(6) Has sudden temperature change occurs inside the disk cabin?
Check if sudden temperature change occurs inside the disk cabin?
Standard: Sudden temperature change occurs inside the disk cabin.
Description: Formulation of dew condensation inside the CD player is due to temperature changes. CD may
not play.
Normal: Formulation of dew condensation due to temperature changes (Leave it for a while before
using it)
Abnormal: Check and replace CD box
5-52 Audio System - Audio System Replacement

Section 4 Audio System Replacement


I. Notice on operation
Please explain to the customer that the AM/FM broadcast channel information will be cleared when removing
the battery negative terminal cable. Record the channel information before removing the negative terminal cable
if necessary. Reset after connecting the negative terminal cable.
All cassette tapes and CDs must be taken out before radio removal and installation.
If the cassette tapes and CDs can not be taken out due to radio fault. Do not take them out by force. Drive the
vehicle to Service Station.
Make sure the grounding bolts are tightened before antenna removal and installation.
There will be noise when receiving electric wave if the grounding bolts are not tightened.
Don't touch the speaker cone.

II. Radio assembly


1. Remove middle instrument board (see internal decorations)
2. Remove radio with bracket assembly
a. Remove four screws
b. Disconnect connector
3. Remove left bracket
a. Remove four screws
4. Remove right bracket
a. Remove four screws
5. Remove radio assembly

III. Front loudspeaker assembly


1. Remove door handhold
2. Remove front door electric piovted window switch assembly
3. Remove front door decorative internal plate assembly
4. Remove front door 5 inch loudspeaker assembly
a. Disconnect connector
b. Avert 3 rivets using a bit less than 4 mm (place bit in center
of rivet to bore out flange, be careful that newly cut rivet is
hot), take down loudspeaker assembly.

IV. Tweeter assembly


1. Remove door handhold
2. Remove front door electric piovted window switch assembly
3. Remove front door decorative internal plate assembly
4. Remove front door tweeter assembly
a. Disconnect connector
b. Remove two tapping screws and speaker assembly
Audio System - Audio System Replacement 5-53

V. Rear loudspeaker assembly


1. Remove rear loudspeaker shelf
2. Remove rear loudspeaker assembly
a. Disconnect connector
b. Remove three tapping screws and loudspeaker assembly

VI. Remove antenna conductor (Retractable antenna)


1. Remove vehicle ceiling internal decorations
2. Remove A column decorative board
3. Disconnect connector
4. Remove instrument desk
5. Remove wire clip and antenna conductor

VII. Multi-disc Exchanger


1. Remove left trunk internal decorations
2. Disconnect connector
3. Remove four bolts and exvhanger
5-54 SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information

Chapter 6 SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)


Section 1 SRS-General Information
I. Precaution for service
For safe reasons, read the following precaution before starting any operation.
1. When servicing the SRS, correct sequence and items are described in the following chapter.
2. Instruments and special tools recommended in this chapter shall be used for operation.
3. When servicing the following components, replace them with the new ones if there is a failure.
(1) SRS ECU
(2) Clock Spring Module
(3) Driver Airbag Module
(4) Passenger Airbag Assembly
(5) Front Seat Belt Pretensioner
4. If there is any abnormality in the wire harness of the SRS, replace it with a new one. Correct or replace the
abnormal wire harness in accordance with Table 1.
pin15 pin1

pin29 pin16

ECU Terminal Description


No Designation
1 Belt-pretensioner, Driver, Low
2 Belt-pretensioner, Driver, High
3 Belt-pretensioner, Passenger, High
4 Belt-pretensioner, Passenger, Low
5 IGN
6 GND
7 WL
9 K
10 DAB Hi
11 DAB Lo
13 (Optional) PAB Hi
14 (Optional) PAB Lo
27 Crash Output

5. Servicing operation shall be carried out 60s after the negative(-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery.
In addition, the disconnected negative (-) terminal cable shall be protected with insulating tape for insulation. In
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information 5-55

order to deploy an airbag within a certain time period after the battery Insulation Band
Battery
is disconnected, condenser in the ECU shall retain some electrical
energy. Otherwise, it could lead to a serious accident because of the
unexpected deployment of airbag.

Cable
6. During spray paint work, ECU, airbag assembly, clock
springassembly, etc shall be removed and kept in place to avoid the SRS Air Bag
effects of overheat. (Over 93) Warning Light
7. When the SRS is serviced, a diagnostic scan meter is used to clear
the DTC to enable the normal work ofthe warning light.

II. Test instrument


Instrument Designation Usage
Diagnostic detector (Hi-DS T Scan meter) Check system troubles of the SRS,
Special diagnostic meter and clear the DTC of ECU

III. Troubleshooting
1. Basic process of trouble diagnosis
DTC of the present fault may coexist with that of the history fault.
Notice:
After the new SRS ECU is installed, the warning light of the SRS, with the ignition switch ON, will be on
for 4s and then go out permanently, indicating SRS works normal. In this case, no service is needed. Otherwise,
system diagnosis and service shall be carried out.
If with the ignition switch ON, the warning light of the SRS is not on, the relevant circuits of the warning
light shall be serviced. Then go on with the operation and enable it to work.
Warning light con-
use scanner find out the trouble troubleshooting trouble eliminated
stantly goes on

Check SRS warning light (see the right figure) SRS Air Bag
(1) Turn the ignition switch ON and find out whether the warning Warning Light
light is on.
(2) 4 seconds after the process of ON-OFF, confirm that the
warning light goes out permanently.
(3) Otherwise, diagnosis and checking have to be involved in.

2. System Diagnosis
The SRS ECU will perform a series of circular diagnostic tests to check the readiness of the SRS functions.
This test can avoid unexpected explosion of the restrain system and in the same time ensure the necessary explosion
in a crash. If a trouble is detected, the SRS ECU will store a proper DTC and turn on the warning light indicating
a trouble for service.
5-56 SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information

3. Trouble Identification
Trouble Record (DTC storage)
Each DTC consists of two bytes, indicating current problem or occurred problem. 93CX or 93DX indicates
current problem while 938X or 939X indicates occurred problem. Current problem can not be cancelled, even if
it is cancelled at that time, it will reoccur after initialization or a cycle of self-check. You have to make analysis
on the causes and perform troubleshooting.
The DTC is transmitted by the diagnostic scan tool instructed by ECU through the serial data interface of the
program.
No. Problem Description DTC Code
1 There are problems in the Airbag ECU 93C1
2 The power supply voltage of the Airbag ECU is too high 93C2
3 The power supply voltage of the Airbag ECU is too low 93C3
4 The drive side airbag module resistance is too high 93C4
5 The drive side airbag module resistance is too low 93C5
6 The drive side airbag module is short to ground 93C6
7 The drive side airbag module is short to power supply 93C7
8 The passenger side airbag module resistance is too high 93C8
9 The passenger side airbag module resistance is too low 93C9
10 The passenger side airbag module is short to ground 93CA
11 The passenger side airbag module is short to power supply 93CB
12 The driver side pretensioner seat belt resistance is too high 93CC
13 The driver side pretensioner seat belt resistance is too low 93CD
14 The driver side pretensioner seat belt resistance is short to ground 93CE
15 The driver side pretensioner seat belt resistance is short to power supply 93CF
16 The passenger side pretensioner seat belt resistance is too high 93D0
17 The passenger side pretensioner seat belt resistance is too low 93D1
18 The passenger side pretensioner seat belt resistance is short to ground 93D2
19 The passenger side pretensioner seat belt resistance is short to power supply 93D3
20 Airbag ECU warning light is short to ground or warning light wire harness is disconnected 93D4
21 Airbag ECU warning light is short to power supply 93D5
22 There are problems in the configuration of the airbag ECU 93D6
The impact signal output interface of the airbag ECU is short to ground or the impact
23 93D7
output circuit is disconnected.

(1) The airbag controller has internal problem (DTC 93C1): when using diagnostic scan tool to test the airbag
controller, if the DTC code is 93C1, it indicates that there are problems in the controller.
Step Operation Yes No
1 When using the scan tool to test the controller, is the DTC 93C1? Go to step 2 other
2 Use new controller to replace faulty controller Go to step 3
3 After the ignition switch is closed, the warning light shall goes off. Go to step 4 Go to step 1
4 The fault has been removed, use the scan tool to eliminate the DTC.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information 5-57

(2) The power supply voltage is too high (DTC 93C2)

Step Operation Yes No


1 When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, is the DTC 93C2? Go to step 2 other
2 Shut off the power supply, check whether the power supply voltage is high? Go to step 4 Go to step 3
3 Check the connection of the airbag ECU power supply wire harness. Go to step 4
After the troubleshooting, switch on the power supply, observe the status
4 of the warning light. The warning light shall goes off after lighting up for Go to step 5 Go to step 1
4 seconds (self-check).
5 The fault has been removed, use the scan tool to eliminate the DTC.
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93C2, indicating that the airbag ECU power supply
voltage is too high, the voltage is higher than 18V.

Step Operation Yes No


1 When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, is the DTC 93C3? Go to step 2 other
2 Shut off the power supply, check whether the power supply voltage is low? Go to step 4 Go to step 3
Analyze the causes of low power supply voltage, check whether the power
3 Go to step 4
supply of the airbag ECU is low? (check the connection of the wire harness)
After the troubleshooting, switch on the power supply,observe the status of
4 the warning light. The warning light shall goes off after lighting up for 4 Go to step 5 Go to step 1
seconds (self-check).
5 The fault has been removed, use the scan tool to eliminate the DTC.
(3) The power supply voltage is too low (DTC 93C3)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93C3, indicating that the airbag ECU power supply
voltage is too low, the voltage is lower than 8.5V.
(4) The drive side airbag module resistance is too high (DTC 93C4)

Step Operation Yes No


1 When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, is the DTC 93C4? Go to step 2 other
Shut off the power supply, check whether the connector of the airbag
2 controller is well plugged (whether the wire harness connector is in good Go to step 3 Go to step 6
condition)?
Disconnect the battery negative cable for 30 seconds, check whether the
3 driver side front airbag module is well connected? Whether the clock spring Go to step 4 Go to step 6
is well connected? (whether the wire harness connector is in good condition)

4 Whether the driver side front airbag module resistance is ok? Go to step 5 Go to step 6
5 Whether the clock spring is ok? Go to step 6
After the troubleshooting, switch on the power supply, observe the status
6 of the warning light. The warning light shall goes off after lighting up for Go to step 7 Go to step 1
4 seconds (self-check).
7 The fault has been removed, use the scan tool to eliminate the DTC.
5-58 SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information

When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93C4, indicating that the driver side front airbag
module resistance is too high, the resistance is higher than 7.0 ohm.
(5) The drive side airbag module resistance is too low (DTC 93C5)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93C5, indicating that the driver side airbag module
resistance is too low, the resistance is lower than 2.1 ohm.

Step Operation Yes No


1 When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, is the DTC 93C5? Go to step 2 other
Shut off the power supply, check whether the connector of the airbag
2 controller is well plugged (whether the wire harness connector is in good Go to step 3 Go to step 6
condition)?
Disconnect the battery negative cable for 30 seconds, check whether the
3 driver side front airbag module is well connected? Whether the clock spring Go to step 4 Go to step 6
is well connected? (whether the wire harness connector is in good condition)

4 Whether the driver side airbag module resistance is ok? Go to step 5 Go to step 6
5 Whether the clock spring is ok? Go to step 6
After the troubleshooting, switch on the power supply, observe the status
6 of the warning light. The warning light shall goes off after lighting up for Go to step 7 Go to step 1
4 seconds (self-check).
7 The fault has been removed, use the scan tool to eliminate the DTC.

(6) The drive side airbag module is short to ground (DTC 93C6)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93C6, indicating that the driver side airbag module
is short to ground, the resistance is lower than 6.5K ohm.

Step Operation Yes No


1 When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, is the DTC 93C6? Go to step 2 other
Shut off the power supply, check whether the connector wire harness of
2 Go to step 3 Go to step 5
the airbag ECU is in good condition?
Disconnect the battery negative cable for 60 seconds, check whether the
3 Go to step 4 Go to step 5
connector wire harness of driver side airbag module is in good condition?
4 Whether the clock spring is ok? Go to step 5
After the troubleshooting, switch on the power supply, observe the status
5 of the warning light. The warning light shall goes off after lighting up for Go to step 6 Go to step 1
4 seconds (self-check).
6 The fault has been removed, use the scan tool to eliminate the DTC.

(7) The drive side airbag module is short to power supply (DTC 93C7)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93C7, indicating that the driver side airbag module
is short to power supply, the resistance is lower than 21K ohm.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information 5-59

Step Operation Yes No


1 When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, is the DTC 93C7? Go to step 2 other
Shut off the power supply, check whether the connector wire harness of
2 Go to step 3 Go to step 5
the airbag ECU is in good condition?
Disconnect the battery negative cable for 30 seconds, check whether the
3 Go to step 4 Go to step 5
connector wire harness of driver side airbag module is in good condition?
4 Whether the clock spring is ok? Go to step 5
After the troubleshooting, switch on the power supply, observe the status of the warning
5 Go to step 6 Go to step 1
light. The warning light shall goes off after lighting up for 4 seconds (self-check).
6 The fault has been removed, use the scan tool to eliminate the DTC.

(8) The passenger side airbag module resistance is too high (DTC 93C8)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93C8, indicating that the passenger side airbag
module resistance is too high, the resistance is higher than 4.5 ohm.

Step Operation Yes No


1 When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, is the DTC 93C8? Go to step 2 other
Shut off the power supply, check whether the connector of the airbag ECU
2 Go to step 3 Go to step 5
is well plugged (whether the wire harness connector is in good condition)?
Disconnect the battery negative cable for 30 seconds, check whether the
3 passenger side airbag module is well connected? (whether the wire Go to step 4 Go to step 5
harness connector is in good condition)
4 Whether the passenger side airbag module resistance is ok? Go to step 5
After the troubleshooting, switch on the power supply, observe the status of the warning
5 Go to step 6 Go to step 1
light. The warning light shall goes off after lighting up for 4 seconds (self-check).
6 The fault has been removed, use the scan tool to eliminate the DTC.
(9) The passenger side airbag module resistance is too low
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93C9, indicating that the passenger side airbag
module resistance is too low, the resistance is lower than 1.2 ohm.

Step Operation Yes No


1 When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, is the DTC 93C9? Go to step 2 other
Shut off the power supply, check whether the connector of the airbag ECU
2 Go to step 3 Go to step 5
is well plugged (whether the wire harness connector is in good condition)?
Disconnect the battery negative cable for 30 seconds, check whether the
3 passenger side airbag module is well connected? (whether the wire Go to step 4 Go to step 5
harness connector is in good condition)
4 Whether the passenger side airbag module resistance is ok? Go to step 5
After the troubleshooting, switch on the power supply, observe the status of the warning
5 Go to step 6 Go to step 1
light. The warning light shall goes off after lighting up for 4 seconds (self-check).
6 The fault has been removed, use the scan tool to eliminate the DTC.
5-60 SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information

(10) The passenger side airbag module is short to ground


When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93CA, indicating that the passenger side airbag
module is short to ground, the resistance is lower than 6.5K ohm.

Step Operation Yes No


1 When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, is the DTC 93CA? Go to step 2 other
Shut off the power supply, check whether the connector wire harness of
2 Go to step 3 Go to step 5
the airbag ECU is in good condition?
Disconnect the battery negative cable for 30 seconds, check whether the
3 Go to step 4 Go to step 5
connector wire harness of passenger side airbag module is in good condition?
4 Whether the passenger side airbag module resistance is ok? Go to step 5
After the troubleshooting, switch on the power supply, observe the status
5 of the warning light. The warning light shall goes off after lighting up for Go to step 6 Go to step 1
4 seconds (self-check).
6 The fault has been removed, use the scan tool to eliminate the DTC.

(11) The passenger side airbag module is short to power supply (DTC 93CB)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93CB, indicating that the passenger side airbag
module is short to power supply, the resistance is lower than 21K ohm.

Step Operation Yes No


1 When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, is the DTC 93CB? Go to step 2 other
Shut off the power supply, check whether the connector wire harness of
2 Go to step 3 Go to step 4
the airbag ECU is in good condition?
Disconnect the battery negative cable for 30 seconds, check whether the
3 Go to step 4
connector wire harness of passenger side airbag module is in good condition?
After the troubleshooting, switch on the power supply, observe the status
4 of the warning light. The warning light shall goes off after lighting up for Go to step 5 Go to step 1
4 seconds (self-check).
5 The fault has been removed, use the scan tool to eliminate the DTC.

(12) The driver side pretensioner seat belt resistance is too high (DTC 93CC)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93CC, indicating that the driver side pretensioner
seat belt resistance is too high, the resistance is higher than 4.5 ohm.
(13) The driver side pretensioner seat belt resistance is too low (DTC 93CD)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93CD, indicating that the driver side pretensioner
seat belt resistance is too low, the resistance is lower than 1.2 ohm.
(14) The driver side pretensioner seat belt resistance is short to ground (DTC 93CE)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93CE, indicating that the driver side pretensioner
seat belt is short to ground, the resistance is lower than 6.5K ohm.
(15) The driver side pretensioner seat belt resistance is short to power supply (DTC 93CF)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93CF, indicating that the driver side pretensioner
seat belt is short to power supply, the resistance is lower than 21K ohm.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information 5-61

(16) The passenger side pretensioner seat belt resistance is too high (DTC 93D0)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93D0, indicating that the passenger side
pretensioner seat belt resistance is too high, the resistance is higher than 4.5 ohm.
(17) The passenger side pretensioner seat belt resistance is too low (DTC 93D1)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93D1, indicating that the passenger side
pretensioner seat belt resistance is too low, the resistance is lower than 1.2 ohm.
(18) The passenger side pretensioner seat belt resistance is short to ground (DTC 93D2)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93D2, indicating that the passenger side
pretensioner seat belt is short to ground, the resistance is lower than 6.5K ohm.
(19) The passenger side pretensioner seat belt resistance is short to power supply (DTC 93D3)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93D3, indicating that the passenger side
pretensioner seat belt is short to power supply, the resistance is lower than 21K ohm.
(20) Airbag ECU warning light is short to ground or warning light wire harness is disconnected (DTC 93D4)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93D4, indicating that the airbag ECU warning light
is short to ground or the warning light wire harness is disconnected.

Step Operation Yes No


1 When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, is the DTC 93D4? Go to step 2 other
Shut off the power supply, check whether the airbag ECU wire harness
2 Go to step 3 Go to step 5
connection is ok? (is there any short)
3 Check the connector of the warning light on airbag ECU wire harness (is there any short)? Go to step 4 Go to step 5
4 Check the LED and wire harness for connection. Go to step 5
After the troubleshooting, switch on the power supply, observe the status
5 of the warning light. The warning light shall goes off after lighting up for Go to step 6 Go to step 1
4 seconds (self-check).
6 The fault has been removed, use the scan tool to eliminate the DTC.
(21) Airbag ECU warning light is short to power supply (DTC 93D5)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93D5, indicating that the airbag ECU warning
light is short to power supply.

Step Operation Yes No


1 When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, is the DTC 93D5? Go to step 2 other
Shut off the power supply, check whether the airbag ECU wire harness
2 Go to step 3 Go to step 5
connection is ok? (is there any short)
Check the connector of the warning light on airbag ECU wire harness (is
3 Go to step 4 Go to step 5
there any short)?
4 Check the LED and wire harness for connection. Go to step 5
After the troubleshooting, switch on the power supply, observe the status
5 of the warning light. The warning light shall goes off after lighting up for Go to step 6 Go to step 1
4 seconds (self-check).
6 The fault has been removed, use the scan tool to eliminate the DTC.
5-62 SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information

(22) There are problems in the configuration of the airbag ECU (DTC 93D6)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93D6, indicating that there are problems in the
configuration of the airbag ECU.
Step Operation Yes No
1 When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, is the DTC 93D6? Go to step 2 other
Check whether the configuration of the airbag ECU is consistent with the
2 Go to step 3
actual on-board configuration?
After the troubleshooting, switch on the power supply, observe the status
3 of the warning light. The warning light shall goes off after lighting up for Go to step 4 Go to step 1
4 seconds (self-check).
4 The fault has been removed, use the scan tool to eliminate the DTC.
(23) The impact signal output interface of the airbag ECU is short to ground or the impact output circuit is
disconnected. (DTC 93D7)
When using the scan tool to test the airbag ECU, the DTC is 93D7, indicating that the impact signal output
interface of the airbag ECU is short to ground or the impact output circuit is disconnected.

IV. Diagnosis of collided vehicle


No matter airbag is unfolded or folded, inspection and maintenance of collided vehicle should be performed
according to the following sequence.
1. Check ECU diagnosis signal.
(1) Connect scanner diagnosis joint
(2) Use scanner to read out diagnosis result.
2. Repair sequence
(1) when airbag is unfolded.
The following components should be replaced with new parts
a. Airbag assembly on passenger side
b. ECU
c. Airbag assembly on driver side
d. Seat belt with pretensioner
Note:
due to impact, when battery power is insufficient, scanner can not communicate with ECU, now check and
service instrument board wire harness or use external power supply.

(2 ) Check the following components, if there is any abnormity, replace with new parts
a. Clock spring.
b. Steering wheel, steering column, lower steering shaft assembly
(3 ) The installation status of driver airbag assembly in relation to steering wheel
a. Check and see if there is abnormal noise in the steering wheel, the action of the same is good, or the
clearance is normal.
b. Check the connecter of the wire harness for damage and the terminal for distortion
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information 5-63

Notice
1. Work must be started 60s after the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from battery. The disconnected
negative (-) terminal cable shall be protected with insulating tape for insulation.
2. Airbag assembly and clock spring shall not be removed or repaired. They shall be replaced if there is any
trouble.
3. Pay enough attention to airbag assembly and clock spring when using,avoiding dropping them onto the
ground or into water or oil. In addition,if there is any pitting,crack or distortion on them,replace with new ones.
4. When an airbag is deployed, the deployed surface should face up. It should be kept on a flat surface without
any other items on it.
5. Don't keep an airbag in a place where the temperature is higher than 85°C.
6. When an airbag is deployed, it shall be replaced with a new one; simultaneously, check the clock spring,
and replace it with a new one if found abnormal.
7. When deal with the deployed airbag, gloves and protective glasses are to be used.
8. When scrapping the undeployed airbag, it shall be discarded after being deployed.

3. ECU
(1) Check the brackets of the ECU Case for recess, crack,
distortion, etc.
(2) Check the union joint for damage and terminal for distortion.
(3) Check the installation status of he ECU brackets
(4) Check the installation status of the airbag assembly.

4. Driver airbag assembly (see the figure right above)


Gas generator

Bracket
5. Clock spring (see the figure on the right)
(1) Check the connector and protecting tube for damage and the
terminal for distortion.
(2) Check the case for distortion. Horn Connector
DAB Connector
5-64 SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information

6. Steering wheel, steering column and steering lower shaft component.


(1) Check the installation status of driver airbag assembly.
(2) Check the steering wheel for any abnormal noise and see if the clearance is normal.
7. Check the wire harness connector (instrument panel wire harness).
Check and see if the wire harness is securely installed, if the joint is damaged and if the terminal is distorted.

V. Warning marks
When using or maintaining an airbag, the warnings shall be indicated. When maintaining, proceed in
accordance with the description of mark. In addition, if the mark is damaged or stained, it shall be replaced.
(1) Steering wheel, see Fig. 1.
(2) Driver airbag assembly, see Fig. 2.
(3) Clock spring, see Fig. 3.
Warning
mark
Warning mark

Fig. 1. Fig. 2. Fig. 3.

(4) ECU, see Fig. 4.


(5) Sunshade, see Fig. 5.

Sunshade

Fig. 4. Fig. 5.

VI. SRS electronic control unit (ECU)


Removal and Installation
1. Operations prior to Removal
(1) Turn the ignition switch OFF.
(2) Remove negative (-) terminal cable of the battery. Put it in a proper position or wrap it up with insulating
tape.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information 5-65

2. Removal procedures:
(1) Remove the miscellaneous box in the middle consoce.
(2) Remove the connectors to SRS ECU.
(3) Remove ECU.
3. Installation procedures:
(1) Install ECU.
(2) Install the connectors to SRS ECU.
(3) Install the miscellaneous box in the middle consoce.
(4) Connect negative (-) terminal cable of the battery.
4. Key points for Installation:
(1) Install ECU.

Notice
If the ECU cannot be installed correctly, the airbag will not act normally.

Notice
1. Work must be started 60s after the negative (-) terminal cable is detached from battery. The detached
negative (-) terminal cable shall be protected with insulating tape for insulation.
2. Never attempt to dismantle or repair an ECU. If there is any trouble, replace the ECU with a new one.
3. Prevent the ECU from shock or vibration. If pitting, crack or distortion is found, replace the ECU with a
new one.
4. Every time an airbag is deployed, the ECU shall be replaced with a new one.
5. When disassembling or maintaining the parts around ECU, attention must be given to avoid contacting the
ECU.

(2) Check after installation.


a. Turn the ignition switch ON.
b. The warning light goes on within 4s, and then goes out.
(3) If the light doesn't go out, check the trouble and eliminate it.
5. Check
a. ECU case for pitting, crack and distortion
b. The connector for damage and distortion.
Notice
If pitting, crack or distortion is found on an ECU, replace it with a new one.

For other ECU inspections, see Troubleshooting.


VII. Airbag assembly & clock spring
1.Removal and Installation of driver airbag and clock spring
Operations prior to removal
(1)Take out the ignition key after the steering wheel and front
wheel are adjusted to straightforward direction.
(2)Remove negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
Removal procedures of the driver airbag assembly:
(1) Unscrew the screws of the two sides, see fig.1
fig.1
5-66 SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information

(2) Disconnect the connector of the wire harness.


(3) Remove the components of airbag assembly.
(4) Remove steering wheel.
Removal procedures of clock spring:
(1) Remove the driver airbag assembly (disconnect the connector).
(2) Remove steering wheel gently (see the precaution).
(3) Remove the steering column cover and disconnect the connector of wire harness in the lower end.
(4) Remove clock spring.
Installation procedures of the driver airbag assembly
(1) Pre-Check
1- Install steering wheel
2- Connect the wire harness
3- Install driver airbag assembly
4- Screw up the installation screws of the two sides
(2) Connection of the negative (-) terminal of the battery
(3) Check after installation.
Installation procedures of clock spring:
(1) Pre-Check
1- Connection and fixation of the clock spring and combination switch
2- the connector of wire harness in the lower end
3- the steering column cover
4-Thread the line at the upper end of the clock spring through hole on the body part of the steering wheel
5-Install the steering wheel
6-Connect wiring harness
7-Install the airbag assembly components Installation nut
(2) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable of the battery
(3) Check after installation

Removal of steering wheel (see the figure 2)


(1) Remove the installation screws from the middle and remove
the steering wheel.(Disconnect the horn connector)

fig.2

Notice
Use scanner to do adiagnossis of airbag circnit, not to break down.
Keep the removed driver airbag assembly upside down in a clean and dry place.

Notice
Keep the removed clock sprint in a clean and dry place.

Key points for installation


(1)Pre-Check
a. The new airbag or clock spring shall be checked before being installed.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information 5-67

Notice
In case of scrapping an airbag, it shall be noted that the airbag shall be deployed according to the specified
procedures before being scrapped.

b. Connect negative (-) terminal cable of the battery.


c. Connect the diagnostic connector (16 pins).

Notice
When connecting or disconnecting the turn the ignition switch OFF first.

d. Turn the ignition switch ON.


e. Read the diagnostic circuit and see if the other locations than the troubled area of the airbag are normal.
f. Turn the ignition switch OFF.
g. Remove the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery, and protect it with insulating tape for insulation.

Notice
Work must be started 60s after the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from battery.
(2) Installation of clock spring
Screw up the clock spring clockwise to the end, rotate it counter-
clockwise by 2.5 turns, and align it with the mark (see the figure 3).

Notice
If the center of the clock spring cannot be aligned, the steering
wheel will not turn midway, or cause bad performance to the clock
spring circuit, consequently hamper the normal action of the airbag.
figure 3
(3) Installation of the components of the steering wheel and airbag assembly
a. When the center of the clock spring is aligned, install the components of the steering wheel and airbag
assembly.
b. After being installed, rotate the left and right sides of the steering wheel to position, and make sure there
is no abnormality.
(4) Check after installation
a. Slightly rotate the steering wheel left and right, make sure that there is no abnormality or noise. (Driver
airbag module, clock spring)
b. Turn the ignition switch ON.
c. The warning light goes on within 4s, and then goes out. SRS Air Bag
Warning Light

Notice
When installing the components of the steering wheel and
airbag assembly, attention should be given to protect the wire
harness of the clock spring from seizure.

d. The trouble shall be eliminated if the warning light remains on when the ignition switch is turned on or
after it goes out after 4s.
5-68 SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information

2. Checking
(1) Driver airbag assembly checking
Check the following items and replace the related components of the airbag assembly if any badness is found.
The old components shall be deployed before scrapping.

Notice
The circuit resistance of the airbag assembly (squib) cannot be measured even with a designated tester.
Since there is current flowing in the squib, when a tester is involved in measuring the resistance, sometimes
the airbag is unexpectedly deployed in case of static electricity, leading to serious accident.
a. Check the cover for pitting, crack and distortion.
b. Check the connector of the wire harness for damage and the terminal for distortion.
c. Check the case of the gas generator for pitting, crack and distortion.
d. Check the installation status of the airbag assembly.
Notice
If there is pitting, crack or distortion, replace the airbag assembly with new one. The old components of
the airbag shall be deployed before scrapping.

(2) Check the clock spring


Check the following items, and replace the clock spring if any badness is found.
a. Check the connector and protecting tube for damage and the terminal for distortion.
b. Check the case for damage.
c. Check and see if the joint terminal at the upper end of the clock spring are in conduction with that at the
lower end.
d. A thin probe shall be inserted from the back of the yellow connector of the clock spring.
e. With reference to the figure below, insert thin probes into the current tester to check the conduction of the
terminals.

VIII. Key points for scrapping the airbag assembly


The airbag shall be deployed according to the following procedures before scrapping the airbag assembly or
a vehicle installed with an airbag.
1. Scrapping of an airbag assembly prior to deployment
Notice
The airbag shall be deployed before being scrapped.
The airbag shall be deployed outside the vehicle before being changed.
The airbag shall be deployed in the vicinity of a smoke detector since smoke will appear when the airbag
is deployed.
When being deployed, the airbag will create much noise. People nearby shall wear noise muffler to close
their ears. Avoid do the job within the residential areas.

Deploy inside a vehicle


1) Park the vehicle in a flat area
2) Disconnect the positive (+) and negative (-) terminal cables from the battery and remove the battery from
the vehicle.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information 5-69

Notice
Work must be started 60s after the positive (+) and negative (-) terminal cables are detached from battery.

3) The airbag assembly shall be deployed according to the following procedures.


(1) Driver airbag assembly
a. Remove the knee bolster.
b. Remove the connector (yellow) that connecting the lower end of the clock spring with the wire harness
of the instrument panel (see the figure below).
Notice
Remove the connector of the clock spring from the wire harness of the instrument, the connector will be
short circuited automatically, which can avoid the possible serious accident resulted from the deployment of
the diver airbag assembly due to static electricity.

c. Tie two 6m plus wire harnesses for deployment to the


adaptor wire harness of the airbag, and wrap the connecting points
Horn
with insulating tape for insulation.The other ends of the wire harness DAB
Connector
for deployment are connected to each other (short circuited). Unex- Connector
pected deployment resulted from static electricity shall be prevented.
d. From the yellow connector of the clock spring, lead the
airbag adapter wire harnesses out of the vehicle by means of the wire
harnesses for deployment (see the figure below).
e. To restrain the noise, close all the windows and doors and
put on the vehicle cover.
Notice
The glass will likely break up if there is crack. Vehicle covers shall be put on.

f. Try to disconnect at a location far away from the vehicle the connector of the wire harness for deployment
of the driver airbag assembly, connect them with the two terminals of the battery removed from the
vehicle and deploy the airbag (see the figure below).
Notice
Make sure there is no man inside or near the vehicle and then Covering the car

carry out the operations.


After the driver airbag is deployed, the gas generator is of high
temperature. Keep it for 30 minutes until it gets cool for use.
Deployed
If the driver airbag assembly cannot be deployed, discuss the Harness
problem with the local Geely service station.

g. The deployed driver airbag assembly shall be scrapped according to the scrapping procedures.
Deploy outside the vehicle
Notice
Keep the airbag over 6m away from a obstacle or person and deploy the airbag in an open flat area.
Deployed the airbag outside the vehicle, avoid to do this job in the strong wind. In case of breeze, fire should
be against the wind.
5-70 SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information

1) Disconnect the positive (+) and negative (-) terminal cables from the battery and remove the battery from
the vehicle.
Notice
Work must be started 60s after removal of the battery.
2) The airbag assembly shall be deployed according to the following procedures.
Driver airbag assembly
a. Remove the driver airbag assembly from the vehicle.
Notice
When the connector is not connected, the terminals of the driver airbag assembly will be short circuited
automatically, preventing the airbag from being deployed unexpectedly. If the airbag is deployed unexpectedly,
the deployed surface should face up. It should be kept on a flat surface without any other items on it.
b. Prepare two 6m plus wire harnesses for deployment, connect
Deployed Harness
the other two ends to avoid unexpected deployment in case
Short Circuit Point
of static electricity (see the figure below).

More than 6m

c. Touch the body of the vehicle with hands for static electricity elimination.
Notice
The above-mentioned procedures can prevent the unexpected deployment due to static electricity and shall
therefore be performed strictly.

d. Cut off the wire harnesses of the driver airbag assembly and Insulation tape
connect them with the two wire harnesses for deployment, DriverÕs airbag Deployment
and make sure to wrap up the connecting location with module wire harness

insulating tape for insulation (see the figure on the right). Short circuit
location

e. Install the unused bolts to the inside bolt of the driver airbag assembly,and tie a thick metal wire securing
the wheel rim.

f. Pass the deployment wire harness of the driver airbag


assembly through an old tire with rim, and fix upwards the Airbag assembly

driver airbag assembly by means of the wire connected to


the bolts, etc (see the figure on the right). Deployed
harness
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) - SRS-General Information 5-71

g. Put three used tires without hubs onto the tire used to fix the
driver airbag assembly (see the figure on the right). Used Tire Without
hub

Deployed Harness

h. Try to disconnect at a location far away from the vehicle the


connector of the wire harness for deployment of the driver
airbag assembly, connect with the two terminals of the
battery removed from the vehicle and deploy the airbag
(see the figure on the right).

Deployed Harness

i. The deployed driver airbag assembly shall be scrapped according to the scrapping procedures.

Notice
Make sure to deploy the driver airbag assembly when there is no person close by.
After the driver airbag is deployed, the gas generator is of high temperature. Keep it for over 30 minutes
until it gets cool for use.
If the driver airbag can't be deployed, please contact the Geely service station for help.
5-72 Air Conditioning System - General Information

Chapter 7 Air Conditioning System


Section 1 General Information
Overview:
Air-conditioning system consists of refrigeration and heating parts. Refrigerating system mainly consists of
compressor, condenser and evaporator etc, it adsorbs heat in the air through circulation of refrigerant, so as to
reduce air temperature in car body and eliminate water vapour in air, to achieve the purpose of temperature drop
and dehumidification. Heating system mainly consists of heat exchanger and heater unit. It utilizes heat of engine
cooling water to heat air via heat exchanger, so as to achieve the purpose of heating. Regulation and control of
temperature, humidity and flow rate of air in car body is realized via heating and refrigeration systems separately
or jointly.
For parameters of refrigerating system, see the table:
Item Parameter
Temperature regulation method Control mixing of cool and warm air
Nominal refrigerating capacity / w 4200

Compressor Displacement / (ml /r) 143 131


Model SEBX13 FM10S13
Power consumed by magnetic clutch /W 43
+20
Lubricating oil / ml 300001202/150ml 0 cm3
Maximum air quantity / (m3/h) 420
Blower Air regulation Manual 4 speed
Motor power / W 200
Dimension /mm 16 x 350 x 630
Heat exchange quantity / W 10000
Condenser Fan motor current / A 8
Fan motor revolution / (r/min) 2200
Dimension /mm 225 x 250 x 58
Evaporator Refrigerating capacity /W 4000
Thermostatic expansion valve Internal balance type 1. 5 tons of refrigeration
Driving belt 4PK820

Refrigerant filling amount/g 440±20g 420±10g


Air Conditioning System - General Information 5-73

Precautions:
1. Don't operate refrigerant in confined space or near open fire.
2. Always wear eyeglass.

3. Be careful don't let liquid refrigerant contact your eyes and skin,
if liquid refrigerant contacts your eye or skin.
(a) Please wash with fresh water.
Warning:
Don't knead your eyes or scrub your skin
(b) Apply soft petroleum ointment on your skin.
(c) See doctor or go to hospital immediately for specialized
treatment.
4. Don't heat container or put it near open fire
5. Be careful not to fall off, object should not touch container.
6. If there is no sufficient refrigerant in refrigerating system, don't
operate the compressor.
If there is no sufficient refrigerant in the system, insufficient oil
lubrication might cause burning out of compressor. Be careful to
avoid occurrence of such things.
7. When compressor runs, don't turn on pressure gauge high-pressure
valve.
If high-pressure valve is turned on, refrigerant will flow in reverse
direction, and cause bursting of refrigerant tank, so only low
pressure valve may be turned on or off.
8. Be careful to avoid excess refrigerant
Excess refrigerant will result in poor refrigerating capacity, worse
fuel economical efficiency, engine overheat etc problems.

Symptom table
Use the following table to find out the cause of fault, number indicates probable priority of problem, check each
part according to priority, replace components if required.

Symptom Suspected Area


1.Blower fuse
2.Centralized controller fuse
3. Blower relay
Blower does not work 4. Integrated control panel assembly (blower switch)
5. Blower adjustment resistor
6. Blower
7. Wiring harness.
5-74 Air Conditioning System - General Information

Symptom Suspected Area


1. Engine coolant quantity
No air temperature control
2. Air conditioning control mechanism assembly.
1. Refrigerant quantity
2. Compressor fuse
3. Centralized controller fuse
4. Magnetic clutch relay
5. Pressure switch
Compressor does not work 6. Magnetic clutch assembly
7. Air conditioning compressor assembly
8. Integrated control panel assembly (air conditioner switch)
9. Air conditioner thermistor
10. Engine ECU
11. Wiring harness
1. Refrigerant quantity
2. Refrigerant pressure
3. Driving belt
4. Air conditioner thermistor
5. Integrated control panel assembly (air conditioner switch)
6. Magnetic clutch assembly
7. Air conditioning compressor assembly
Insufficient refrigeration 8. Condenser
9. Accumulator-drier
10. Expansion valve
11. Evaporator
12. Refrigerant line
13. Pressure switch
14. Air conditioner control mechanism assembly
15. Wiring harness
1. Idle speed control system
No engine idle speed when air conditioning
2. Wiring harness
switch is ON (switch on)
3. ECM
No air input control 1.Air conditioner control mechanism assembly
No mode control 1.Air conditioner control mechanism assembly
1. MAIN fuse
2. Condenser fan fuse
Condenser fan does not work 3. Condenser fan relay
4. Condenser fan motor
5. Wiring harness
Air Conditioning System - General Information 5-75

Inspection
1. Check pressure switch
(a) Magnetic clutch control: Air conditioner pressure switch plug-in unit
Check operation of pressure switch
( 1 ) Install manifold instrument
( 2 ) Connect positive meter pen of ohmmeter to terminal 4,
negative meter pen to terminal 1respectively.
( 3 ) As shown in the figure, check connection of each terminal
when refrigerant pressure changes
If operation does not conform to specification, replace
pressure switch.

(b) Check operation of condenser fan


( 1 ) Connect positive meter pen to terminal 2, negative meter pen to terminal 3 respectively.
( 2 ) As shown in the figure, check connection of each terminal when refrigerant pressure changes
If operation does not conform to specification, replace pressure switch.
2. Compressor magnetic clutch
(a) Connect positive pole of storage battery to binding post, negative pole to compressor shell.
(b) Check magnetic clutch in energized condition.
If abnormal, replace magnetic clutch.

3. Air conditioner thermistor

Thermistor plug-in unit (a) As shown in the figure, check resistance value of air conditioner thermistor
between terminal 1, 2 at each temperature,
Resistance:
1

Resistance
(K ohm )

Temperature(°C)
5-76 Air Conditioning System - General Information

4. Integrated control panel assembly


(a) Check connection of blower switch.

Condition/ circuit Tester connection Specification


Blower switch connector unit
OFF OFF
LO E D1 ON
D2 D4 D5
ML E D1 D2 ON
D1 D6 E
MH E D1 D4 ON
HI E D1 D5 ON
If connection does not conform to specification, replace integrated control panel assembly.
(b) Check lighting operation
Connect positive wire of storage battery to terminal D6, negative wire to terminal E, then check whether
illuminating lamp illuminates. If bulb does not illuminate, replace the bulb.
(c) Check connection of air conditioning switch
As shown in the table, check connection of terminal when switch is pressed

Tester connection Specification A/C switch connector


2 5 ON
If connection does not conform to specification, replace air
conditioning switch.
(d) Check indicator work
Connect positive wire of storage battery to terminal 1, negative
wire to terminal 3, then check whether illuminating lamp
illuminates.
If connection does not conform to specification, replace
integrated control panel assembly.
4. Blower adjustment resistor Speed regulating resistance connector unit
(a) Measure resistance between terminals, as shown in the table
Tester connection Specification
1-2 About 0. 38 Ohm
2-3 About 1. 47 Ohm
1-4 About 2. 71 Ohm

If resistance does not conform to specification, replace blower


resistance.
5. Blower assembly
(a) Connect positive wire of storage battery to terminal 2, negative
wire to terminal 1, check work smoothness of motor.
If work does not conform to specification, replace blower
assembly
Air Conditioning System - General Information 5-77

6. Heater blower motor relay assembly


Check connection of relay Heater blower motor relay assembly

Condition Tester connection Specification


3
Constant 1 2 ON
Apply storage battery 2 1
positive voltage 3 4 ON
between terminal 1, 2 4
If connection does not conform to specification, replace heater
blower motor relay.
7. Magnetic clutch relay
(a)Check connection of relay
If connection does not conform to specification, replace Magnetic clutch relay

magnetic clutch relay


Condition Tester connection Specification
Constant 1 2 ON
Apply storage battery
positive voltage be- 3 5 ON
tween terminal 1, 2
5-78 Air Conditioning System - Refrigerant

Section 2 Refrigerant

Refrigerant inspection
1. Check refrigerant quantity
(a) Observe sight glass on refrigerating liquid pipe.
Test condition:
Engine speed: 1500 rpm
Blower speed control switch: HI "high "
Air conditioning switch: switch on
Temperature setting: maximum refrigeration
Sight glass
Refrigeration runs for 5 minutes
Open door

Symptom Refrigerant quantity Correct treatment


1 With foam Insufficient * 1. Check gas leakage, repair if necessary
2. Add refrigerant until foam disappears
2 Without foam Empty, insufficient or beyond Refer to 3 and 4
No temperature difference be- 1. Use detector to check gas leakage,
3 tween input and output of Empty or nearly full repair if necessary
compressor 2. Add refrigerant until foam disappears.
There is considerable tem-
4 perature difference between Proper or beyond Refer to 5 and 6
compressor input and output
After air conditioner is turned 1. Discharge refrigerant
5 off, refrigerant should be Excess 2. Eliminate air, add appropriate quantity
cleared immediately of pure refrigerant
After air conditioner is turned
6 off, refrigerant foams Appropriate quantity
immediately, then clears
*: If refrigerating capacity is sufficient, environmental temperature is higher than normal condition, bubble
in sight glass may be deemed as normal.

2. Use manifold meter to check refrigerant pressure


( a ) This method is to utilize installed instrument to determine
where the fault is. Use manifold pressure meter reading to evaluate
fault condition.
Test condition:
Switch sets temperature of cyclical air inlet: 30-35°C
Engine speed: 1500 rpm
Blower speed control switch: high
Temperature control panel: refrigeration
Air Conditioning System - Refrigerant 5-79

Air conditioning switch: switch on


So door is completely open
(1) Refrigerating system meter reading during normal work:
Low pressure side: 0. 15-0. 25MPa
High pressure side: 1. 37-1. 57MPa
(2) System contains moisture

Pressure gauge indication when there is moisture in the system

Symptom Possible cause Diagnosis Correct treatment


1. During work, pressure Moisture in the system 1. Drying agent is in satu- 1. Replace stock solution dry-
on low pressure side some- freezes at orifice of expan- rated state ing agent
times becomes vacuum sion valve, circulation 2. System moisture 2. By drawing off air repeti-
2.Intermittent refrigeration, suspends, but system re- freezes at orifice of ex- tively to remove water vapor in
finally no refrigeration stores to normal after ice pansion valve, obstructs the system, fill in appropriate
thaws refrigerant circulation quantity of new refrigerant

(3) Poor cooling

Manifold pressure gauge indication in case of poor cooling

Symptom Possible cause Diagnosis Correct treatment

1. Pressure on high, low Refrigerant leakage 1. System refriger- 1. Use leak detector to check whether
pressure side is a bit low occurs in refrigerat- ant is insufficient there is gas leakage, repair if there is any.
2. Successive bubble ap- ing system 2. Refrigerant leaks 2. Fill in appropriate quantity of refriger-
pears in glass window ant
3. Refrigeration efficiency 3. Connect a pressure gauge, if pressure
deteriorates is zero, repair leaking part, and vacuumize
the system
5-80 Air Conditioning System - Refrigerant

(4) Poor refrigerant circulation

Manifold pressure gauge indication in case of poor refrigerant circulationa

Symptom Possible cause Diagnosis Correct treatment


1. Pressure on high, low pressure side is a bit low Dirt in refrigeration Stock solution Replace stock
2. Pipeline from stock solution drier to main set frosts drier obstructs flow drier does not solution drier
3. Refrigeration is insufficient of refrigerant circulate
(5) Refrigerant does not circulate

Manifold pressure gauge indication in case of no refrigerant circulationa

Symptom Possible cause Diagnosis Correct treatment


1. Indicates vacuum on low pres- System con- Refrigerant 1. Check expansion valve
sure side, indicates too low pres- tains moisture does not cir- 2. Use compressed air to eliminate dirt of expan-
sure on high pressure side or dirt which culate sion valve, but it cannot be eliminated, replace
2. There is dew or frost on pipe obstructs flow expansion valve.
before and after expansion valve of refrigerant 3. Vacuumize and fill in appropriate quantity of
or stock solution drier Expansion new refrigerant
valve failure 4. Expansion valve leaks, replace expansion valve

(6) Too much refrigerant or heat dissipation of radiator is poor

When there is too much refrigerant or heat dissipation of condenser is poor


Air Conditioning System - Refrigerant 5-81

Symptom Possible cause Diagnosis Correct treatment

1. Too high pressure on the 1. Excessive refrigerant, 1.Excessive refrigerant is 1. Clean condenser
high and low pressure side not utilizing the efficacy circulating 2. Check operation of fan
2. Even with decreasing engine of refrigerant 2. Insufficient refrigera- motor
speed, no bubble can be seen 2. Poor heat dissipation tion in condenser, block 3.Check the amount of
through view glass of condenser of condenser radiator or refrigerant, and fill in proper
3. Refrigeration is insufficient fan fault amount of refrigerant

(7) There is air in the system

There is air in the system.

Symptom Possible cause Diagnosis Correct treatment


1. Pressure on high, low pressure side There is air in 1. There is air in re- 1. Check whether compressor
is too high refrigerating frigerating system lubricating oil is dirty or insuffi-
2. Touch thesuction hose, it is hot system 2. Vacuumizing is cient
3. Bubble appears in glass window, not complete 2. Pump off air and fill in appro-
cooling is not good priate quantity of refrigerant

(8) Expansion valve fault

Expansion valve failure

Symptom Possible cause Diagnosis Correct treatment


1. Pressure on high, low pressure Expansion valve fails 1. Refrigerant in low-pres- Check expansion
side is too high sure line is too much valve
2. There is frost or a great deal of 2. Expansion valve is opened
water drops on pipeline of low too large
pressure side
5-82 Air Conditioning System - Refrigerant

(9) Compressor poor compression fault

Compressor failure

Symptom Possible cause Diagnosis Correct treatment


1 pressure is too high on low Inside sealing of compressor Compressor fails, valve Repair or replace
pressure side, pressure on high- is poor leaks or is damaged. compressor
pressure side is too low
2. Without cold air

Discharge and fill-up of refrigerant


Discharge of refrigerant
In case of depletion, surrounding environment should always be
well-ventilated, do not approach open fire, otherwise toxic gas might Compressor
be generated.
(1) Firstly turn off meter valve high low manual valve, connect
pipeline according to the figure below, then adjust air conditioner to
maximum refrigeration operating condition, adjust engine speed to
1000 - 2000 r/min, run for 5 min. Circulate refrigerant and collect
residual oil in parts as far as possible into compressor.
Gathering tank

(2) Loosen throttle, let engine restore to normal idle speed, turn off engine.
(3) Slowly open high voltage manual valve,cover a white towel on hose outlet,observe whether there is oil stain
on the towel, adjust flow of refrigerant.
(4) When high pressure gauge reading decreases to below 0. 35MPa, slowly open low pressure manual valve.
Close manual valve until reading of high low pressure gauge is zero.

Fill-up of refrigerant
(1) Use vacuum pump to vacuumize the system
During repair of refrigerating system, once refrigerating system is exposed to air or certain refrigerating
system part is to be replaced, automobile air conditioner must be vacuumized. So as to eliminate air and
water vapour in the system.
(2) Fill in R134 a
Standard: 420 ± 10 g (Dongfeng Painen System)
440 ± 20 g (Tianjing Sando System)
Air Conditioning System - A/C Operating Mechanism 5-83

Section 3 A/C Operating Mechanism

1. Remove heater control and attachment assembly


(1) Remove three control knobs.

(2) Remove two screws and middle instrument board


subassembly.

(3) Loosen six lock catches, pull out heater control and attach
ment assembly

Clamp

2. Remove the operation mechanism


(1) Loosen the fixed clip (air distributor) and remove the air mit
damper conrol cable.

:clip

(2) Loosen the fixed clip (air distributor) and remove air inlet
mode selector cable.

:clip
5-84 Air Conditioning System - A/C Operating Mechanism

(3) Loosen the fixed clip (air distributor) and remove the adjust-
ment vent cable.

:clip

(4) Loosen 3 fasteners on the operation mechanism and remove


the operation mechanism assembly.

Clamp

3.Remove the cable of the operation mechanism


(1) Loosen the fixed clip and remove air inlet mode selector cable.

(2) Loosen the fixed clip and remove the air mit damper conrol
cable.

(3) Loosen the fixed clip and remove the adjustment vent cable.
Notice: Do not twist the cable,otherwise the air conditianing
operation mechanism does not work normally.
Air Conditioning System - A/C Operating Mechanism 5-85

4. Remove the inner and outer cycle flipper


Unscrew the retaining buckle and the inner and outer cycle Clamp
flipper.

5. Install the control mechanism assembly


(1) Replace the damaged part, installation is in the reverse order of removal.
(2) Notice:
When installing the warm and cold adjustment damper cable on the head unit of the air conditioner, set
the rocker arm connecting the cable to the maximum travel position of the damper for refrigeration, then
press the cable in the clamp. Do not twist the cable. Check that the temperature control knob on the
rotation panel can stop at both the maximum refrigeration and maximum heating positions and won't
resile.
When installing the inner and outer cycle damper cable on the head unit of the air conditioner, set the
rocker arm connecting the cable to the maximum travel position of the inner cycle, then press the cable
in the clamp. Do not twist the cable. Check that the air intake adjustment rod on the rotation panel can
stop at both the inner and outer cycle maximum positions and won't resile.
When installing the outlet vent adjustment damper cable on the head unit of the air conditioner, set the
rocker arm connecting the cable to the maximum travel position of face mode, then press the cable in
the clamp. Do not twist the cable. Check that the airflow selector knob on the rotation panel can stop
at both the face mode and defroster heating positions and won't resile.
5-86 Air Conditioning System - Heater, Ventilation and Air Conditioning

Section 4 Heater, Ventilation and Air Conditioning

Component View I

A/C Head Unit Assembly

Seal Ring
No. 2 coolant Tank

Dual Steel Wire Circlip

No.1 coolant Pipe

Exhaust Pipe Seal


Ring

Exhaust Pipe
Air Conditioning System - Heater, Ventilation and Air Conditioning 5-87

Component View II

air inlet case

air screen

heater core
clip

heater core

screen support

Type H expansion valve

upper case
lower case
evaporator core

blower with impellor


assembly

thermistor

rear air outlet case


5-88 Air Conditioning System ¡ª¡ªHeater, Ventilation and Air Conditioning

Overhaul
1. Drain the coolant (refer to Coolant for details).
2. Disconnect A/C pipeline assembly.
(1) Remove the bolt, disconnect A/C pipeline assembly
(2) Remove 2 O rings form the A/C pipeline assembly.
Notice: O ring is a non-reusable part.

3. Disconnect the water pipe assembly connecting the heater core.


Loosen the dual steel wire circlip, disconnect the water pipe
connecting the heater core.

4. Remove console assembly


Refer to Interior Trim: Removal of the Console Assembly
5. Remove central cross member assembly
(1) Unscrew the wire harness clip and screw.
(2) Remove the nut and bolt.
(3) Remove cross member assembly.
clip
screw,nut and
bolt

6. Remove A/C lower left and right air outlet pipe


(1) Unscrew the two clips, disconnect the A/C lower left air outlet
pipe.

clip

(2) Unscrew the two clips, disconnect the A/C lower right air
outlet pipe.

clip
Air Conditioning System - Heater, Ventilation and Air Conditioning 5-89

7. Disconnect engine ECU


(1) Remove 3 bolts.
(2) Carefully disconnect the wire harness.

8. Remove A/C head unit assembly.


(1) Remove the clip attaching the console wire harness on the
A/C head unit body.
(2) Disconnect 3 connectors.
(3) Remove 2 bolts and 5 nuts, remove the A/C head unit
assembly

9. Remove heater core


(1) Loosen two clips, remove the air inlet case assembly.

2 clips

(2) Remove the screw, clamp and heater core.

10. Remove A/C wire harness


disconnect the connector, remove the A/C wire harness.
5-90 Air Conditioning System - Heater, Ventilation and Air Conditioning

11. Remove adjustment resistor


remove 2 screws and blower adjustment resistor.

12. Remove blower motor with impellor assembly.


remove 3 screws and blower motor with impellor assembly.

13. Remove rear air outlet case


remove rear air outlet case after loosening the clip.

4 clips

14. Remove Type H expansion valve


Use inner hex wrench of 5.0mm to remove 2 bolts and type H
expansion.

15. Remove the thermistor on the evaporator


(1) Disconnect the mode damper drive arm.
Air Conditioning System - Heater, Ventilation and Air Conditioning 5-91

(2) Remove 12 screws and upper case assembly.

(3) Remove the thermistor from the evaporator.

16. Remove evaporator core assembly


(1) Remove evaporator core assembly from the lower case
assembly.

(2) Remove 2 O rings from the evaporator core assembly.


Notice: O ring is a non-reusable part.

17. Remove exhaust pipe


18. Installation
(1) Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
(2) Oring is a non-reusable part and needs to be replace.
5-92 Air Conditioning System - Layont of Air Conditioning Hose

Section 5 Layont of Air Conditioning Hose

Component View

Compressor Suction Hose

Dual Tube Compressor Exhaust Hose


Clip Single-Tube Clip

Pressure Switch

Liquid Tube
High, Low Pressure Tube Assembly
Air Conditioning System - Multi-wedge belt (Connecting Compressor and Crankshaft Pulley) 5-93

Section 6 Multi-wedge belt (Connecting Compressor and


Crankshaft Pulley)
Replacement
1. Remove multi-wedge belt
(1) Loosen nut A. bolt B
(2) Loosen bolt B, remove multi-wedge belt (A/C compressor to
crankshaft pulley)

nut A

2. Install multi-wedge belt


as shown in the illustration, temporarily install the multi-wedge
belt.

blot B
3. Adjust multi-wedge belt
(1) Tighten nut A
Torque: 25 N.m
(2) Adjust the belt tension by turning bolt B. nut A

Belt Distortion:
Measuring
New belt: 6.5 - 7.0mm
point
Old belt: 8.0- 9.0mm
Tip:
New belt means the belt used on the engine for less than 5
minutes.
Old belt means the belt used on the engine for more than 5
minutes.
Correct Wrong
Install the drive belt,check whether the belt fit the belt slot.
Use hand to confirm that the belt does not slide in the belt slot.

4. Tighten multi-wedge belt


Tighten bolt A
Torque: 39 N.m
5-94 Air Conditioning System - Compressor Assembly

Section 7 Compressor Assembly


Component View

Multi-Wedge Belt 4PK820 Tensioner Assembly

Hexagonal Bolt
Compressor Support
Spring and Plate
Washer Set

Hexagonal Bolt Spring and


Plate Washer Set (3 Pcs)

Compressor
Assembly

Hexagonal Bolt M8 x105

Replacement
1. System drains coolant (refer to Coolant for details)
2. Remove multi-wedge belt (refer to Multi-wedge Belt (A/C Compressor to Crankshaft Pulley for details)).
3. Disconnect the suction vent
(1) Remove the bolt, disconnect the suction vent.
Discharge
(2) Remove the O ring from the suction vent. port
4. Disconnect the exhaust vent
(1) Remove the bolt, disconnect the exhaust vent.
(2) Remove the O ring from the exhaust vent.
Notice:
Use vinyl tape seal all the interfaces of the disconnected
parts to avoid entry of water and foreign objects.
O ring is a non-reusable part. Suction port
Air Conditioning System - Compressor Assembly 5-95

5. Remove the compressor and magnetic clutch


(1) Discomect the connetor.
(2) Loosen 4 bolts and remove the compressor.

6. Remove the bracket for compressor


(1) Remove 4 bolts and detach the bracket for compressor.

7. Installation is the reverse order of removal.


5-96 Air Conditioning System - Condenser Fan Motor and Condenser Assembly

Section 8 Condenser Fan Motor and Condenser Assembly

On-board Inspection
1. check condenser assembly
(1) if the radiator in the condenser is dirty, wash it with clean water and dry it with compressed air.
(2) if the radiator in the condenser is distorted, use the proper tool to correct it.
2. check the condenser for coolant leakage.
(1) use the leakage tester to check the connection area of the pipeline for leakage.
(2) If there is leakage, check the connector set bolt for tightening condition.

Component View

condenser upper cushion


condenser fan upper cushion

condenser fan
motor assembly

condenser as-
sembly

condenser fan lower


cushion

condenser lower
cushion
Air Conditioning System - Condenser Fan Motor and Condenser Assembly 5-97

Overhaul
1. Drain coolant (refer to Coolant for details).
2. Remove condenser fan motor assembly
(1) Disconnect condenser fan motor wire harness connector.

(2) Unscrew 1 bolt, remove condenser fan motor assembly.

3. Disconnect the liquid tube


(1) Remove the bolt, disconnect the liquid tube from the condenser.
(2) Remove the O ring from the liquid tube.

4. Disconnect the high and low pressure pipe assembly


(1) Remove the bolt, disconnect the high and low pressure tube
assembly from the condenser.
(2) Remove the O ring from the high and low pressure tube
assembly.
Notice: Use vinyl tape seal all the interfaces of the disconnected
parts to avoid entry of water and foreign objects.

5. Remove engine hood lock assembly


(1) remove the bolt, remove engine hood lock assembly
5-98 Air Conditioning System - Condenser Fan Motor and Condenser Assembly

6. Remove the centor backet for the radiator.

7. Remove the condenser body.

8. Change new O sealing ring and Installation is the reverse


order of removal.
MK-60 ABS system - ABS Diagnosis 5-99

Chapter 8 MK-60 ABS system


Section 1 ABS Diagnosis
I. Check ABS warning lamp
1. Check whether ABS warning lamp illuminates in the following way
a. Ignition switch turns to ON, ABS warning lamp illuminates for approximately 1.7s then goes out.
b. If it is not the above-mentioned case, it shows that there is fault, please check fault code.
c. If warning lamp does not illuminate at all, refer to trouble check list without fault code.
II. Reading of information state
After power on fault diagnosis instrument, turn ignition switch to "ON " position, select function menu item
01, press OK for confirmation, the screen will display the following status information
1. E. g. ECU drawing number and version number:
ABS MK60 IE
2. Code 040907
III. Read and eliminate fault code
1. After select "02 read fault code" in function selection menu, firstly display total number of fault, if there is no
fault code, display no fault code. Now, press OK key to turn page, look down for fault code and its description.
There is generally P or O before fault code, which represents that this is a persistent fault or a occasional fault.
Persistent fault always exists, while occasional fault may be eliminated, only when run on real vehicle, might it
appear again.
Note:
Read fault code function can not be exited in midway, only after all fault codes are turned over, could it return
to function menu.
Eliminate fault code
2. In function selection function menu 05, press OK key to eliminate fault code, if fault code cannot be eliminated,
it shows that this is a occasional fault, could be detected again only when the vehicle is actually running.

IV. Display mode of malfunction code


System problem Display code
No problem for the time being Never occurred before
No fault code
(ABS warning lamp does not
illuminate) Once occurred before Occasional fault code
Problem still exists Never occurred before Non-occasional fault code
(ABS warning lamp
illuminates) Once occurred before Occasional fault code and non-occasional fault code

V. Hydraulic control unit diagnosis


Use fault diagnosis instrument to diagnose hydraulic control unit, after select "3 hydraulic control unit
diagnosis" , proceed according to the following steps.
5-100 MK-60 ABS system - ABS Diagnosis

Step Action of operator Screen display Result in normal condition

01 Hydraulic control unit diagnosis -- hydraulic pump test Pump motor works

02 Left front wheel -- step down brake pedal


Left front wheel -- normally open valve opens, Wheel lockup
03
normally closed valve is closed, wheel lockup?
Left front wheel -- normally open valve is closed, Wheel lockup
04
normally closed valve is closed, wheel lockup?
Step down brake
Left front wheel _ _ normally open valve is closed, Wheels may rotate freely,
pedal and hold
05 normally closed valve opens, wheels may rotate pedal rebounds, work noise
freely of pump motor may be heard
Left front wheel _ _ normally open valve is closed,
06
normally closed valve is closed, wheels may rotate freely Wheels may rotate freely
Left front wheel -- normally open valve opens, Wheel lockup, pedal auto-
07
normally closed valve is closed, wheel lockup? matically goes down slightly
08 Release brake pedal

* Perform testing of the above steps 2-8 for each wheel. Sequence is as follows: left front right front left
rear right back.
* If result of one of the above steps is different from the result in normal condition, it shows that corresponding
actuator fails to work normally, please check corresponding actuator.
* Here as long as "return " position appears on the screen, it may finish the testing via "ESC " key and returns
to function menu.

VI. Troubleshooting quick index table


Diagnostic Check Reference
code Fault description Diagnosis content list No. page
65535 Electronic control unit Damaged

01276 ABS hydraulic pump Motor cannot work 1 5-103

00283 Left front wheel sensor Electric and mechanical failure 2, 3, 4 5-104

00285 Right front wheel sensor 5-106

00290 Left rear wheel sensor 5-106

00287 Right rear wheel sensor

01044 ABS coding error 5 5-107

00668 Supply terminal 30 6 5-107

01130 ABS works abnormally Signal lacks of conformity 7 5-108


MK-60 ABS system - ABS Diagnosis 5-101

VII. Check list index of fault without fault code


Fault condition Check list No. Reference page
When Ignition switch is turned to "ON " (engine stall condition), ABS
1 5-109
warning lamp does not illuminate
After Engine is started, warning lamp does not go out 2 5-110
Braking force on both sides is not even
Braking force is insufficient
ABS works When brake pedal is stepped on slightly, ABS works
abnormally (automobile in idle state) 3 5-111
When brake pedal is stepped on slightly, ABS works
(automobile in running state)
When ABS works, brake pedal vibrates excessively
Travel of brake pedal is too long 4 5-112
A very large force is needed to step on brake pedal 5 5-112
No fault code output (cannot communicate with fault diagnosis instrument) 6 5-113

VIII. Circuit diagram

Please Refer to "MK WIRING DIAGRAM"


5-102 MK-60 ABS system - ABS Diagnosis

ABS ECU socket pin distribution (wiring harness end)


(1) ABS ECU socket (view of leading-out terminal)

46 33
47 32

31 17
16 1
15 2

(2) Trouble light driver module

7 6 5 4 3 2 1

(3) Diagnosis connector


MK-60 ABS system - ABS System Check 5-103

Section 2 ABS System Check


I. Check list of fault with fault code
Possible cause
1 Fault code is 01276
Power supply is discon-
[Description ] When vehicle speed exceeds 20 km/h, ABS ECU monitors that nected or earthed
motor can not work normally, it will record this fault code Motor wiring harness gets
[Prompt ] When this fault appears, wiring harness connection between motor loose
and ECU may get loose. Use hydraulic pressure unit functional Motor is damaged
testing of fault diagnosis instrument to drive motor for this test.

Note: If storage battery is discharged excessively, it might fail to drive motor, so when conduct motor drive test,
firstly confirm whether voltage of storage battery is normal, when conduct motor drive test, vehicle must be in idle
state.

Pull out motor wiring harness plug, connect Abnormal


battery power source directly to motor plug, see Replace HCU
whether motor works or not?

Abnormal
Check safety wire and ABS ECU joint Replace HCU

Connect motor wiring harness


Turn ignition switch to ON position
Eliminate fault code
Use fault diagnosis instrument to conduct
hydraulic control unit diagnosis

Yes
Whether fault recurs Replace ABS ECU

Refer to "key points of occasional fault


repair"
5-104 MK-60 ABS system - ABS System Check

Possible cause
2 Fault code is 00283, 00285, 00290, 00287
Sensor is not mounted
[Description ] when open circuit cannot be detected, there is no signal output Sensor coil or wiring har-
even if vehicle speed reaches above 20 km/h, this fault code ness is shorted
will appear. Air gap between sensor
[Prompt ] It is probably because that sensor is not mounted, sensor coil or and gear ring is too large
wiring harness is shorted, air gap between sensor and gear ring is Gear ring is not mounted
too large or gear ring is damaged. ABS ECU fails

Whether sensor is installed Yes


Install it correctly
correctly

Check sensor output volt- Abnormal Check each wheel Abnormal


Replace
age at ABS ECU 25 chip speed sensor
socket
Normal

Abnormal
Check the pulse ring Replace
Replace ABS ECU
Normal

Check wheel bearing Abnormal


Replace or
clearance
repair
Normal

Check wiring harness


between sensor and
ABS ECU
MK-60 ABS system - ABS System Check 5-105

Possible cause
3 Fault code is 00283, 00285, 00290, 00287
Intermittent poor contact or
[Description]When speed >20km/h, if sensor signal exceeds tolerance short circuit of sensor coil or
range, this fault code will appear. wiring harness
[Prompt ] It is propably because intermittent poor contact or short Air gap between Sensor and
circuit of sensor coil or wiring harness, gear ring is dam gear ring is too large or too small
aged or air gap between sensor and gear ring is too large, so Gear ring teeth is damaged
sensor signal is too weak. Bearing clearance is too large
ABS ECU fails

Whether sensor is installed Yes


Install it correctly
correctly

Check sensor output volt- Abnormal Check each wheel Abnormal


Replace
age at ABS ECU 25 chip speed sensor
socket
Normal

Abnormal
Check the pulse ring Replace
Replace ABS ECU

Normal

Check wheel bearing Abnormal


Replace or
clearance
repair
Normal

Check wiring harness


between sensor and
ABS ECU
5-106 MK-60 ABS system - ABS System Check

Possible cause
4 Fault code is 00283, 00285, 00290, 00287
Sensor socket connector
[Description]When identifiable open circuit, short circuit etc faults exist on or coil is disconnected
sensor, this fault code will appear. Sensor coil appear is
[Prompt ] It might because poor contact of sensor, short circuit of coil or shorted
wiring harness or faulty sensor signal processing circuit in ABS Sensor plug or wiring har-
ECU ness is shorted with earth or
power supply
ABS ECU sensor signal
processing circuit fails

Check sensor of each wheel

Normal

Remove ABS ECU plug, check


whether resistance value between
the following terminals conforms
to standard value or not? Normal
Standard value : 1.0-1.3K ohm¸ Replace ABS ECU

Left front : 45-46


Right front :33-34
Left rear : 36-37
Left rear: 42-43

Abnormal

Abnormal
Check corresponding sensor
Repair socket connector
plug

Normal

No
Refer to key point for re-
Whether fault recurs
pair of occasional fault

Yes

Check wiring harness between ECU and sensor


MK-60 ABS system - ABS System Check 5-107

Possible cause
5 Fault code is 01044
Bouncing pin connection
[Description]When ECU software code is inconsistent with hardware error in ABS wiring harness
bouncing pin connection, this fault code will appear Abs ecu coding error

Use fault diagnosis instrument to check whether ABS ECU software No


Recode
code is correct
Correct value: 040907
Yes

Check whether ABS wiring harness bouncing pin joint is connected Abnormal
Repair wiring harness
Bouncing pin joint : ABS ECU Pin 38and Pin 14

Possible cause
6 Fault code is 00668
Abs system fuse is blown out
[Description]When supply terminal 30 does not supply voltage or Storage battery voltage is too
voltage is too high, this fault code will appear. low or too high
ABS wiring harness socket
connector is damaged
ABS ECU is damaged
Abnormal
Check ABS system 30 A safety wire Replace fuse

Normal

Disconnect connection of ABS wiring harness and ECU,


turn ignition switch to ON position, measure voltage value
between the following terminals of ABS wiring harness Normal
Replace fuse
Terminal 1 and 47 9.5 _ 16.5V
Terminal 32 and 16 9.5 - 16.5V
Terminal 4 and 16 9.5 _16.5V

Abnormal

Abnormal
Check ABS wiring harness socket connector Replace fuse

Normal
No Refer to repair of
Retry. Abnormity reoccurs occasional fault
Yes Key points

Check storage battery voltage


5-108 MK-60 ABS system - ABS System Check

Possible cause
7 Fault code is 01130
High frequency interfer-
[Description]When ABS suffers from high frequency interference of electro ence of electromagnetic
magnetic wave or microprocessor thinks that input speed signal wave
is unauthentic, this fault code will appear Sensor is damaged or sen-
sor wiring harness is dam-
aged
ABS ECU is damaged

No Abnormal
Check sensor output voltage Check sensor Replace wheel
speed

Normal

Replace ABS ECU Check wiring harness


between ECU and
sensor
MK-60 ABS system - ABS System Check 5-109

II. Check list of fault without malfunction code

Possible cause
1 When ignition switch is in ON position (engine stall), ABS warning
Safety wire is burnt out
lamp does not illuminate
ABS warning lamp bulb
[Description ] ABS warning lamp does not illuminate, warning lamp power
is burnt out
supply circuit might be disconnected, bulb is burnt out or
Power circuit is discon-
warning lamp driving module is damaged.
nected
ABS warning lamp driv-
ing module is damaged

Check ABS warning lamp Abnormal


safety wire in fuse boxCheck Replace
ABS warning lamp safety wire
in fuse box

Normal

Remove ECU joint, when igni-


No Check whether ABS warn- Yes
tion switch is in ON, does warn- Replace
ing lamp is burnt out
ing lamp illuminate ?
No
Yes
Check whether warning
Check whether the wire in ABS lamp power supply circuit Abnormal
and ground loop in wiring Repair wiring
wiring harness connecting ABS
harness is disconnected harness
warning lamp driving module
and ECU is shorted to ground Normal

Check warning lamp power


supply circuit and ground Abnormal
Repair socket
loop socket connector in
connector
wiring harness

Normal
Refer to key point
No
Does fault reoccur for repair of occa-
sional fault
Yes

Repair wiring harness


5-110 MK-60 ABS system - ABS System Check

Possible cause
2 After engine starts up, ABS warning lamp illuminates normally
ABS warning lamp driving
[Description] Probably because ABS warning lamp driving module is module is damaged
damaged or ABS warning lamp circuit is disconnected. ABS warning lamp driving
module circuit is disconnected
ABS ECU is damaged

Note: this fault mode is only limited to the condition in which system may communicate with fault diagnosis
instrument (ABS ECU ABS ECU power supply is normal), and there is no fault code.

Check whether wire between Yes


ECU and ABS warning lamp Repair wire harness
driving module is disconnected

No

Check ABS warning lamp driv- Abnormal


Replace
ing module

Normal

Replace ABS ECU


MK-60 ABS system - ABS System Check 5-111

Possible cause
3 ABS works abnormally
Sensor is not installed properly
[Description] This issue is closely related to driver condition and Sensor wiring harness has problem
road surface condition, so it is not easy to conduct Sensor is damaged
fault diagnosis. However, if there is no fault code Gear ring is damaged
memory, the following inspection may be conducted. Sensor is attached with foreign
matter
Wheel bearing is damaged
ABS HCU (hydraulic pressure unit)
is damaged
ABS ECU (electric control unit) is
damaged

Yes
Whether sensor is installed correctly Install it correctly

Abnormal Abnormal
Check sensor output voltage Check each sensor Replace

Normal Normal
Abnormal
Check gear ring of each sensor Replace
Use fault diagnosis instrument to
conduct diagnosis of hydraulic Normal
control unit Abnormal Replace or
Abnormal Check wheel bearing clearance
repair
Normal
Replace ABS HCU Replace
Abnormal
Check ABS ECU socket and socket
middle socket connector connector
Normal

No Refer to key point


Does fault recur for repair of oc-
Yes casional fault

Remove ABS ECU plug, check whether resis-


tance value between the following binding
posts conforms to standard value or not? Normal Repair wiring
Abnormal Standard value: 1.0-1.3K ohm¸ harness or socket
Replace ABS ECU
Shake sensor wiring harness and socket con- connector
nector while measuring
Left front: 44-45 Right front: 33-34
Left rear: 36-37 Right rear:42-43
5-112 MK-60 ABS system - ABS System Check

Possible cause
4 Travel of brake pedal is too long
Brake fluid leaks
[Description] Firstly visually check whether there is external leakage or There is air in the system
mechanical failure. Use exhaust method to check whether Brake disc is worn severely
there is air in the system. Use fault diagnosis instrument Brake fluid level switch
hydraulic pressure unit functional testing to check whether fails
normally closed valve leaks.

Abnormal
Visually check whether Hydraulic coupler leaks Screw down pipe head as required

Normal

Abnormal
Check worn condition of brake disc Replace brake disc

Normal

Abnormal
Check brake fluid level switch Replace brake fluid level switch

Normal

Abnormal
Exhaust check Exhaust again

Normal

Use fault diagnosis instrument hydraulic con- Abnormal


Replace HCU (hydraulic control unit)
trol unit for diagnosis
Check tightness of normally closed valve leak

Possible cause
5 A very large force is needed to step on pedal
Booster has problem
[Description] Use traditional method to check travel of booster and brake pedal. Normally closed
Fault of normally open valve may be checked using fault diagnosis valve has problem
instrument hydraulic pressure unit functional testing

Use fault diagnosis instrument hy- Abnormal


Replace HCU(hydraulic control unit)
draulic control unit for diagnostic
check of normally open valve
Normal

Use traditional method of non-ABS


vehicle to check booster and pedal
stroke
MK-60 ABS system - ABS System Check 5-113

Possible cause
6 No diagnostic code output (cannot communicate with fault diagnosis
Safety wire is burnt out
instrument)
Diagnosis wire is broken
[Description] When it cannot communicate with fault diagnosis instrument,
or joint gets loose
ABS ECU power supply circuit or diagnosis wire circuit might
ABS ECU is damaged
be disconnected
Fault diagnosis instru-
ment has problem

Whether fault diagnosis instrument No ABS fault diagnosis instrument fails,


may communicate with MK -60 ABS check again after repair
ECU on other vehicle
Yes

Abnormal
Replace
Check ABS power fuse

Normal
Check power cord, earth wire Repair fault di-
No No
Whether there is display on the screen and diagnosis wire in fault agnosis inter-
of fault diagnosis instrument diagnosis interface and their face or wiring
Normal connection harness

Remove ABS ECU connector, check No


Check diagnosis interface or wire harness
whether ECU binding post 2 in ABS
wiring harness is connected with pin
7 in diagnostic interface
Yes

Replace ABS ECU


5-114 MK-60 ABS system - ABS System Check

III. ABS system inspection


Ignition switch
Inspection item Binding post Standard value Unit
position
Storage battery voltage (motor) OFF 1-47 10.1 ~ 14.5 V
Storage battery voltage OFF 32-16 10.1 ~ 14.5 V
(Solenoid valve)
Power supply insulating property OFF 4-16 0.00 ~ 0.5 V
Earth insulating property OFF 16-47 0.00 ~ 0.5 V
Supply voltage ON 4-16 10.1 ~ 14.5 V
OFF ECU is not Warning lamp goes out Visual inspection
ON connected Warning lamp illuminates Visual inspection
ABS warning lamp OFF Warning lamp goes out Visual inspection
Connect ECU Warning lamp illuminates
ON Visual inspection
for about 1.7s,then goes out
Brake light switch function pedal
ON 16-41 0.0 ~ 0.5 V
is not stepped down
Brake light switch function pedal
ON 16-41 10.0 ~ 14.5 V
is stepped down
Diagnostic interface Diagnosis joint
OFF 0.0 ~ 0.5 ohm
K and 7
Left front wheel speed sensor
OFF 45-46 1.2 ~ 1.3 k ohm
resistance value
Right front wheel speed sensor
OFF 33-34 1.2 ~ 1.3 k ohm
resistance value
Left rear wheel speed sensor
OFF 37-36 1.0 ~ 1.3 k ohm
resistance value
Right rear wheel speed sensor
OFF 42-43 1.0 ~ 1.3 k ohm
resistance value
Left front wheel sensor output
OFF 45-46 3.4 ~ 14.8 MV/Hz
voltage value
Right front wheel sensor output
OFF 33-34 3.4 ~ 14.8 MV/Hz
voltage value
Left rear wheel sensor output
OFF 37-36 >12.2 MV/Hz
voltage value
Right rear wheel sensor output
OFF 42-43 >12.2 MV/Hz
voltage value
Maximum peak to peak value voltage
Speed sensor output voltage ratio 2
Minimum peak to peak value voltage
MK-60 ABS system - ABS System Check 5-115

Inspection item Key switch position Operation Standard value Remarks

Note: when perform the following inspection, vacuum must be applied on vacuum booster.

When left front wheel Check normally


Tightness of left ON Step on pedal cannot rotate, pedal does closed valve
front wheel nor- not sink
mally open valve
and normally ON (two valves are Left front wheel may Check normally
closed valve energized simulta- Step on pedal rotate freely, pedal does open valve
neously with pump) not sink

When right front wheel Check normally


Tightness of right ON Step on pedal cannot rotate, pedal does closed valve
front wheel nor- not sink
mally open valve
and normally ON (two valves are Right front wheel may Check normally
closed valve energized simulta- Step on pedal rotate freely, pedal does open valve
neously with pump) not sink

When left rear wheel Check normally


Tightness of left ON Step on pedal cannot rotate, pedal does closed valve
rear wheel normally not sink
open valve and nor-
ON (two valves are Left rear wheel may ro- Check normally
mally closed valve
energized simulta- Step on pedal tate freely, pedal does open valve
neously with pump) not sink

When right rear wheel Check normally


Tightness of right ON Step on pedal cannot rotate, pedal does closed valve
rear wheel normally not sink
open valve and nor-
ON (two valves are Right rear wheel may Check normally
mally closed valve Step on pedal
energized simulta- rotate freely, pedal does open valve
neously with pump) not sink

Note: fault diagnosis instrument function "03 hydraulic control unit diagnosis" is used for this inspection.

IV ABS work inspection


1. Check wheel speed sensor output voltage
a. Check whether gap between wheel speed sensor and gear ring meets standard value or not
For standard value of front wheel, see installation drawing of front wheel sensor
For standard value of rear wheel, see installation drawing of rear wheel sensor
b. Jack up wheel, loosen manual brake
c. Remove ABS wiring harness, measure at wiring harness socket connector
5-116 MK-60 ABS system - ABS System Check/ Removal and Installation

d. Rotate the wheel at speed of about 1 / 2 turns per second, use multimeter or oscillograph to measure output
voltage
Terminal 45-46
Terminal 33-34
Terminal 37-36
Terminal 42-43
Output voltage
When use multimeter for measurement
See front wheel sensor drawing for front wheel.
See rear wheel sensor drawing for rear wheel
When use oscillograph for measurement
See relevant standard for front wheel.
See relevant standard for rear wheel.
e. If output voltage is not in above-mentioned range, the cause might be the following:
Air gap between sensor and pulse ring is too large.
Sensor fails.
Check sensor resistance value (1. 0 - 1. 3 k ohm).
Take four points on pulse ring to check air gap between pulse ring and wheel speed sensor (pulse ring
distortion).
2. Check hydraulic pressure unit HCU
a. Jack up vehicle to confirm that wheel may rotate freely.
b. Release manual brake.
c. After connecting fault diagnosis instrument, turn ignition switch to ON, here it is not necessary to start up
engine.
e. Check with reference to hydraulic control unit diagnosis.
Note: when connect or remove fault diagnosis instrument, ignition switch must be in OFF position

Section3 Removal and Installation


I. Precautions for removal and installation
1. Firstly use diagnostic instrument to find out source of trouble, then repair.
2. Repair front prior use excluding mineral oil of detergent will surface clean Neatness ; repair when should note
before repair, use detergent without mineral oil to wipe off surface; pay attention to cleaning during repair, only
use rag without wool to wipe removed components.
3. Only use original factory spare parts, and new spare parts could only be unpacked just before installation.
4. Return liquid pump motor and hydraulic controller (HCU) is integrated structure, can not be separated.
MK-60 ABS system - Removal and Installation 5-117

5. When system is opened, don't use compressed air or move the vehicle.
6. After removing ABS assembly, use appropriate plugs to plug up hydraulic delivery outlets as soon as possible.
Remove other parts that might hinder work.
7. Please use HZY4 brake fluid, do not use mineral oil.
8. Use brake fluid to soak sealing member and O ring, do not use engine oil or brake ointment.
9. After repair, check whether function of routine brake system and ABS brake is reliable and normal or not.
10. Check whether there is any leakage at all Hydraulic couplers.
II. Removal of HECU
1. Turn off ignition switch and disconnect storage battery minus earth wire.
2. Remove wiring harness plug from ABS HECU assembly.
3. Step down the pedal >60mm, use pedal bracket to fix it, so master cylinder center valve will be turned off, when
system is opened, brake fluid will not flow out from outlet.
4. Put a clean pad under hydraulic controller.
5. Firstly remove brake hard tube (A, B) on HCU connecting with master cylinder, make sign. Plug up the outlet
with a plug immediately.
6. Remove brake pipe (1 - 4) to wheels and make sign. Plug up the outlet with a plug immediately.
7. Remove the screw cap fixing HECU onto the bracket.
8. Remove the entire HECU from bracket.

ABS HECU assy. Schematic diagram for removal of ABS HECU brake oil pipe

III. Replace hydraulic control unit


1. Press lock catch on joint side, remove wire harness of pump motor.
2. Remove 4 screws as as shown in the figure, the removed old screws
can not be reused.
3. Separate hydraulic control unit HCU from electronic control unit
ECU.
4. Mount new hydraulic control unit HCU onto electronic control unit
ECU.
5. Use new screw to fix ECU onto HCU, tightening moment: 3-4N.m.
6. Insert motor wiring harness, note that lock catch must be in right
position.
5-118 MK-60 ABS system - Removal and Installation

IV. Replace electronic control unit


1. Press lock catch on joint side to remove wiring harness.
2. Remove 4 screws as shown in the figure and discard them.
3. Remove hydraulic control unit HCU from electronic control unit
ECU.
4. Mount new electronic control unit ECU onto hydraulic control unit
HCU.
5. Use new screws to lock ECU on HCU, torsional moment:3-4N.m.
6. Insert motor wiring harness, note that lock catch must be in right
position.

V. Reinstallation of ABS assembly


Note: plug of hydraulic opening on ABS assembly may be removed only when brake hard tube is to be installed,
so as to avoid foreign body entering brake system
1. Mount ABS assembly to bracket and tighten it, moment is 20~24 N.m.
2. Remove the plug on hydraulic opening, mount brake hard tube, confirm that hard tube connection is correct.
3. Mount brake hard tube to master cylinder.
4. Tightening moment for assembly of brake hard tube is 12~16N.m (M10 x 1) and 15~18 N.m (M12 x 1).
5. Fill new brake fluid into tank until liquid level reaches MAX place, use specified method to exhaust.
6. Turn ignition switch to ON, ABS warning lamp must illuminate for 1. 7s, then go out.
7. Eliminate fault code memory, reread to see whether there is any fault code.
8. Finally, run the vehicle in actual situation to confirm function of ABS (you should feel rebound of pedal).

VI. ECU code


Note: when replacing HECU or ECU, encode new ECU, otherwise ABS warning lamp blinks, system can not work
normally.
Use fault diagnosis instrument to encode ECU, the steps are as follows:

Connect fault diagnosis instrument and fault diagnosis interface

Select function 07, press OK key to confirm

Input code 40904 at code input place, press OK key to confirm

Select function 06, press OK key to confirm, exit diagnosis mode

End
MK-60 ABS system - Removal and Installation 5-119

VI. Filling brake fuid and blead


After replace HECU, besides filling and blead as per routine brake system, also blead the secondary circuit of
HECU. Steps are as follows if fault diagnosis instrument is used for operation:

Perform charging blead according to routine brake system until no bubble


appears in transparent rubber tube

Connect fault diagnosis instrument and diagnostic interface

Select function 04, press OK key to confirm

Step down brake pedal and keep rebound of hydraulic pump work pedal

Release the brake, loosen left and right front brake tongs venting screws,
press " " key

Step on brake pedal for 10 times, tighten up left and right front brake
tongs venting screws, press " " key

Repeat the above Step I II III for seven times, then press " " key.

Screen displays end of exhaust, press " " key to return to "function
selection" menu

Select function 06, press OK key to exit diagnosis mode

End
5-120 Engine EFI System - Engine EFI System

Chapter 9 Engine EFI System


I. Outline
This system includes sensor that detects engine functioning. Engine ECU utilizes sensors installed at differ-
ent parts of engine to measure various working parameters of engine, accurately control oil injection quantity
according to control procedure set in engine electronic control unit, so engine could work in optimum mode
under various operating conditions, i. e. optimal power output, the most economical oil consumption, optimal
exhaust emissions. Engine ECU is capable of start up control, idle speed closed-loop control, air fuel ratio
closed-loop control, canister control, transient operation control, angle of ignition control, knocking control, air
conditioning control, coasting fuel cutoff and overspeed fuel cutoff control, ternary catalyst heating and protec-
tion control, system self-diagnosis etc.
II. Inspection of control element
1. Manifold intake pressure temperature sensor
(1) The part to measure intake pressure is piezo type sensor, could provide controller with "load signal "
according to the difference between atmospheric pressure and manifold pressure; controller will supply 5V
voltage, and feed back 0-5V voltage to controller according to different intake pressures. The part to measure
intake temperature is NTC type (negative temperature coefficient) sensor, resistance changes with intake
temperature, this sensor conveys a voltage representing intake temperature change to the controller.
Intake pressure sensor feature cure Intake temperature feature curve
Output voltage

Resistance

Absolute pressure Temperature

Fault symptom Possible cause


There is abnormal high voltage or reverse heavy current during useVacuum
Flameout, poor idle speed
unit is damaged during repair
Repair precautions: it is prohibit to use high pressure gas to impact vacuum unit during repair; when replace
sensor case of trouble, check whether generator output voltage and current is normal or not.

(2) Simple measuring method:


Temperature sensor part: (remove joint) turn digital multimeter
to Ohm position, two meter pens connect sensor 1 #, 2 # pin
respectively, rated resistance is 2. 5k ohm±5% at 20°C, correspond-
ing resistance value may be measured from the above characteristic 1 2 3 4
curve. Simulation method may also be used for measurement, spe-
Manifold intake pressure temperature
cific procedure is to use electric drier to blast sensor (pay attention not sensor
to be too close), observe change of sensor resistance, here resistance
Engine EFI System - Engine EFI System 5-121

should drop.
Pressure sensor part: (connect joint), turn digital multimeter to DC voltage position, black meter pen is earthed,
red meter pen is connected with 3#, 4# pin respectively. In condition of idle speed, 3# pin should have reference
voltage of 5 V, 4 # pin voltage should be about 1. 3 V (specific value is related with vehicle type); in no-load
condition, open the throttle slowly, change of voltage of 4 # pin is not large; open the throttle quickly, voltage of
4 # pin may reach about 4V in no time (specific value is related with vehicle type), then it drops down to about
1. 5 V.
2. Throttle position sensor
(1) This sensor is actually corner potentiometer with linear output characteristic. Potentiometer tumbler is
mounted coaxially with throttle, when throttle rotates, it drives potentiometer tumbler to slide to certain position,
potentiometer outputs voltage signal proportional to throttle position.

Fault symptom Possible cause


Poor speedup etc Man made fault
Repair precautions: pay attention to mounting position.
(2) Simple measuring method:
(Remove joint) turn digital multimeter to ohm position, connect
two meter pens with sensor 1 #, 2 # pin respectively, its resistance 1 2 3
value at room temperature is 2k ohm±20 %. Connect two meter pens
with 1 #, 3# pin respectively, rotate throttle, its resistance value shows
Throttle position sensor
linear change with opening of throttle, while situation is reverse for
2 #, 3# pin.
Note: when observe change of resistance value, pay attention to observe whether has large leap.
3. Coolant temperature sensor
(1) This sensor is a negative temperature coefficient (NTC) thermistor, its resistance value decreases with
increase of temperature, but not a linear relationship. This thermistor is installed in a copper heat conducting sleeve.
Fault symptom Possible cause
Difficult to start Man made fault
Mounting torque: 20 N.m(Max)
(2) Simple measuring method:
(Remove joint) turn digital multimeter to ohm position, connect two meter pens with sensor pins respectively,
rated resistance at 20°C is 2.5 k ohm± 5%. Simulation method may also be used for measurement, specific
procedure is to put sensor work area into boiled water (pay attention to soak for sufficient time), observe change
of sensor resistance, now resistance should drop down to 300 ohm-400 ohm (specific value subjects to temperature
of boiled water).
Resistance value (K ohm)
Temperature
No. Temperature tolerance ±1°C Temperature tolerance ±0°C
(°C)
Min. Max. Min. Max.
1 8.16 10.74 8.62 10.28 -10
2 2.27 2.73 2.37 2063 +20
3 0.290 0.354 0.299 0.345 +80
5-122 Engine EFI System- Engine EFI System

4. Knocking sensor
(1) Knocking sensor is a vibration acceleration sensor. Mounted on engine cylinder body. Sensing element of
the sensor is a piezocrystal. Vibration of engine cylinder body is transferred to piezocrystal via mass block in the
sensor. Since pressure generated by vibration of mass block is applied to piezocrystal, it generates voltage on two
polar planes and turns vibration signal into voltage signal for output.

Symptom Possible cause


Various liquids, such as engine oil, cooling fluid, brake fluid, water etc
Poor acceleration
contact the sensor for a long time, which cause corrosion to the sensor.

Mounting torque: 20 ± 5 N.M


Repair precautions: sensor must be fitted closely to cylinder body with its metal surface, any type of washer
is not permitted for installation. For wiring of sensor signal cables, note that do not let resonance occur to signal
cables, otherwise they might be broken. Energizing of high voltage between sensor 1 # and 2 # pins must be
avoided, otherwise piezoelectric element might be damaged.
(2) Simple measuring method:
(Remove joint) turn digital multimeter to ohm position, connect two meter pens with sensor 1 #, 2 # pin
respectively, its resistance value at room temperature should exceed 1M ohm. Turn digital multimeter to millivolt
position, use a hand hammer to tap near knocking sensor, now voltage signal output should be available.
5. Oxygen sensor
(1) Its sensing element is a ceramic tube, outside is open to exhaust, inside is open to atmosphere. When
temperature of sensing ceramic tube reaches 350°C, it will have the characteristic of solid state electrolyte. Just
utilizing this characteristic, it converts concentration difference of oxygen into electric potential difference, thus
forms electrical signal output. If mixed gas is a bit concentrated, inside and outside oxyanion concentration
difference of ceramic tube is high, electric potential difference is a bit high.
A large number of oxyanions move from inside to outside, output voltage is high (approximate 900mV); if
mixed gas is a bit thin, inside and outside oxyanion concentration difference of ceramic tube is low, electric
potential difference is low, only a small quantity of oxyanions move from inside to outside, output voltage is low
(approximate 100mV).

Symptom Possible cause


Poor idle speed, poor speedup, tail gas 1. humid water vapor ingresses inside of sensor, temperature
overproof, too high oil consumption changes rapidly, probe is broken.
2. oxygen sensor "is poisoned". (Pb, S, Br, Si)

Mounting torque: 40-60 N.m


Repair precautions: it is prohibited to use cleaning fluid, oily liquid or volatile solid on oxygen sensor during
repair.
(2) Simple measuring method:
(Remove joint) turn digital multimeter to ohm position, connect
two meter pens with sensor 1# (white), 2# (white) pin respectively, its 1 2 3 4
resistance value at room temperature is 1- 6 ohm.
(Connect joint) in idle speed condition, when oxygen sensor
reaches its working temperature of 350°C, turn digital multimeter to Oxygen sensor
DC voltage position, connect two meter pens with sensor 3 (grey),
#
Engine EFI System - Engine EFI System 5-123

4#(black) pin respectively, now voltage should fluctuate quickly between 0. 1-0. 9V.
6. Speed sensor
(1) Use with oscillator. Oscillator is a fluted disc, originally has 60 teeth, but two teeth are absent. Oscillator
is mounted on crankshaft, and rotates with the crankshaft. When tooth tip passes by sensor end closely, the
oscillator which is made of ferromagnetic material cuts magnetic line of permanent magnet in the sensor, and
generates induced voltage in coil, which is output as rotating speed signal.
Symptom Possible cause
Fail to start Man made fault
Mounting torque: 8 ± 2 N.m
Repair precautions: use pressing in instead of hammering method for installation during repair.
(2) Simple measuring method:
(Remove joint) turn digital multimeter to ohm position, connect
two meter pens with sensor 2#, 3# pins respectively, rated resistance
at 20°C is 770-950 ohm.
1 2 3
(Connect joint) turn digital multimeter to AC voltage position,
connect two meter pens with sensor 2 #, 3# pins respectively, start up
Speed sensor
engine, now voltage output should be available.
Suggestion: use oscillograph for vehicle use to check.
7. Phase sensor
(1) This sensor consists of a hall sensor and a rotor made of steel plate. Fix hall sensor, mount rotor on camshaft.
Rotor is a 180( range cylindrical face steel blade. When the blade covers hall sensor, high Level signal is output;
otherwise low level signal is output. This differentiates two different upper dead points.
Fault symptom Common cause
Dischrge overproof, increased oil consumption Man made fault
Repair precautions: avoid removing end cover as far as possible during repair, so as to avoid ingress of foreign
matter, which might result in abnormal damage of magnetic gate.
(2) Simple measuring method:
(Connect joint) turn on ignition switch but not start up engine, turn digital multimeter to DC voltage position,
connect two meter pens with sensor red, black conductors respectively, ensure reference voltage of 5V is available.
Start up engine, voltage output between green and black conductors should be available.
Suggestion: use oscillograph for vehicle use to check.
8. Idle speed regulator
(1) Idle speed regulator consists of a step motor and a sealing plug on its shaft, sealing plug may generate radial
displacement driven by step motor shaft, position of sealing plug determines extent of opening of by-pass airway,
so as to adjust the size of by-pass air quantity. Position of sealing plug is controlled by ECU output.
Fault symptom Possible cause
Too high idle speed, flameout at idle speed Since interior contamination is severe, regulating element
is blocked and leads to malfunction.

Repair precautions: dust and sand grain will result in damage of idle speed regulator. Intake air should be
filtered by dry air cleaner before entering idle speed regulator, filtration efficiency should exceed 99 %. To
5-124 Engine EFI System - Engine EFI System

replacing air cleaner, always ensure that no dirt enters air duct, never
use ungraded air cleaner.
(2) Simple measuring method:
(Remove joint) turn digital multimeter to ohm position, connect 1 2 3 4
two meter pens with regulator pin 1, 4 and 2, 3 respectively. Rated
resistance between 1, 4 and between 2, 3 at 20°C should be about
43.2 ohm.
9. Fuel injector
(1) ECU energizes coil of fuel injector to form magnetic field force. When magnetic field force increases to
sufficient to overcome pressure of return spring, gravity of needle valve and resultant force of frictional force,
needle valve begins to rise, oil injection process begins. When oil injection impulse cuts off, pressure of return
spring closes needle valve again.

Symptom Possible cause


Poor idle speed, poor speedup, failure to start Since lack of maintenance, gum builds up in
(difficult to start) fuel injector and leads to malfunction

Repair precautions:
1. there are many kinds of fuel injector, their appearance is the same, mountable fuel injector may not be the
exactly suitable one, part number of fuel injector used in repair must be consistent with original fuel injector, wrong
replacement is not permitted;
2. To facilitate installation, it is recommended to apply silicon free clean engine oil on O ring surface at upper
part connecting distributing pipe of fuel oil. Pay attention not to let engine oil contaminate fuel injector inside and
jet orifice;
3. To remove and reinstall fuel injector, O ring must be replaced, here do not damage sealing surface of fuel
injector;
4. if fuel injector has two slots, when mount buckle clamp, pay attention not to clamp in the wrong position,
refer to mounting position of original parts;
5. It is strictly prohibited to remove strainer, clean or replace strainer at discretion; 6. after removal, ensure
cleanness of fuel injector holder, avoid foreign matter ingressing the cylinder.
Simple measuring method:
(Remove joint) turn digital multimeter to ohm position, connect two meter pens with fuel injector pins
respectively, rated resistance at 20°C is 11-17 ohm.
Suggestion: use special cleaning analyzer to conduct thorough cleaning for the fuel injector per 20000km.
10. Electric fuel pump
(1) Fuel pump is a vane pump driven by DC motor, is placed in oil tank, immersed in fuel oil, utilizes fuel oil
for heat dissipation and lubrication. Storage battery supplies power to electric fuel pump via oil pump relay, the
relay switches on electric fuel pump circuit only at the time of startup and during operation of engine. When engine
shuts down due to accident, fuel pump stops running automatically.
Symptom Common cause
Large running noise, poor speedup, failure to start 1. Gum builds up to form insulating layer;
(difficult to start) 2. Oil pump bushing is blocked with armature;
3. Fuel level sensor assembly is corroded etc.
Engine EFI System - Engine EFI System 5-125

Repair precautions:
1. according to engine requirement, electric fuel pumps with different flows are available, they have the same
appearance, mountable fuel pump may not be exactly suitable, during repair, part number of fuel pump used must
be consistent with original one, wrong replacement is not permitted;
2. in order to prevent fuel pump from damaging, please do not run it in dry state for a long time;
3. in case fuel pump needs to be replaced, please pay attention to clean fuel tank and pipeline and replace fuel
filter.
(2) Simple measuring method:
(Remove joint) turn digital multimeter to ohm position, connect two meter pens with fuel pump pins
respectively, measure internal resistance, it should not be zero or infinite (namely not in short circuit, open circuit
condition).
(Connect joint) connect fuel pressure gauge on sucker, start up engine, run the engine at idle speed, now fuel
pressure of engine should be about 260kPa; unplug fuel pressure regulator vacuum tube, now fuel pressure should
be about 300KPa.
11. Canister control valve
(1) Canister in fuel evaporation control system adsorbs oil vapor from oil tank until saturated. Electronic
control unit controls opening of canister control valve, fresh air and saturated fuel vapor in canister form
regeneration stream, which is led into engine intake pipe again. Electronic control unit changes duty ratio of pulsing
signal to canister control valve solenoid according to different operating conditions of engine, thus controls flow
of regeneration stream. In addition, this flow is also influenced by pressure difference at both ends.
Symptom Possible cause
Poor idle speed, malfunction etc Entering of foreign matter into valve inside results in
corrosion or poor leak tightness etc
Repair precautions:
1. To install, airflow direction must meet the specification;
2. when black granules inside valve body result in malfunction of control valve, and control valve needs to be
replaced, please check the condition of canister;
3. avoid water, oil etc liquids from entering valve as far as possible during repair;
4. in order to avoid transfer of solid-borne noise, it is recommended to install canister control valve suspending
on the hose or use soft rubber to fix.
(2) Simple measuring method:
(Remove joint) turn digital multimeter to ohm position, connect two meter pens with canister control valve pins
respectively, rated resistance at 20°C is 22 - 30 ohm.
12. Ignition coil
(1) When earthing channel of primary winding is connected, this primary winding is charged. Once ECU cut
off primary winding circuit, charging stops, high voltage is induced in secondary winding at the same time, so spark
plug discharges. Ignition coil ZSK 22 (both ends of 2 secondary windings are connected with a spark plug
respectively, so these two spark plugs ignite simultaneously.
Symptom Possible cause
Fail to start Too heavy current leads to burnout, damaged by external force

Repair precautions: it is prohibited to use "short circuit ignition testing method" to test ignition function, so
5-126 Engine EFI System - Engine EFI System

as to avoid damaging electronic control unit.


(1) Simple measuring method:
(Remove joint) turn digital multimeter to ohm position, connect two meter pens with primary winding pins
respectively, rated resistance at 2 0°C is 0. 4-0. 6 ohm for 2X2 type; on secondary winding, 11-15k ohm for 2x2 type.
13. Electronic control unit ECU

Engine ECU

Symptom Possible cause


Unsteady idle speed, poor speedup, failure to start, too high Electric overload of externally connected
idle, tail gas overproof, difficult to start, malfunction of air device leads to burnout of components inside
conditioner, malfunction of fuel injector control, flameout ECU and results in malfunction
Repair precautions:
1. Don't remove ECU at discretion during repair;
2. ECU may be removed more than 1 minute after removing storage battery head;
3. Store removed ECU properly;
4. It is prohibited to attach any circuit onto connecting wire of ECU.
Simple measuring method:
1. (Connect joint) use engine data K-line to read engine trouble record;
2. (Remove joint) check whether ECU connecting wire is in good condition or not, mainly check whether ECU
power supply grounded circuit is normal or not;
3. Check whether external sensor works normally, whether output signal is credible, whether circuit is in good
condition;
4. Check whether actuator works normally, whether its circuit is in good condition;
5. Finally replace ECU to conduct test.
Judgment principle: "two interchange principle" ---interchange ECU, interchange fault symptom.

III. Diagnostic system


Description:
When engine ECU detects a trouble, engine trouble warning lamp on instrument will illuminate. In addition,
relevant diagnostic code will be recorded in ECU memory. Connect handheld tester with diagnostic interface on
automobile, read various data from automobile ECU. Connect handheld tester with diagnostic interface. Technical
personnel may also read fault code via blinking of instrument fault warning lamp.
Engine EFI System - Engine EFI System 5-127

Terminal No. Terminal definition


4 Power supply (-)
7 Bus (signal)
Diagnosis connector 16 Power supply (+)

Notes: use tester cable to connect handheld tester with diagnostic interface, turn ignition switch to ON position,
operate tester, if tester displays that communication is not possible, the vehicle or tester fails.
Inspection diagnosis
1. Check engine fault warning lamp
(1) When ignition switch is turned to ON position and engine does not run, engine warning lamp on
instrument should illuminate.
(2) When engine runs, engine fault warning lamp should go out. If it still illuminates, diagnostic system
detects system fault or abnormity.
2. Use handheld tester to check diagnostic code
(1) Connect handheld tester according to corresponding pin.
(2) Turn ignition switch to ON position, turn on main switch of handheld tester.
(3) Use handheld tester to detect and check diagnostic code, refer to fault diagnostic code table. (For
operation of handheld tester, see instruction manual of handheld tester)
3. Engine fault warning lamp displays fault code through blinking code, so professional may make fault
judgment in case of emergency.
(1)Turn ignition switch to ON position.
(2) Short signal pin (9#) and negative pole (4#) for more than 2. 5s,then disconnect them,detection fault lamp
on dashboard will blink the faults in fault code according to their occurrence sequence.

See from terminal outlet Connect in jump way over 2.5s and
end disconnect

Diagnosis connector Diagnosis connector

(3) Each fault code will blink for three times, interval time is 3s, after blinking for the third times, after an
interval of 3s, next fault code will blink. After blinking of all fault codes is finished, they will blink from begining
again. The following diagram shows engine fault warning lamp blinking mode for oxygen sensor fault code 17.

2
Flashing way of malfuntion code 17 for O sensor
5-128 Engine EFI System - Engine EFI System

4. Eliminate fault code either by diagnosis instrument or manually. Manual operation method, specific
procedure: use engine data K-line (namely 9 # terminal of diagnostic interface) earth twice, earthing time is more
than 2. 5 s at each time.

Fault code table


No Faulty part Fault code Fault lamp Fault type
1 No fault 11 OFF -
2 Electronic control unit (unit) fault 34 ON 2
3 Knocking control zero test 1 OFF -
4 Knocking sensor 15 ON 2
5 Storage battery voltage 38 OFF 2
6 Intake pressure sensor 16 ON 1
7 Throttle position sensor 14 ON 1
8 Idle speed control valve 61 ON 1
9 Coolant temperature sensor 19 ON 1
10 Intake temperature sensor 18 ON 1
11 Engine maximum speed overrun 33 OFF 2
12 Fuel injector 1 22 ON 1
13 Fuel injector 2 23 ON 1
14 Fuel injector 3 24 ON 1
15 Fuel injector 4 21 ON 1
16 Fan relay 42 ON 1
17 Oxygen sensor 17 ON 1
18 Air fuel ratio control correction coefficient 31 OFF 2
19 ? self-learning value 1 35 OFF 2
20 ? self-learning value 2 36 OFF 2
21 ? self-learning value 3 37 OFF 2
22 Fault caution light 45 OFF 1
23 Canister control valve 25 ON 1
24 Air conditioner condenser temperature sensor 13 OFF 1
25 Phase sensor 43 ON 1

Fault type: 1-open circuit 2-signal overrun


No. 18 to 21 in the table refers to air fuel ratio correction coefficient,?=actual air quantity/air need for
combustion, "? self-learning value" is also called learning air fuel ratio control value.
On Board Vehicle Telephone - On-board Vehicle Telephone 5-129

Chapter 10 On-board Vehicle Telephone


I. Key points for use of Geely hands-free car telephone:
1. Microphone of hands-free car telephone is installed on the back of steering wheel upright column, away from
driver to ensure talking effect. During talking, do not open window, otherwise noisy wind might influence talking
effect.
2. Since there are many kinds of mobile phones in Chinese market, in order to ensure talking effect, please
select interface line corresponding to your mobile phone, otherwise talking effect might be influenced. At present,
Nokia, Motorola, Siemens interface lines are available.
3. To use, insert one end of mobile phone interface line into 8 core RJ 45 stand on automobile panel, connect
the other end to earphone output port of the mobile phone. When mobile phone is not connected, automobile sound
works normally, when mobile phone receive a call, CD becomes quiet automatically, at the same time, loudspeaker
in the vehicle is switched to hands-free telephone output. This hands-free car telephone is provided with response
button at the top of microphone, however, new style of mobile phone does not support manual response function
for the time being, while supports automatic response function, namely it receive the call automatically after
ringing for three times.
4. After talking is finished, automobile sound will return to original state automatically.
5. During daily use, note that contact insertion and withdraw force of mobile phone interface line should not
be too large, so as to avoid damage.
6. Hands-free car telephone has no volume switch, volume of loudspeaker voice may be adjusted by regulating
the volume of handset earphone.

II. Circuit diagram

Please Refer to "MK WIRING DIAGRAM"


5-130 On Board Vehicle Telephone - On-board Vehicle Telephone

III. Troubleshooting:
No. Symptom Possible cause
1.Whether power supply is normal or not.
2. Increase mobile phone output volume.
1 3. Confirm whether mobile phone interface line is correct, (replace
No voice can be heard from with new mobile phone interface line).
hands-free telephone
4. When mobile phone works, confirm whether there is relay
closing sound in hands-free telephone box.
5. If there is relay closing sound, check whether anything is wrong
with socket drop-out line.
2 Loudspeaker sound is light Adjust mobile phone output volume.
3 Connection is interrupted Check receiving signal of mobile phone.
Rear Parking Radar System - Rear Parking Radar System 5-131

Chapter 11 Rear Parking Radar System


I. System principle
Reversing radar system mainly adopts ultrasonic ranging technology, utilizes piezoelectric property of
transducer (ultrasonic sensor), excites piezo sheet with voltage with frequency of 40KHZ intermittently, this piezo
sheet is then converted from electric energy to mechanical energy and sent out. When emitted sound wave contacts
object, it will reflect weak sound wave energy to transducer according to sound wave reflection principle, i. e.
convert received weak acoustic vibration signal to electrical signal, after signal amplification processing, it is
transmitted to microprocessor to calculate the distance between vehicle and this object and display the distance.
Then microprocessor determines whether to give caution remind for dangerous object according to varying
degrees.

Ultrasonic sensor Transmitting Amplifier Phonetic circuit

Electric A/D switch


Receiving Amplifier

MCU Display
Transmitting Amplifier

Ultrasonic sensor Receiving Amplifier Receive, filter and amplify

II. Circuit diagram

Please Refer to "MK WIRING DIAGRAM"


5-132 Rear Parking Radar System - Rear Parking Radar System

III. Fault diagnosis


1. During detection, if there is no sound or display screen does not illuminate, please detect whether polarity
of power supply is connected in a wrong way, whether power cord is connected, whether supply voltage 9V,
whether display joint is inserted properly.
2. If clobber "0.0" or constant ringing occurs, please exit reverse gear, engage reverse gear again. If the
above symptom still exists, it may be deemed that principal machine is damaged, and should be replaced
completely.
3. If certain value is displayed, while there is no evident barrier at right ahead of probe. Prominence on or rear
might be detected (such as license plate, bumper bar etc). please check whether direction axis of the probe is
correct, horizontal axis of the probe should slightly upwarp.
4. When accelerating, the installed display shows irregular disordered frame, circuit interference might occur,
check earth wire of reversing radar.
IV. Installation of reversing radar
1. Reversing radar system consists of reversing radar principal machine, reversing radar display screen, wiring
harness, buckle and reversing radar probe etc.

About 500 mm

About 265 mm

Rear parking radarsensor

Rear bumper bar

Clip Push
Centralized Controller System - Function Inspectior 5-133

Chapter 12 Centralized Controller System


Section 1 Function Inspectior
I. Glass frame riser:
1. Glass frame riser may be operated to move within 60s after ignition switch is turned on or off; 60s after
ignition switch is turned off, glass frame riser cannot be operated to move;
2. Manual rise: press corresponding glass frame riser switch rise key, corresponding glass frame riser motor
works, glass frame rises, release rise key, it stops.
3. Manual fall: press corresponding glass frame riser switch fall key (hold time 300ms), corresponding glass
frame riser motor works, glass frame falls, release fall key, it stops.
4. Automatic fall: press corresponding glass frame riser switch fall key (hold time < 300 ms), corresponding
glass frame riser motor works, glass frame falls down to end; or fall down until rise key or fall key is pressed again.
Note:
During automatic fall of glass frame, if corresponding glass frame riser switch fall key is pressed down for more
than 300 ms, glass frame riser is changed to manual fall mode; if corresponding glass frame riser switch rise key
is pressed down for more than 300ms, glass frame riser stops work.
5. Remote window closing:
In case of remote protection, if a key is pressed down for more than 1s, perform glass frame riser automatic
rise action, left front, right front, left rear, right rear in turn.
II. Central lock:
1. In case protection is deactivated, use a key to open left front door switch or press internal unlock switch to
open four door fasteners; close left front door switch, close four door fasteners.
2. Remote unlock /lock:
(1) Ignition switch opening
a. Press remote control unlock key to open four door fasteners;
b. Press remote lock key to close four door fasteners;
(2) Turn off ignition switch
a. Press remote unlock key to open four front door fasteners, at the same time turn light flashes once.
b. Press remote lock key to close four door fasteners, at the same time turn light flashes twice.
(3) When door is opened, press remote fastener, turn light will flash for three times, at the same time electric
horn beeps for three times.
(4) If the system is triggered in anti-theft condition, when remote unlock system exits protection state,
directional turn signal will flash for four times, at the same time, electric horn beeps for four times.
3. Automatic lock
When vehicle speed exceeds 30km/h, three doors will be closed.
4. Door lock priority
Central door lock should not act simultaneously with glass frame riser; when they conflict with each other,
central door lock acts with priority, while glass frame riser stops; after central door lock action is finished, glass
frame riser continue its work in previous condition.
III. Front womdscreem wiper:
After spray water signal is finished, the wiper acts twice.
5-134 Centralized Controller System - Function Inspectior

IV. Post-defrost:
1. When engine speed exceeds 700rpm (ignition switch is turned on), defrost work is permitted.
2. Turn on defrost switch, perform defrost work for 12 minutes, if defrost switch is pressed down again during
defrost work, defrost work will stop.
3. During defrost, turn off ignition switch, cancel this defrost.
V. Light control:
1. Headlight:
(1) After press remote lock key to close four doors, if remote lock key is pressed down again twice in
succession within in 2s, dipped headlight will extend lighting for 1 minute; if remote unlock key is
pressed down within 60s, dipped headlight control output will be turned off.
(2) During output of 60s low level, if ignition switch is turned on, low level output will stop.
2. Ceiling lamp:
(1) When any of the doors is opened, ceiling lamp illuminates; if door is not closed, ceiling lamp will be
turned off after 10 minutes of delay.
(2) For closing of all doors, ceiling lamp will go out after time delay of 30s;
(3) In case all doors are closed,and ceiling lamp illuminates,ignition switch is turned on,ceiling lamp goes
out.
(4) For remote unlock, ceiling lamp illuminates; in case all doors are closed and ceiling lamp illuminates,
remote lock ceiling lamp goes out.
VI. Remote anti-theft
1. Protected state: press lock key on remote controller, while closing four doors, anti-theft indicator lamp will
flashes slowly, indicating that the system enters protected state, when the system is triggered, turn light of the
vehicle will flash, warning horn gives out alarm.
2. Cancel protection: press unlock key on remote controller, while opening left front door, anti-theft indicator
lamp flashes rapidly, if at least one of ignition switch, door is opened within 30 s, anti-theft indicator lamp will
go out; otherwise it will enter secondary anti-theft state.
3. Two stage type protection cancellation: while the system is in triggered state, press any key on the remote
controller, alarm sound will stop, however, the system is still in protected state, and car door is still locked; if the
system continues to receive invasion signal, alarm will ring again after brief stop. To cancel protection completely,
cancel alarm for the first time, then press unlock key once immediately;
4. Secondary anti-theft: after protection is cancelled, if any of ignition switch, door is not opened within 30s,
the system will restore alert status automatically, and lock the car door.

Distribution of centralized controller connector terminals:

Centralized
controller

Connector on wiring harness, as shown in the figure below (view from outgoing terminal):
Centralized Controller System - Function Inspectior 5-135

Connector A

Connector B Connector C

Definition of centralized controller terminals:


Terminal No. Conductor color Terminal definition
1 RY Power supply (+)
3 YR Speed sensor signal
4 BBL Engine speed signal
5 BR IG2
6 BL Spray water signal wiper switch 7#
7 GR Wiper intermittent position signal (+)
8 WR Right front door lamp switch
9 WB Left front door lamp switch
10 BR Hazard lamp switch
11 GND
14 WG Right rear door lamp switch
15 BW Left rear door lamp switch
19 Gr Rear right glass regulator switch (down)
20 VY Rear right glass regulator switch (up)
A
21 BG Turn light switch (right turn)
22 WG Turn light switch (left turn)
24 BLW Defrost switch
26 BR Left front door fastener unlocked signal
27 BY Left front door fastener locked signal
28 BG Anti-theft indicator lamp
29 R Rear left glass regulator switch (down)
30 O Rear left glass regulator switch (up)
31 GR Front right glass regulator switch (down)
32 WG Front right glass regulator switch (up)
33 BLB Front left glass regulator switch (down)
34 BLR Front left glass regulator switch (up)
35 GND
36 BL Antenna
5-136 Centralized Controller System - Function Inspectior

Terminal No. Conductor color Terminal definition


1 G Hazard lamp power supply
2 G Hazard lamp power supply
3 RY Dome lamp
4 Br Wiper motor (INT)
5 GND
6 GND
B 7 GB Right turn light and its indicator lamp
8 GW Left turn light and its indicator lamp
9 BLW IG2
10 Br Wiper switch 3#
11 RB Head light relay 85 #
12 RB Head light relay 85 #
1 YB Rear air window defrost and indicator lamp
2 YB Rear air window defrost and indicator lamp
3 RBL Rear air window defrost power supply
4 RBL Rear air window defrost power supply
5 GND
6 GBL Horn relay 85 #
7 R Electric glass frame power supply
8 GND
C 9 GND
10 RW Fastener power supply
11 RW Right front, right rear, left rear fastener
12 BR Right front, right rear, left rear fastener
13 WR Left actuator
14 BL Front left glass regulator
15 W Front left glass regulator
16 GND
17 WB Front right glass regulator
18 BLB Front right glass regulator
19 R Glass power supply
20 BLB Rear left glass regulator
21 WB Rear left glass regulator
22 GND
23 BLY Rear Right glass regulator
24 WY Rear Right glass regulator
25 RB Left actuator

Replacement
( 1 ) Remove dashboard subassembly (refer to trim)
( 2 ) Remove two bolts
Centralized Controller System - Remote Transmitter 5-137

( 3 ) Disconnect the connector


Repair precautions:
If a new centralized controller is replaced, it must be encoded again, only in this way could remote controller
use it normally.
We may adopt the method of replacing centralized controller to determine whether there is any fault.

Section 2 Remote Transmitter

I. Replacement of remote transmitter battery


Note:
Be very careful during operation, so as to avoid damaging
electronic components in the remote transmitter. When replacing the
battery, don't bend or contaminate electric pole, otherwise poor
contact might occur.

1. Unclench the remote transmitter housing with flat-tip screw 1


driver or similar tool.

2.press down the battery edge and take out the battery. 2

3.When replacing, please use CR2032 lithium battery or the same


class product.Ensure the new battery with anode upward.The re- 3
mote transmitter housing must be firmly encased.

After replacing the battery, check the remote transmitter operates


normally,
5-136 Door Glass Regulating and Power Door Lock Control - Door Glass Regulating System

Chapter 13 Door Glass Regulating and Power Door Lock Control


Section 1 Door Glass Regulating System
I. Inspection
1. Check basic function
(1) Ignition switch is turned "ON" or within 60 s after ignition switch is turned off.
a. Check when rise key of glass regulator switch is pressed, corresponding glass rises, when release, it stops
rising; when press fall key and hold it, corresponding glass falls, when release, it stops falling.
b. Check when glass regulator main control switch lock switch on driver side is pressed,except which on driver
side, other glass regulator switches do not act.
c. Automatic fall: press corresponding glass regulator switch fall key briefly,corresponding glass
regulator motor works, glass falls down to the end; or falls down until rise key or fall key is pressed again.
Notes:
During automatic glass down, if corresponding glass regulator switch fall key is pressed down and held,
glass regulator is changed into manual fall mode; if corresponding glass regulator switch rise key is pressed down
and held, glass regulator is changed into manual rise mode; if corresponding glass regulator switch rise or fall key
is pressed briefly, glass regulator stops work. Press briefly: less than 300ms; press and hold: more than 300 ms.
(2) Close window remotely.
In case setting protection remotely, if a key is pressed for more than 1s, glass regulator automatic window
rising action will be performed, implementation mode: left front, right front, left rear, right back, in the
process of window rise, only one glass regulator is permitted to act, only after glass regulator up to the top,
could the other glass riser act.
2. Glass reguelator switch on driver side

Glass regulator switch on driver side

Window on front passenger side


Window on driver side
Rear right window
Rear left window

Window locking switch


Door Glass Regulating and Power Door Lock Control - Door Glass Regulating System 5-137

(1) Check conductibility of the switch.


Standard

Switch position Terminal Result


UP 12---13 ON
On driver side
DOWN 12---14 ON
UP 12---5 ON
On front passenger side
DOWN 12---6 ON
UP 12---9 ON
Left rear
DOWN 12---10 ON
UP 12---1 ON
Right rear
DOWN 12---2 ON
Lock 12---3 ON
Window locking switch
Unlock 12---3 OFF

If it does not meet stipulation, replace this switch.


(2) Check indicator lamp on glass riser switch on driver side
Storage battery may be connected with terminal of indicator
lamp directly (as shown in the figure)
Standard

Connecting condition Result


Battery positive - terminal 11 Indicator lamp
Battery negative - terminal 12 illuminates

If it does not meet stipulation, replace this switch.


3. Other window glass riser switches (passenger side, left rear, right rear)

Other glass regulator switches


5-140 Door Glass Regulating and Power Door Lock Control - Door Glass Regulating System

(1) Check conductibility of the switch.


Standard

Switch position Terminal Result


UP 5-7 ON
DOWN 5-8 ON

If it does not meet stipulation, replace this switch.


(2) Check indicator lamp on switch
Standard

Connecting condition Result


Battery positive - terminal 4 Indicator lamp illumi-
Battery negative - terminal 2 nates

If it does not meet stipulation, replace this switch.

4. Check door glass riser motor


Notes:
(1) Detect door glass riser motor on driver side and on right rear Driver side, right rear side
side following the same steps.
(2) Detect door glass riser motor on front passenger side and on
left rear side following the same steps. Driving
shaft
(3) Connect door glass riser motor terminal with storage
battery, check operation of the motor.
Anticlockwise

Standard
Clockwise
Measuring condition Stipulations
Front passenger side, left rear side
Battery positive -1
On driver side, Clockwise Clockwise
Battery negative -2
rear right side
Battery positive -2 Anticlockwise
Anticlockwise
Battery negative -1
Battery positive -2 Driving shaft
Clockwise
On front passen- Battery negative -1
ger side, rear left Battery positive -1
side Anticlockwise
Battery negative -2
Door Glass Regulating and Power Door Lock Control - Door Glass Regulating System 5-141

5. Electric circuit diagramfor door glass regnlating system

Please Refer to "MK WIRING DIAGRAM"


5-142 Door Glass Regulating and Power Door Lock Control - Power Door Lock Control System

Section 2 Power Door Lock Control System


I. Inspection
1. Check basic function
a. When door lock control switch locks, four door locks are locked; when door lock control switch unlocks,
four doors are unlocked.
b. When door lock on driver side is locked using key, four door locks are locked.
Unlock
LOCK

Power door lock center control switch

2. Check door lock main control switch (1) Connection of terminals


Standard:
Terminal No. Door lock state Standard state
12-7 Lock ON
- OFF OFF
12-15 Unlock ON
If it does not meet stipulation, replace this switch.
3. Fastener inspection
(1)Apply storage battery voltage, check operation of the actuator.
Standard:

Measuring condition Standard state


Battery positive -1
Unlock
Battery negative -2
Battery positive -1
Lock
Battery negative -2
Lock

If not, replace actuator assembly. Unlock


Battery
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Front Seat Assembly 6-1

Part VI Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory


Chapter 1 Front Seat Assembly
I. Component View

Headrest

Front seat (L)

Inner seat rail cover


37

Seat backrest cushion

Outer seat rail cover

Cushion trim
Seat backrest trim

C-ring
C-ring Headrest bracket

Front seat adjuster


FL seat cushion inside stopper

Seat cushion Front seat-belt buckle assy.


Angle adjuster inside cover

Seat cushion frame

FL seat cushion stopper

Seat rail handle

21
N . m :Specified torque
Release lever
Non-reusable parts
6-2 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Front Seat Assembly

II. Removal and installation of front seat assembly


The operation procedure on the right side is identical with that on the left side.

1.Remove the front seat


a. Remove the headrest;
b. Remove the inner and outer seat rail covers;
c. Unfix 4 screws;
d. Disconnect the connector on the back of seat cushion;
e. Remove the front seat.
2. Remove the left front seat cushion outer stopper
a. Unfix the release lever;
b. Loosen 3 clips and then unfasten the outer stopper.

3. Remove the left front seat cushion inner stopper


a. Unfix the screw;
b. Loosen the clip and then unfasten the inner stopper.
4. Remove the left front seat-belt buckle assembly
a. Disconnect the connecting wiring harness;
b. Unfix the screw and then unfasten the seat-belt buckle assembly.

5. Remove the left front backrest trim


a. Turn the backrest over and unfix the C-rings;
b. Remove 2 headrest brackets;
c. Remove the backrest trim.
6. Remove the left front seat cushion trim
a. Remove the C-rings from the back of seat cushion;
b. Remove the seat cushion trim.

7. Remove the seat adjuster


a. Remove the seat rail handle;
b. Unfix the screw and then unfasten the seat rail.
8. Install the front seat assembly
Tips:
Install in reverse order of removal.
Install seat cushion frame with 4 bolts, Torgue:21N.m.
Install FL seat belt buckle assembly. Torgue:43N.m.
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Rear Row Seat Assembly 6-3

Chapter 2 Rear Row Seat Assembly


I. Component View

headrest pillow
lock-up handle of seatback
support of headrest pillow
support of lock-up handle of seatback

frame of right-rear seatback assembly of right-rear seatback lock-up


assembly of left-rear seatback lock-up
cover (cushion) of right-
rear seatback
side hinge of rear seat

cover (cushion) of left-rear


seatback frame of left-
rear seatback

arch ring

central hinge

side hinge of rear seat


central bracket of rear
seat cushion

rear row seat cushion lock


6-4 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Rear Row Seat Assembly

II. Removal & Installation of Rear Seat Assembly


1. Remove the rear seat cushion assembly
a. Pull out the front part of seat cushion upwards.
b. Release the wire harness of seat cushion from the central
protuberance, and remove the seat cushion assembly.

2. Remove the assembly of left-rear seatback


a. Fold the seatback;
b. Remove the clamp, and uncover the seat;
c. Remove the 2 bolts and seatback assembly.
3. Remove the assembly of right-rear seatback
Tip:
Apply the procedures the same as aforesaid for the left side.

4. Remove the assembly of left-rear seatback lockup


Remove the 2 bolts and the seatback lockup device off the
seatback frame.
5. Remove the assembly of right-rear seatback lockup
Tip:
Apply the procedures the same as aforesaid for the left side.

6. Install the assembly of rear seatback


Tip:
Follow the sequence reverse to removal.
All the bolts shall be installed with the torque: 18N.m.
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Front Seat Belt 6-5

Chapter 3 Front Seat Belt

Seat Belt Reminder System


I. Component View

DriverÕs seat belt reminder lamp

Left front buckle

II. Fault diagnosis

Symptom Possible causes


1. GAUGEfuse;
Driver's seat belt lamp is not on 2. Instrument cluster;
3. Left front buckle assembly
4. Wiring harness

III. Alarm system inspection


1. To inspect the left front buckle assembly
Check the conductivity of left front buckle assembly

Terminal Number Seat Belt Required


1<=>2 Insert OFF
1<=>2 Release ON
If you find that the result of the inspection is not the same as
required, you can replace the left front buckle assembly.
6-6 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Front Seat Belt

Detach and Mount Front Seat Belt


I.Component View

Rear door frame


weather strip

Front door frame


weather strip

Front doorsill shield


Rear doorsill shield

40~60
Remote adjuster assy.
for seat belt

40~60
Trim
Pulley cover

Front seat belt


assy.

Front seat assy.

47

Buckle assy.
Lower trim
40~60

20

N.m :Specified torque

II. Belt replacement


Notes: Installation is basically the reverse of removal and different operation(s) in the process of installation,
if any, will be pointed out specifically.
1. Remove the negative terminal of battery;
2. Detach the front seat assembly;
Loosen the front lock bolt and remove the buckle assembly from inside the front seat;
3. Use the screwdriver to detach the center pillar lower trim; Cut two clips and 4 buckles and remove the trim;
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Front Seat Belt 6-7

Notes:
Wrap the sharp end of screwdriver up with adhesive tape before
operation. Pulley cover
4. Use screwdriver to pry open the seat belt pulley cover;
5. Unscrew the bolt and detach the seat belt ring from the car;
6. Disconnect the pre-load insertion of seat belt on the bottom edge
of the middle pillar;
7. Detach the front seat belt from the car;
8. Unfix the clip using the screwdriver and detach the trim from the
right middle pillar;
9.Unscrew two bolts using the spanner and detach the remote adjuster
assembly.
Notice:Only the ignition switch turns to "OFF" position and the battery negative should be disconncted more than
90s, the seat belt with pretensioner can be removed.
III. Seat belt with ELR and pre-tensioner
Seat belt with ELR and pre-tensioner is provided with pre-tensioner which works together with the airbag.
The pre-tensioner is part of airbag assembly. The pre-tensioner is mounted in the retractor and controlled by SDM.
When the front bumping force of the car exceeds a specific value, the pre-tensioner and airbag can be triggered
at the same time. To maintain the pre-tension type of seat belt (retractor), observe all the "Alarm" and
"Operation Instruction".
Warning:
Do not try to remove or repair seat belt pre-tensioner. If any abnormal situations take place, replace the whole
assembly with a new one.
Before working, be sure to read through "Attention for Maintenance", and observe them during working. Any
ignorance can cause injury or the failure of seat belt pre-tensioner.
IV. Inspect Operations of Seat Belt Alarm Lamp (on Driver's side)
1. Turn on the ignition switch and check if the seat belt alarm lamp flashes;
2. Fasten the belt buckle and check if the belt alarm lamp goes out;
3. Turn off the ignition switch;
4. Disconnect the seat belt buckle;
5. Turn on the ignition switch;
6. Connect wiring terminal and make earth connection, and inspect the lamp status of the seat belt. Seat belt lamp:
flashing.
V. Inspect Seat Belt
1. Confirm whether the seat belt is properly mounted.
2. Inspect whether the metal part of seat belt is damaged.
3. If the car vibrates in accidents, pull out the seat belt from the retractor and determine whether the seat belt is
scratched (load limit retractor does not work) by visual inspection and touching.
4.Inspection contents before outer seat belt instalation:When ELR
lock,check the gradient of ELR. Check and make sure the seat belt
can not be locked from any aspect within 15°.When you move the Unlock
belt ring device beyond 45° slowly,the seat belt should be locked.
5.After installation check the seat belt lock in this way that draw the
seat belt from belt ring quiekly and the seat belf can be locked
normally.
Attention: Lock
Should the seat belt not comply with the technical specification,
you should replace it.
6-8 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Front Seat Belt

VI. Attentions:
1. Before mounting, you must check if the product is damaged, cracked or rusted.
2. Place the retractor on the vertical position before pulling out the strap. Check if the strap can be easily pulled
out and rotated and the retractor can be locked.
3. When installing a pretensioning seat belt, check if the emitter head pin deflects and is rusted, etc. The emitter
in the pre-tensioning seat belt can work for 15 years.
4. Check if the buckle lock and connection piece comply with the connection of the car. And check if the buckle
can be opened easily.
5. When fitting the bolts, check if the threads on the nut of coating are clear. Those with welding slag must be
cleaned before fitting the bolts.
6. After pulling out the strap of retractor, no barrier (such as wiring harness, etc.) around the strap is allowed. If
there is, it is necessary to get rid of the barrier to ensure the force of retractor and that the strap is not scratched.
VII. How to handle with scraped seat belt
Tips:
Scrap seat belt provided with pre-tensioner, you have to trigger the pre-tensioner taking the following steps.
1. Check if the storage battery is above 12 V on its positive and negative poles;
2. Check the energizing tool;
Warning:
When energizing the pre-tensioner of seat belt, be sure to use dedicated energizing tool for the pre-tensioner
of seat belt.
3. Connect the special tool with the storage battery and also connect
the red clip on the special tool with the positive terminal of the battery
and connect the black clip with the negative terminal of the battery;
4. If the front seat belt is on the car body and is not taken off,
disconnect the joint of the pre-tensioner of seat belt;
5. Connect the yellow joint of the special tool with the joint of the Above 10 meter

pre-tensioner of seat belt;


6. At 10 meter away from seat belt, use a special tool to trigger the
pre-tensioner of seat belt.
Warning:
a. Ensure that there be no people within 10 meters from the seat
belt;
b. If the seat belt has already been taken down from the car, it is
necessary to cover it using the car wheel with tire to avoid injury.
c. When triggering, explosion will emit loud sound. So it shall be
done outdoors without disturbing local community.
d. When you hold the triggered seat belt, be sure to wear gloves
and goggles.
e. After you have finished the operation, you must wash your hands.
f. Do not pour water, etc. to the energized seat belt pre-tensioner.
7. Place the already triggered seat belt into the ethylene bag and tighten it as you do with other articles.
Warning:
a. Do not dispose untriggered seat belt at will.
b. When the pre-tensioner of seat belt is triggered, the seat belt assembly would be very hot. Therefore, you
cannot touch it until at least 30 minutes after it is triggered.
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Rear Seat Belt 6-9

Chapter 4 Rear Seat Belt


I.Component View

RR/RH safety belt assy. Rear shelf trim


High mounted
stop light
assembly
Rear right C-pillar
upper trim Rear right C-pillar
lower trim

40¡«60N . m

RL/LH safety belt


assy.

Rear left C-pillar


lower trim

Rear left C-pillar


upper trim
Rear right buckle &
waistband Assy.
Rear right backrest
assembly

Rear left buckle assy.

Rear left backrest assembly

Rear cushion assy.


6-10 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Rear Seat Belt

II. Rear seat belt removal


1. Remove the rear cushion assembly;
2. Remove the rear backrest assembly;
3. Remove left (right) side quarter upper trim;
4. Remove the high mounted stop light;
5. Remove the rear shelf trim;
6. Remove the rear seat belt assembly;
a. Remove bolts under the quarter lower trim connecting the left and right rear side;
b. Remove bolts for the retractor and take down the rear seat belt assembly;
7. Remove bolts on the floor and disassemble the right rear seat belt buckle assembly and the waistband assembly;
8. Remove bolts on the floor and take down the left and rear buckle assembly.

III. Installing rear seat belt


1. Install the left and rear buckle assembly.;
As per the drawing, bolt the left and rear buckle assembly. on the
floor. Torque: 40~60N.m
Floor projection

2. Install the right rear seat belt buckle and the waistband assembly; Front Front mark

Tips: same as way of the left.

3. Install the rear seat belt assembly;


Unlock
Attention: Do not break down the retractor.
a.Inspection contents before outer seat belt instalation:When ELR
lock,check the gradient of ELR. Check and make sure the seat belt
can not be locked from any aspect within 15°.When you move the
belt ring device beyond 45° slowly,the seat belt should be locked.
b. Install the rear seat belt assembly using bolts (part of
Lock
retractor) ;
Torque: 40~60N.m
c. Install the rear seat belt assembly using bolts(part of anchor).
Torque: 40~60N.m

4. Inspect the properties of seat belt assembly;


5. Install the rear seat and trim.

IV. Precaution for Usage and Disposal of Used Safty Belt


The details are the same as front safty belt.
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Dashboard, Middle Console and Instrument Panel 6-11

Chapter 5 Dashboard, Middle Console and Instrument Panel


I.Component View

II.Component View

Instrument panel upper housing assy

Upper housing

Instrument cluster assy

CD player housing
6-12 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Dashboard, Middle Console and Instrument Panel

Instrument panel
lower housing assy

Steering column upper cover Glove compartment assy

Instrument cluster trim panel


Right
Combination
switch

Left Combination switch Cupholder

Steering column lower cover

Auxiliary fasia
console body

III. Removal and installation of instrument panel


1. Disconnect the negative terminal of storage battery

2. Remove the instrument panel trim panel sub-assembly


a. Loosen 7 clips;
b. Disconnect the connector and unfasten the trim panel.

7 clips

3. Remove the instrument cluster trim panel sub-assembly


a. Unfix the clamp;
b. Loosen 10 clips and unfasten the trim panel.

10 Clips
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Dashboard, Middle Console and Instrument Panel 6-13

4. Remove the instrument cluster assembly


a. Unfasten 4 screws;
b. Disconnect the connector and unfasten the instrument cluster
assembly.

5. Remove the glove compartment assembly


a. Detach the glove compartment assembly by pressing the top
releaser;
b. Pull the glove compartment upward and then take it out.

6. Remove the right front pillar trim panel


Unfix 2 clamps by use of a screwdriver and then unfasten the right 2 clips
front pillar trim panel.
Tips:
Protect the trim panel from damage by wrapping the sharp end of
screwdriver up with adhesive tape before operation.
Clip

7. Remove the left front pillar trim panel


8. Disconnect the right airbag connector
9. Remove the instrument panel sub-assembly
a. Unfix 6 screws <D>, <H> and 2 bolts <B>;
b. Unfix the screw <A>
c. Loosen 8 clips;
d. Disconnect the connector;

8 clips
Clasp
6-14 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Dashboard, Middle Console and Instrument Panel

e. Pull the instrument panel sub-assembly backward and then take it out.
10. Remove the instrument panel lower housing assembly
Loosen 6 clasps and then pull the lower housing assembly out.

6 clasps

11. Remove the radio set assembly with bracket


a. Unfix 4 screws;
b. Disconnect the connector and then unfasten the radio set
assembly with bracket.

12. Remove the horn button assembly


13. Remove the steering wheel assembly
14. Remove the steering column upper cover assembly
15. Remove the steering column lower cover assembly

16. Remove the cupholder

2 clamps
2 clips

17. Remove the auxiliary fasia console assembly


a. Unfix 3 screws;
b. Unfix 3 clips by use of a clip remover and then unfasten the
auxiliary fasia console assembly.
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Dashboard, Middle Console and Instrument Panel 6-15

18. Remove the auxiliary fasia console trim panel


Unfix 6 clips and then unfasten the auxiliary fasia console trim
board

19. Remove the instrument panel lower housing assembly


a. Unfix 2 nuts <I> and <J>, 2 bolts <B> and 3 screws <C>
<F> <H>; 6 clips
b. Unfix 16 clasps;
c. Unfasten the lower housing assembly.

16 clasps
6-16 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Windshield

Chapter 6 Windshield
I. Component View

Roof handle assy.

Ceiling trim

Right Sun Visor assy.


Right front bady
pillar upper trim
Front windscreen seal-
ing strip Sun Visor holder
Left Sun Visor assy.
Sun Visor holder
Glasses box assembly
(without moonroof)
Inside rearview mirror

Front windscreen stop

Polyurethane adhesive sealant

Left front body pillar


upper trim

Right front wiper


rocker arm Assy.

Left front wiper rocker arm assy.

Right vent cover assy. Vent cover seal

Left vent cover assy.


Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Windshield 6-17

II. Install and replace windscreen glass


1. Remove the rearview mirror assy.
2. Remove the cover assy.
a. Unfasten two bolts on the wiper and remove the wiper assy.
b. Remove bolts and clips from vent cover, and take down the left portion of the cover.
c. Remove the right part of the board.
3. Remove the exterior sealing strip of the windscreen glass.
a. As per the drawing, cut the sealing strip with a knife; cut
Attention:
Avoid damaging the car body.
cut
b. Tear away the sealing strip.

4. Remove windscreen glass


a. Guide iron wire through inner side right car body and glass;
b. Fasten a wood block or article of similar function to both ends
of the wire;
(Tips: Stick a protective film on the exterior surface to avoid stopper

it being scratched)
c. Draw the steel wire and cut the polyurethane adhesive sealant;
High-carbon steel wire
d. Remove the stop block;
e. Use a rubber cupule to detach the glass.

Safety pad
Attention:
1. When detaching the glass, be careful not to scratch the paint
or the inner and outer trims;
2. When removing the glass, leave as much as possible
polyurethane adhesive sealants.
Protective belt

5. Clean the windscreen glass;


a. Use drawknife to remove the remaining stop block and
polyurethane adhesive sealant;
b. Use clean gasoline to clean outer race of glass.
Attention:
Do not touch the glass surface after cleaning.

6. Install the stop block of windscreen glass (II)


(1) Clean the mounting position of stop block for glass;
(2)Install two new stops (with pressure sensitive adhesive) onto the glass.
6-18 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Windshield

7. Install stop block of windscreen (I)


As per the drawing, install two new stops onto the car body.

8. Install the polyurethane adhesive sealant onto the windscreen


Apply primer onto the mounting portion of polyurethane adhesive sealant for windscreen glass.
Attention:
3 minutes for adhesive drying
Once opened, the adhesive can not be used anymore.
Do not apply too much adhesive.

9. Install the seal for windscreen


(1)Apply primer G on glass edge and touching surface using brush or sponge;
(2)Install the sealing strip for windscreen.

10. Install windscreen


(1)Clean and tidy the car body contact surface;
a. Cut the polyurethane adhesive sealant on the contact surface
with a knife and clean it.
(Tips: Leave as much as possible polyurethane adhesive Mark
sealant.)
b.Clean the contact surface using cloth wetted with detergent.
(Tips: Even though all the polyurethane adhesive sealants
are removed, the car body yet has to be cleaned.)
(2)Place glass
a. Use rubber cupule to place the glass at a proper position;
b. Check whether the contact surface around the glass is
smooth;
c. Put reference marks between glass and car body. Correct
Attention:
Primer M
Check whether the stop block is well glued on car body and
whether it is correctly positioned. Wrong

(Tips: When using the original glass again, check and


correct the position of reference marks.) Primer M

d. Detach glass Adhesive


(3)Use a brush to apply primer M on the exposed parts of car
body.
Attention:
It takes three minutes for primer drying;
Once opened, primer M can not be used anymore;
Avoid daubing primer onto the adhesive.
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Windshield 6-19

(4) Use a brush to apply primer M onto the glass edge and contacting parts.
(5)Add the polyurethane adhesive sealants
a. Prepare a sealing gun with sleeve;
b. As per the drawing, use the gun to apply the polyurethane adhesive sealants around the glass.
(6)Install glass
a. Use cupule to place glass and align with the reference marks and press it gently along the edge.
b. Press the front surface of glass gently so that it comes to tight contact with the frame.
c. Use a scraper to clean the remaining polyurethane adhesive sealants.
(7)Inspect leakage and service
a. Leakage test will be carried out after the polyurethane adhesive sealants are fully solidified.
b. Use the polyurethane adhesive sealants to seal up all the leaking areas.
6-20 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Rear Window Glass (with Defrosting Heater Wire)

Chapter 7 Rear Window Glass (with Defrosting Heater Wire)


I. Component View

Rear right roof handle

Roof trim
Rear left roof handle

Rear windscreen stopper

Rear windscreen weather strip

Rear right C-pillar trim


rear windscreen glass

Windscreen glass
Hight mounted brake light assembly
weather strip

Rear left C-pillar trim

Rear shelf trim

II. Removal and Replacement of Rear Windscreen Glasses


Tip:
Installation is basically the reverse of removal and different operation(s) in the process of installation, if any,
will be pointed out specifically.
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Rear Window Glass (with Defrosting Heater Wire) 6-21

1. Remove the assembly of rear seatback; (Refer to "Removal and Installation of Seat")
2. Remove the interior decorative components of vehicle top; (Refer to "Removal and Installation of Interior
Decorative Components of Vehicle Top" )
3.Remove the upper decorative plate at the right-rear enclosure;
(Refer to "Removal and Installation of Interior Decorative Com-
ponents at side enclosure" )
4.Remove the assembly of high-level brake light;
(Refer to "Removal and Installation of Interior Decorative Com-
ponents at side enclosure" )
slot
5. Remove the assembly of trunk shelf; slot
(Refer to "Removal and Installation of Interior Decorative Com-
ponents at side enclosure" )
6. Remove the exterior seal belt of rear window glass; cut

(1) Cut apart the seal belt with knife;


Tips:
cut
Do never damage the vehicle body with knife.
(2) Pull off the cut seal belt by hand, and remove it.

7. Remove the rear window glass.


(1) Let the steel wire go through the vehicle body and the glass;
(2) Secure the wire at two ends with wood-block-kind-of objects;
(Tip: attach the protective film to the exterior surface to prevent
scratch)
stopper
(3) Pull the steel wire, and cut off the polyester urethane sticking/
sealing materials around the glass;
(4) Remove the stopper;
steel wire
(5) Remove the glass with the rubber extraction.
Tips:
Separate the glass carefully to prevent scratch on paint or
interior/exterior upholsteries;
Leave as much polyester urethane sticking/sealing materials
as possible on the vehicle body during the removal of glass.

8. Clean the rear windscreen;


(1) Remove the remained stopper, waterproof layer and polyester
urethane sticking/sealing materials with the scraper;
(2) Clean the exterior glass ring with uncontaminated petroleum.
Tips:
Keep off the glass surface after cleaning it.
6-22 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Side Inner Panel Trim

Chapter 8 Side Inner Panel Trim


I. Component View

Rear shelf trim

Left C-pillar upper trim

Door frame left


Left B-pillar upper weather strip
Pulley cover
trim

Left A-pillar
upper trim

Front door frame left


Rear left quarter lower trim
weather strip

Left B-pillar Rear left doorsill shield


lower trim

Left A-pillar lower


Front left doorsill shield
trim

II. Removal & installation Side Quarter Trim Assy.


Tips:
Installation is basically the reverse of removal and different operation(s) in the process of installation, if any,
will be pointed out specifically. Mounting and taking down at right side is the same as the left side.
1. Detach right doorsill shield Clasp
Use the screwdriver to loosen 7 clasps and detach the right front
doorsill shield.
Notes:
Wrap the sharp end of screwdriver up with adhesive tape before
operation.
2. Detach the left front doorsill shield.
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Side Inner Panel Trim 6-23

3. To remove the right rear doorsill shield.


Use screwdriver to loosen 6 buckles and detach the right rear
doorsill shield.
Notes:
Wrap the sharp end of screwdriver up with adhesive tape before
operation.
4. Detach the left rear doorsill shield.
Clasp

5. Detach the right front pillar trim


Use the screwdriver to loosen the clip and detach the right front
pillar lower trim.
Note:
Wrap the sharp end of screwdriver up with adhesive tape before
operation.
clip
6. Detach the left front pillar trim.

7. Detach the right center pillar trim


Use the screwdriver to disconnect 2 clips, 4 buckles and detach
the right mid pillar lower trim. clip
Notes:
Wrap the sharp end of screwdriver up with adhesive tape before Clasp
operation.
8. Detach the left center pillar lower trim.

Clasp
9. Detach the right center pillar upper trim.
a. Use the screwdriver to open the pulley cover of the seat belt;
b. Unscrew the bolts and detach the belt rings from the car.
c. Use the screwdriver to loosen the clip and detach the right
center pillar upper trim.
Notes:
Wrap the sharp end of screwdriver up with adhesive tape before
operation.
10. Detach the left center pillar upper trim.

clip

11. Detach the backseat cushion assy.


12. Detach the backrest assy.
6-24 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Side Inner Panel Trim

13. Detach the luggage shelf assy.;


a. Detach the high-mounted stop lamp assy.;
b. Unfix three clips;

clip

c.To pull the belt from the rift and detach the luggage shelf assy.;

cut

14. To remove the right quarter upper trim;


Use the screwdriver to unfasten 5 clips and 1 buckle and detach
the right quarter upper trim.
Notes: Clip
Before using the screwdriver, apply the tape to cover its head.
15. Detach the left quarter upper trim.
clip

16. Detach the right quarter lower trim.


a. Unfasten bolts and brackets.
b. Use the screwdriver to unfix 3 clips and detach the right quarter
lower trim.
Notes:
Wrap the sharp end of screwdriver up with adhesive tape before
operation.
Clip
17. Detach the left quarter lower trim.

18. Detach the ring front pillar upper trim.


Use the screwdriver to unfix 2 clips and detach the ring front pillar
trim. clip
Notes:
Wrap the sharp end of screwdriver up with adhesive tape before
operation.
19. Detach the left front pillar upper trim.
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Roof Trim 6-25

Chapter 9 Roof Trim


I.Component View

Rear roof handle assy.


Roof trim

Front roof handle assy.

Right sun visor assy.

Glasses box assembly


(without moonroof)
Left sun visor
assy. Roof lamp

Right roof handle assy.


Sun visor holder
Lamp shade

II. Removal and Installation Roof Trim Assy.


Tips:
Installation is basically the reverse of removal and different operation(s) in the process of installation, if any,
will be pointed out specifically.
Follow the same steps as you do with left side parts when installing the right side parts.

1. Remove side quarter trim assy.


2. Remove the right sun visor assy.;
Unfasten 2 screws;
3. Remove the sun visor assy..
Remove the left sun visor assy.;
6-26 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Roof Trim

4. Remove the indoor roof lamp assy.


a. Use screwdriver to unfix the 4 buckles and remove the
lampshade;
Tips:
Wrap the sharp end of screwdriver up with adhesive tape before
operation.
b. Unfix 2 screws and the roof lamp assy.

5. Remove the handle assy.


a. Pull down the handle and take out 2 rubber plugs from the holes where two bolts are positioned;
b. Unfasten 2 screws and remove the handle assy.

6. Detach the sun visor tightener.


(Take down anti-clockwise the sun visor fastener.)

7. Remove the top trim


Use a special tool to remove 3 clips and remove the roof trim assy.
clip

8. Installation is basically the reverse of removal.


Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Front Door Interior Trim 6-27

Chapter 10 Front Door Interior Trim


I.Component View

FL door glass guide

FL door glass

FL door glass outer weatherstrip

FL door glass rail

FL door glass inner weatherstrip


FL door
Handle bracket FL/LH glass corner trim
regulator FL door inside handle

FL door trim
FL door seal board pull handle

Switch panel
FL door muffler

FL door trim panel


6-28 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Front Door Interior Trim

II. Removal and installation of front door trim assembly


Notes:
Installation is basically the reverse of removal and different operation(s) in the process of installation, if any,
will be pointed out specifically.
Installation and removal on the right side is identical with that on the left side.
1. Remove the left front door trim board pull handle
Unfix 1 screw by use of a crosshead screwdriver and then
unfasten the pull handle.
Tips:
Protect the pull handle from damage by wrapping the sharp end
of screwdriver up with adhesive tape before operation.

2. Remove the glass regulator switch assembly


Hook
a. Loosen the hook and the clamp by use of a slot-head screw-
driver and then unfasten the glass regulator switch;
b. Disconnect the switch;
c. Unfix 3 screws and the trim board.

Clip

3. Remove the left front door corner trim


Clip
a. Loosen 2 hooks and clamps by use of a slot-head screwdriver
and then unfasten the corner trim.
Tips:
Protect the corner trim from damage by wrapping the sharp end
of screwdriver up with adhesive tape before operation.
Hook

4. Remove left front door trim board


a. Unfix the screw and 2 clips;
b. Loosen 7 clips by use of a slot-head screwdriver and then pull
the door trim board backward to unfasten it.
Notes:
Protect the door trim board from damage by wrapping the sharp
end of screwdriver up with adhesive tape before operation. Clip
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Front Door Interior Trim 6-29

5. Remove the left front door inside handle


Loosen 2 hooks, unfasten the left front door inside handle and
then disconnect 2 wires from the handle.

Hook
Hook
6. Peel off the rainproof film
7. Remove the speaker assembly

8. Remove the left front door glass and the left front door glass guide
Tips:
Protect the glass from scratch by inserting a cloth in the LF door
inner panel.
a. Unfix 2 bolts retaining the glass in place;

b. Remove the left front door glass;


c. Take out the glass guide.

9. Remove the left front door muffler


Unfix 2 bolts, 2 liners and the left front door muffler.

10. Remove the left front door glass regulator assembly


a. Disconnect the connector;
b. Unfix 6 bolts and left front door glass regulator assembly.
Caution
Be careful to prevent the glass regulator assembly from damage
when it is not supported by the bolts.
Notes:
Remove the left front door glass regulator assembly through the
service hatch.
6-30 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Rear Door Interior Trim

Chapter 11 Rear Door Interior Trim


I. Component View

Left window end cover


Rear Left corner glasses Rear left glass guide slot

Rear left corner window weather strip

Rear left window inner weather strip


Rear left window
guide track

Rear left window


outer weather strip
Rear left window

Rear left window regulator


assembly

Rear left door inside handle

Inside handle installation


bracket

Rear left door weather strip

Power rear window switch


Rear left door
grips
interior trim panel
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Rear Door Interior Trim 6-31

II. Removal and Installation of the Rear Door Interior trim


Tip:
Installation is basically the reverse of removal and different operation(s) in the process of installation, if any,
will be pointed out specifically.
The removal and installation at the right side are the same as those at the left side.
1. Remove the interior decorative plate handle of left rear door;
Remove a screw with the cross-head screwdriver, and then take
off the interior decorative plate handle of left-rear door.
Tip:
Wrap the head of screwdriver with belt before using it.

2. Remove the assembly of electric-driven window regulator switch;


a. Release the grips with the straight screwdriver, and then re
move the regulator switch off the decorative plate.
b. Disconnect the switch connector.

grips

3. Remove the interior decorative plate of left rear door;


a. Remove the screws and buckles;
b. Release the 6 buckles with the straight screwdriver, and hold
upwards the interior decorative plate of rear-left door to re
move it.
Tip:
Wrap the head of screwdriver with belt before using it.
clip

4. Remove the interior handle of left-rear door;


Release the 2 hooks, remove the interior handle of left-rear door,
and disconnect the 2 wires off the interior handle of left-rear door.
Hook
Hook

5. Remove off the rain-proof film on the door;


6-32 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Rear Door Interior Trim

6. Remove the rear left window and the guide slot of rear left window;
Tip:
Insert the duster cloth into the interior plate of door to prevent
scratch on glass.
a. Remove the left rear window;
b. Remove the screws and the 2 bolts;
c. Remove the guide slot of rear left window.

7. Remove the rear left corner window;

8. Remove the assembly of left-rear window regulator.


a. Disconnect the connector;
b. Remove the 4 bolts and the assembly of left-rear window
elevator.
Tips:
After removal of bolts, rear left window regulator may fall to
cause damage.
Tip:
Remove the rear left window regulator through the manhole.
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Front Bumper 6-33

Chapter 12 Front Bumper

I.Component View

Radiator grille assembly

Right bumper bracket

Front bumper
Left bumper bracket

Left bumper
bottom grille
Right bottom grille
Front bottom grille

Towing hitch cap

II. Removal and installation of front bumper


Notes:
Installation is basically the reverse of removal and different operation(s) in the process of installation, if any,
will be pointed out specifically.

1. Remove the radiator grille assembly


a. Unfix 2 bolts and clips;
6-34 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Front Bumper

b. Loosen the clips by use of a screwdriver and then unfasten the radiator grille assembly.
Caution
Protect the radiator grille from damage carefully by wrapping the sharp end of screwdriver up with adhesive
tape before operation.

2. Remove the front bumper


a. Unfix 2 bolts, 6 screws and clips;
b. Loosen 2 clips and then unfasten the front bumper.

3. Remove the left bumper bracket


Unfix 2 nuts and then unfasten the bracket.

4. Remove the right bumper bracket


Unfix 2 nuts and then unfasten the bracket.

5. Remove the left bottom grille


Loosen clips and then unfasten the grille.

6. Remove the right bottom grille


Loosen clips and then unfasten the grille.

7. Remove the front bottom grille


Loosen clips and then unfasten the grille.

8. Install in reverse order of removal.


Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Rear Bumper 6-35

Chapter 13 Rear Bumper


I. Component View

Right trunk trim board

Left trunk trim board Rear shelf lower trim panel

Spare tire board

Rear bumper support installation nut


Torque nut: 6 N¡¤m

Left mud guard

Rear bumper

II. Disassembly and assembly of the rear bumper


Notes:
Installation is basically the reverse of removal and different operation(s) in the process of installation, if any,
will be pointed out specifically.

1. Remove the spare tire cover assembly.


2. Remove the lower trim board of the rear separator.
3. Remove the ornamental blanket at the left side of the luggage compartment.
a. Remove six snaps.
6-36 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Rear Bumper

b. Remove the ornamental blanket at the left side of the luggage


compartment.
4. Remove the ornamental blanket at the right side of the luggage
compartment.
a. Remove six snaps.
b. Remove the ornamental blanket at the right side of the luggage
compartment.

5. Remove the rear bumper. Snap Rear bumper


a. Remove four nuts;
b. Remove two screws and four clips;
c. Remove 8 snaps and the bumper.

Snap
6. Mount the rear bumper.
Installation is basically the reverse of removal.
(Notes: Mount the rear bumper with two screws, 4 clips and 4
nuts; Torque: 5.5N.m, for the nut)
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Outside Rearview Mirror 6-37

Chapter 14 Outside Rearview Mirror


The outside rearview mirrors are mounted on the left and right doors. With specially designed rubber sheath, the
rearview mirrors are seamlessly and smoothly joined to the body of vehicle. Meanwhile, they block neither upward
nor backward turn of rearview mirrors upon knocking. Such installation also plays an important role in decreasing
the air resistance coefficient of the whole vehicle.
The mirror glasses are fixed to the supporting plates with double-side adhesive tape. The supporting plates are
connected to the shell of rearview mirrors with ball hinge in order to make sure no glass will scatter that causes
secondary injury, as well as replacing the damaged glasses easily. When the glasses are damaged, the supporting
plates can be taken out of the ball-head mount with tools, and then pressed into the mount again after replacing
the glasses. The turning force of rearview mirror is designed as 30N, which enables easy turn and less hurt/damage
in case human or object knocks the mirror. In addition, the rearview mirrors are equipped with electric adjustment
and heat defrosting.
Notes
When turning over the rearview mirror, please don't put your finger between the exterior rearview mirror and
the hinge in order to avoid extrusion injury!

Replacement of Rearview Mirror


Removal procedures
1. Remove the cathode lead wire off the storage battery;
2. Remove the corner decoration of door;
3. Disconnect the plug of electric-driven exterior rearview mirror;
4. Remove the 3 screws;
5. Remove the electric-driven exterior rearview mirror

Installation procedures
1. Mount the rearview mirrors onto the doors
2. Fasten the screws from the lower-left side clockwise
Fastening
Fasten the screws of exterior rearview mirrors with the torque
of 8.0N.m
3. Connect the plug of electric-driven exterior rearview mirrors;
4. Install the corner decoration of door
6-38 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Door Protecting Stripe

Chapter 15 Door Protecting Stripe


I. Removal and installation of door protector
Notes:
Installation is basically the reverse of removal and different operation(s) in the process of installation, if any,
will be pointed out specifically.
Installation and removal on the right side is identical with that on the left side.
1. Remove the door protector from the left front door
a. Use a heating lamp or a dedicated electric blower to heat up the door protector to 40~60°C.
Caution:Do not overheat the door protector.
b. Fasten both ends of the steel wire to the wooden handle.
c. Cut the adhesive tape by pulling the steel wire.
Protective tape
Caution: Make sure not to break the door protector to be
installed later.
Do not cause damage to the car.
d. Remove the door protector.
2. Install the door protector

Adhesive Band

a. Rip off the protective tape from the car;


b. Use a heating lamp or a dedicated electric blower to heat up the car exterior and the door protector.
Desired temperature
Car body 40~60°C
Door protector 20~30°C

Caution:Do not overheat the car exterior and the door protector.
c. Rip off the release liner from the door protector;
Caution
Make sure the adhesive tape does not get dusted or stained when
the release liner is ripped off.
Do not push the door protector too hard; make sure it is attached to the door firmly by pressing it with your
fingers.
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Carpet and Insulator 6-39

Chapter 16 Carpet and Insulator


Component View

Dash heat insulation panel

Dash sound insulation Assy.

Carpet

1. Removal
a. Remove front rear seat, left front doorsill, right front doorsill, right center lower pillar lower trim, left center
pillar lower trim, right rear doorsill shield, left rear doorsill shield, frontal and rear parts of auxiliary fascia
console;
b. Remove the sound insulator assembly under carpet and dash, the dash heat insulation (in compartment).

2. Mounting
a. Mount accelerator pedal assembly, brake and clutch pedal assembly, brake assembly onto the car;
b. Install the carpet according to the corresponding holes with its left and right edges mounted separately under
the left front doorsill shield, the right front doorsill shield, the right center pillar lower trim, the left center
pillar lower trim, right rear doorsill shield and the left rear doorsill shield.
6-40 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Moonroof Assembly (Optional)

Chapter 17 Moonroof Assembly (Optional)


Component View

Sunroof glass

Sunroof glass seal

Sunroof glass bracket

Sunroof frame

Bracket sub-assy.

Sunroof motor

Sunshade sub-assy

II. Inspection of sunroof


Troubleshooting form

Symptom Possible causes


1. Power relay
2. Instrument fuse
3. Sunroof switch
Sliding sunroof system doesn't work. 4. Sunroof lock switch
5. Sunroof motor
6. Sunroof guide rail
7. Wire harness
1. Sunroof lock switch
Sling sunroof system gets stuck (e.g. 2. Sunroof motor
foreign matter like gravel caught in motor) 3. Sunroof guide rail
4. Wire harness
Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Moonroof Assembly (Optional) 6-41

III. Removal and installation of sliding sunroof


1. Remove the roof panel trim
(For more information, see "removal and installation of roof panel trim".)

2. Remove the ceiling lamp


(For more information, see "removal and installation of roof panel trim".)

3. Remove the sunroof glass sub-assembly


a. Unfix the screw by use of a box spanner;
b. Pull the glass upward and then take it out.

4. Remove the sunroof motor


Caution
Make sure the sunroof is completely closed before removing the sunroof motor.
a. Disconnect the connector;
b. Unfix the bolt and then remove the sunroof motor.

5. Remove the sunroof bracket sub-assembly


a. Detach water pipe;
b. Unfasten the retaining bolts around the sunroof bracket sub-assembly;
c. Take out the sunroof bracket sub-assembly.

6. Remove the sunshade sub-assembly


Slide the sunshade backward and then take it out.

7. Remove the sunroof drive cable and the sunroof guide rail;

8. Install in reverse order of removal.


Caution
Check if the sunroof is waterproof after installation.
If a water leak is detected, readjust the sunroof.
For more information on the electrical part of sunroof, see the chapter on electrical part of this manual.
6-42 Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Plug List

Chapter 18 Plug List

No. Picture Material code Position Diameter Quantity

1 1018005004 Side Dash 25.5 2

2 1018005000 Front floor 13.5 4

3 1018005001 Front floor and rear floor 44.5 6

4 1018005003 Front floor 30.5 2

5 1018005002 Front floor 2

6 1018005005 Rear floor 2

7 1018005006 Side dash 11 2

8 1108005007 Positioning plate for taillight 9.5 2

9 1018005008 Front floor 9.5 4

10 1018005009 B-pillar 17 2

11 1018005010 B-pillar 25 4

12 1018005011 Front of Side dash 20 2


Interior & Exterior Trim and Accessory - Plug List 6-43

No. Picture Material code Position Diameter Quantity

13 1018005012 Under the Side dash outer plate 21.5 18

14 1018005013 B-pillar¡¡ 15 2

15 1018005014 C-pillar 40 6

16 1018005015 Doorsill 30 6

17 1018005016 Top cover 60 4


Body - Survey 7-1

Part VII Body


Chapter 1 Survey
Section 1 Body Structure
The body is made up of main structure, movable plate work, interior/exterior trim parts, and body accessories.
I. Main Structure
As shown in Fig.5-1, the main structure is made up of various assemblies and parts including engine compartment
assembly & front wall parts, floor assembly, left/right wall assembly, rear wall assembly, roof assembly and
luggage compartment main cover assembly etc.

6
5

1
3
7

Fig. 5-1 Main Structure


1 Engine compartment assembly & front wall parts 2. Left/right wall assembly
3. Luggage compartment main cover assembly 4. Rear wall assembly 5. Floor assembly
6. Roof assembly 7. Front cross beam assembly

(1) Engine Compartment Assembly & Front Wall Parts


The main function of the engine compartment assembly and front wall parts is to form an engine compartment
and absorb most energy generated when the vehicle is collided from the front. The compartment provides a hood
for the engine and its accessories, which can prevent the front wheel from throwing mud. In the appearance, it
represents the body's design requirements. As shown in Fig.5-2, the engine compartment assembly and front wall
parts include front cross beam assembly, left/right longitudinal beam assembly, radiator cross beam assembly,
7-2 Survey - Body Structure

front wall lower plate assembly, front wall upper assembly, left/right front damper support lower front plate
assembly, and right front damper right-angle support assembly.

6 3

Fig. 5-2 Engine Compartment Assembly & Front Wall Parts


1. Front cross beam assembly 2. Left/right longitudinal beam assembly
3. Panel left/right support assembly 4. Front wall lower plate sub-assembly 5. Front wall upper assembly
6 Radiator cross beam assembly

1. Front cross beam assembly


The front cross beam assembly includes front cross beam left/right support assembly, front cross beam sub-
assembly, front cross beam side support etc. They play a role in front bumper.
2. Left/right longitudinal beam assembly
The left/right longitudinal beam assembly includes left/right longitudinal bean front and mid- block assembly,
energy-absorbing beam big assembly, and left/right front damper support assembly etc.
It is mainly used to install engine left/right suspension, left/right front suspension damper, storage battery and
other accessories. In the outside, it can be equipped with left/right front fender.
3. Radiator cross beam assembly
The radiator cross beam assembly includes radiator left/right post big assembly, radiator lower cross beam big
assembly, radiator central support sub-assembly, and radiator upper cross beam big assembly etc.
It is mainly used to install radiator, condenser, engine hood lock, radiator hood, front bumper, and front
headlight.
4. Front wall lower plate assembly
The front wall lower plate connects to the floor, which separates the engine compartment from the cabin. It
includes front wall frame assembly, front wall lower main plate assembly, brake installation reinforced plate, and
front wall left/right support assembly etc.
Survey - Body Structure 7-3

It is mainly used to install the pipes and accessories of the brake system and clutch system.
5. Front wall upper assembly
The front wall upper assembly includes left/right hinge base mounting plate big assembly, front wall upper
front cover big assembly, VIN number mounting plate, and front wall upper rear cover big assembly etc.
It forms a high-stiffness frame structure together with the engine compartment assembly and the front wall
lower plate assembly. It can generate strong resistant to the transverse collision and rolling deformation. It can also
separate the engine compartment form the cabin, preventing the odor entering into the cabin. Consequently, it can
isolate the noise, heat and vibration.

(2) Floor Assembly


The floor assembly is the base work of the main structure. It is a key component that connects various
assemblies and carries the load. The vehicle performance is subject to its strength and stiffness. For the floor
assembly, see the Fig. 5-3.
The floor assembly includes front floor assembly and rear floor assembly. The front floor mid-block goes
through a ridgy channel in longitudinal direction. It can increase the longitudinal rigidity together with the lower
floor longitudinal beam. The space below under the channel is used to install various parts and components, such
as transmission gearshift rod, parking brake cable, discharge pipe with three-way catalytic converter etc. In the
cabin, there is carpet and muffle pad. The floor frame structure is made up of front floor left/right frame, front floor
main plate assembly, front floor mid-bridge assembly, rear frame assembly, rear floor rear block assembly, rear
floor mid-block assembly and longitudinal beam etc. These parts and components provide strong and reliable carry
capacity and ensure that the vehicle meets the strict driving requirement on the body.
1
2

3 5

6
3
1
Fig. 5-3 Floor Assembly
1. Front floor left/right frame 2. Front floor main plate assembly 3. Longitudinal beam rear block 4. Rear frame assembly
5. Rear floor rear block assembly 6. Rear floor mid-block assembly 7. Front floor mid-bridge assembly
7-4 Survey - Body Structure

(3) Side Wall Assembly


The left/right side wall assembly is a frame structure, which is a side component that connects the front and
rear parts of the body. As shown in Fig.5-4, it includes left/right side wall outside plate assembly, left/right wheel
assembly, left/right A post inside plate assembly, and left/right intermediate post interior plate assembly etc.

Fig. 5-4 Side Wall Assembly


1. LH/RH upper front body inner pillar 2.LH/RH lower front body inner pillar 3.LH/RH no.1 crossemember joint panel
4.LH/RH roof inner rail 5.LH/RH center body inner pillar 6.LH/RH rear crossmember tee joint panel
7.LH/RH lower rear pillar remforcement panel 8.LH/RH roof rear inner panel 9.LH/RH side rear pillar inner panel
10.LH/RH luggage compartment support panel 11.LH/RH luggage compartment hinge fixing panel
12.LH/RH wheel house outer panel 13.LH/RH wheel house inner panel 14.LH/RH side panel
15.LH/RH rear combination lamp fixing panel 16.Fuel refilling cap assembly 17.LH/RH side doorsill outer reinforcement panel
18.LH/RH side doorsill inner reinforcement panel 19.LH/RH center pillar upper reinforcement panel
20.LH/RH front seat belt upper reinforcement panel 21.LH/RH roof rail upper master reinforcement panel
22.LH/RH center pillar middle reinforcement panel 23.LH/RH center pillar lower reinforcement panel
24.LH/RH roof rail assistant reinforcement panel 25.LH/RH front body pillar upper reinforcement panel
26.LH/RH front body pillar outer reinforcement panel
Survey - Body Structure 7-5

(4) Rear Wall Parts


As shown in Fig.5-5, the rear wall assembly includes rear wall plate, rear wall reinforced plate, luggage
compartment door lock mounting plate and luggage compartment door cross beam etc.

1
2

3
Fig. 5-5 Rear Wall Assembly
1. Rear wall upper cross beam
2. Luggage compartment lock
mounting plate big assembly
3. Rear wall left double-hole plate
4. Rear wall outer plate

It is mainly used as a cross beam to improve the strength of the rear part of the vehicle and form a luggage
compartment door.

5) Roof Assembly
The roof assembly includes roof outer panel, roof No.1 and No.2 cross beam, and roof rear cross beam etc.
Inside the roof, there is top interior decoration. There is a heat pad in the center and there is bond between the cross
beam and the roof. The rain from the roof is discharged out of the rear part through the channels at both sides. These
cross beams are used to reinforce the roof's transverse stiffness. For disassembled parts, see Fig. 5-6.

1
1

4
4
6
2 3 5
Fig. 5-6 Roof Assembly
1. Roof outer panel 2. Roof No.1 cross beam 3. Roof No.2 cross beam 4.Roof rear cross beam 5.Roof No.3 cross beam
6. Moon roof reinforcement panel

(6) Luggage Compartment Main Cover Assembly


The luggage compartment main cover assembly includes luggage compartment main cover sub-assembly, rear
seat hook mounting plate assembly, left/right side angle plate, drip channel and reinforced upper cross beam etc.
When the luggage compartment main cover assembly is welded to the left/right side wall, it forms a luggage
7-6 Survey - Body Structure

compartment together with the rear floor and side walls. As shown in Fig. 5-7, a torsion resistant frame is also
formed at the rear part at the same time.
3
2

Fig. 5-7 Luggage Compartment Main


Cover Assembly

2 4 1. Luggage compartment main cover


2. Rear seat hook mounting plate assembly
3. Left/right side angle plate
4. Drip channel
3

II. Movable Plate Work


(1) Engine Hood & Front Fender
The engine hood is used to protect the engine and fit the vehicle design. It is also helpful to the repair and
maintenance, and isolates the engine's noise. The engine hood has a double-lock device. The unlocking function
of the first locking is controlled by the cable handle under the instrument board. The unlocking function of the
second locking can raise the hood to a certain height. The double-lock function is designed in consideration of
safety. Especially when the vehicle is running at a high speed, it can prevent the engine hood from being raised,
which may cause traffic accident. The maximum angle at which the engine hood opens is 65°(See Fig.5-8).

Max. opening angle less


than 65°

Fig. 5-7 Engine Hood & Front Fender


2 1. Engine hood
2. Hinge pin
3
3. Hinge support
5 4 4. Hinge
5.Inner hood panel
Survey - Body Structure 7-7

(2) Front Fender


Front fender plays a role in front wheel apron and rotect person safty.And at the same tirne,if also woork as vehicle
styling parts.
For the match relationship between the front fender & engine hood and the front door, see Fig. 5-9.
Engine hood
Front fender

Front door Front fender

Fig. 5-9 Front Fender related to surrounding parts


A) With Engine Hood (4mm¡À1mm)
B B) With Front Door (5mm¡À1mm)

(3) Door Assembly


Doors have LH/RH front door and rear door.
The door uses hinge gemel with limiting device, which is an open structure.
The door includes door outside plate, door inside plate, bumper and hinge reinforced plate etc.
The door has a complex structure, which is a movable component on the body. It helps the passengers get on/
off the vehicle and form an enclosed cabin with the main structure and the relevant parts. Meanwhile, the doors
are used frequently, so there is high requirement on their reliability and durability.
The outside/inside plate is molded by one complete steel sheet, which can improve the stiffness and precision.
In order to improve the safety when the vehicle is collided from the side, four doors are equipped with door
bumpers.
As shown in Fig. 5-10 and Fig. 5-11, the door assembly is made up of outside plate assembly and inside plate
assembly. 1
2
10

8
6

Fig. 5-10 Front Door


7
1. Front door inner panel 2. Left front door inner reinforced panel 3. Front door window opper rail 4. Door lock reinforced panel
5. Left front door inner plate cross beam 6. Front door outer panel 7. Door bumper assembly
8. Front door upper hinge assembly 9. Front door lower hinge assembly 10. Hinge reinforced panel assembly
7-8 Survey - Body Structure

1 2

8
5
4
7

Fig. 5-11 Rear Door


1. Rear door inner panel 2. Rear door inner lock mounting panel 3. Rear door glass rail 4. Rear inner plate cross beam
5. Rear door outer panel 6. Door bumper assembly 7. Rear door lower hinge assembly
8. Rear door upper hinge assembly 9. Rear door inner plate hinge reinforced panel

(3) Luggage Compartment Cover Assembly


As shown in Fig. 5-12, the luggage compartment cover assembly includes luggage compartment cover outside
plate, luggage compartment cover inside plate, luggage compartment cover hinge mounting plate, and luggage
compartment cover lock core mounting plate etc.

Fig. 5-12 Luggage Compartment Cover


1. Hinge torsion spring 2. Hinge mounting panel 3. Luggage compartment cover hinge
4. Luggage compartment cover inside panel 5. Luggage compartment cover outside panel
6. Luggage compartment cover lock core mounting panel
Body Repair - Body Damage Forms and requirements For Repair 7-9

Chapter 2 Body Repair


Section 1 Body Damage Forms and requirements For Repair

I. Damage Type
The damage type includes deformation, crack, rust-through, water leakage, dust leakage and the like caused
by collision, overload, fatigue, and corrosion.
The body damage is not merely caused by the huge force. As some parts (such as door etc.) are damaged, the
vehicle stays in an abnormal status, which also can cause damage. In most cases, the bend and torsion is caused
by huge local load in the impact or turnover accident.
Typical Body Damage:
1. Front Center Collision (Fig. 5-13)

Fig. 5-13 Front Center Collision

For the damage caused by the collision on the front center, it usually makes the engine compartment front part
and the engine hood left/right side extend inwards so the following positions shall be checked:
a. Ambience of the left/right assembling position of the hood plate
b. Ambience of the joints of the front cross beam and the left/right longitudinal beam
2. Front External Force or Left External Force (Fig. 5-14)

Fig. 5-14 Front External Force or Left External Force

As shown in Fig. 5-14, when the front is pressed or the left side end is acted by the external force, the external
force will spread to around the front suspension mounting position from the left/right side of the hood, so
deformation occurs easily in this position.
7-10 Body Repair - Body Damage Forms and requirements For Repair

3. External Force Having an Angle with Vehicle Centerline (Fig. 5-15)

External Force

Fig. 5-15 External Force Having an Angle with Vehicle Centerline

As shown in Fig. 5-15, when the vehicle is acted by an external force having an angle with its centerline, the
force will affect the hood root and the front window side post if it is strong enough.
4. Body Side Center Acted by External Force in Upright Direction (Fig. 5-16)

External Force

Fig. 5-16 Body Side Center Acted by External Force in Upright Direction

As shown in Fig. 5-16, when the body side center is acted by an external force in the upright direction, check
the following positions:
a. Front window side post upper/lower installation position;
b. Side window intermediate post upper/lower installation position;
c. Side window rear post deformation;
d. Roof and frame deformation.
When the body is acted by an external force on the rear part, its damage is the same as that caused by an external
force on the front part. Check the parts in full consideration of the rear structure and feature.
Body Repair - Body Damage Forms and requirements For Repair 7-11

II. General Repair Principle


1. Precaution Windshield
covering
(a) Vehicle Protection
In the welding process, make sure to protect the paint, windshield,
seat and carpet with heat-resistant and fireproof covering.

Seat covering

(b) Safety Measures


(1)When pulling the body or crossbeam with drawing device, do
not stand at the position in the same line of the drawing cable,
and make sure to use safe drawing cable.

Wrong

(2)Before repairing, make sure to check whether there is any


leakage. In case of any hole, remove it immediately.
(3)When welding near to the oil tank, make sure to remove the
oil tank first, and block the oil pipe.

Wrong

(c) Protective Article


In the repairing process, make sure to wear uniforms, helmet and
safety shoes. In addition, according to the different work types,
wear proper gloves, welding mask, goggle, earplug, face cover,
and dust respirator etc. Wear the protective devices properly as
the table below.

Code Item
A Dust Respirator
B Mask
C Goggles
D Safety Shoes
E Welded Goggle
F Earplug
G Welded Mask
H Welded Gloves
7-12 Body Repair - Body Damage Forms and requirements For Repair

III. Correct & Efficient Repair


1. Removal
(a) Measure dimension before removal
Before removal and cutting operation, make measurement as
the body dimension drawings. Make sure to pull the damaged
body or crossbeam with drawing device.

(b) Cutting part


Cutting position
When working on the cutting part, make the cutting in a straight
Reinforced plate
position without reinforced plate.

Bend position

(c) Boring/cutting precaution


In the boring or cutting operation, make sure whether there is
any oil pipe or cables etc on its back side, otherwise they may
be damaged.

Wrong

(d) Removal of ambient components


When removing the ambient components, make sure to adhere
protective tape on the body and disassembly tool to prevent the
body or ambient components being damaged.

2. Installation Preparation
(a) Precaution
When the steel plate to be welded exceeds 3mm
thick, make hole-filling welding with MIG welder.
Tips: If the total thickness exceeds 3mm, the spot can not
provide adequate welding strength. Larger than 3mm
Body Repair - Body Damage Forms and requirements For Repair 7-13

(b) Apply special paint for spot welding


Remove the paint film from the new parts to be welded and the
body, and apply the special paint for spot welding.

(c) Bore for hole-filling welding


In the position that can not carry out the spot welding, bore it
with borer or bit to make hole-filling welding.
Unit: mm
Plate Thickness Hole Diameter
<1.0 >5
Hole filling
1.0~1.5 >6.4
>1.5 >8

(d) Precaution for electronic parts


(1) In the welding process, the electronic parts may be damaged
due to the current in the body.
(2) Before the welding, cut the cathode connection of the
storage battery, and put the ground end of the welder on the
ambiance of the welding area.

(e) Rough cutting of joint parts


In the rough cutting process in the connecting area, an overlap
Pneumatic saw Overlap
of 20~30mm must be reserved on the new parts.

3. Installation
(a) Measure before Welding
Before installing the lower body or the parts of the engine
compartment, make sure to make measurement as the body
dimension drawing, to ensure the correctness. After the
installation, reconfirm whether the assembling is proper.

Body dimension
drawing
7-14 Body Repair - Body Damage Forms and requirements For Repair

(b) Precaution
(1) For the number of spot welding, it depends on the following
principles.
Spot welding:1.3 times of the number specified by the manufacturer
Hole-filling welding: more than the number specified by the
manufacturer
(2) When carrying out the hole-filling welding, MIG welder
shall be used. It is not allowed to use the oxyacetylene Wrong

welding or braze welding outside the specified area.


(c) Abrasion after welding
(1) After the welding, make sure to check the welding position
whether it is welded firmly.
(2) When abrading the welding position with disc abrader,
never abrade it too much, which may weakens the strength
of the welding position.
Correct Wrong

(d) Precaution of spot welding


(1) The shape of the spot welder head may affect the strength
of the welding.
(2) Make sure to remove the paint film on the surface of the spot
welding and the contact surface of the welder head.

Spot welding head scraper

(e) Position of spot welding


New welding position
In the spot welding process, overlap with the old welding
Old welding
position shall be avoided. position

4. Anti-rust Processing
Sealant gun
(a) Apply sealant
In the waterproof and antirust part operation, make sure to
apply the sealant on the joint of the steel plates,door,and engine
hood corner.
Body Repair - Body Damage Forms and requirements For Repair 7-15

(b) Apply primer


In order to prevent rust and protect the body steel plate from
being damaged by the bouncing stone, sufficient primer is
applied onto the body base and inner wheel cup.

(c) Apply antirust (wax)


In order to prevent the painting part from rusting, sufficient
antirust is applied on the engine cover, door inner corner, hinge
ambiance, or in the inside welding part of the box section
structures such as side beam, body post.

5. Base Anti-rust Processing


Impact-proof Coat
In order to avoid corrosion and protect the body from being damaged by bouncing stone on the road, a layer
of impact-proof coat is applied on the door threshold plate, arc area and balancing plate etc.
Tips: There are two types of painting: impact-resistant coat on the electrophoresis primer or on the surface paint
according to different types and painting positions. (See Fig.5-22)

Apply the impact-proof coat on the surface paint Apply the impact-proof coat on the electrophoresis primer

Surface paint
Impact-proof coat
Intermediate primer
Surface paint
Impact-proof coat
Intermediate primer
Electrophoresis primer Electrophoresis primer
Steel sheet Steel sheet

Fig. 5-22

IV. Repair Requirement


1. As the body is an integral structure and the steel plates used are not thick, special attention shall be paid to
reinforce the parts acted in the reshaping process in the plate work processing. For the parts that burden the stress
intensively, measures shall be taken to lower the local stress.
2. After the plate work processing, note to apply the antirust primer on the inside and outside surfaces to avoid
corrosion.
3. In the body repair process, repair the old parts; or remove the parts with serious defects and order new parts
from the manufacturer.
4. When making body reshaping or parts welding, make sure that all main control points of the body are within
the specified scope in the design.
5. The strength and serviceability of the repaired body shall not be lower than those of the new vehicle.
6. The outside decoration of the repaired body shall meet the requirements by the new vehicle body and the
drivers in various aspects, such as modern aesthetics and ergonomics etc.
7-16 Body Repair - Typical Technique of Body Panel Repair/ Repair After Body Damage

Section 2 Typical Technique of Body Panel Repair


Repair Process Flow:
Visual Inspection
Remove Remove Paint Appraise
& Appraisal

Platework
Assemble Paint
Repair

Section 3 Repair After Body Damage


The body damage repair includes rectification, reshaping, reinforcing, local change, and complete replacement.
Generally, CO2 welding method is used.

I Reshaping Repair
1. Rectification
In general, the deformation of body is caused by accident. It can be rectified in a supporting method. In the
rectification process, apply the force in the direction against the force of accident or deformation. In most cases,
cold rectification can be used. Local heating can reduce internal stress, and the corresponding processing shall be
carried out.
For the limousine, it is preferred to rectify it with the dressing machine. All dimensions and tolerances of all
parts shall be returned to the original standard, so the mobility, serviceability and comfortableness can be
guaranteed. (Fig.5-23)

Fig. 5-23 Mounting Bench of Universal Dressing Machine


Body Repair - Repair After Body Damage 7-17

The body repair starts from the primary rectification or rough rectification. The deformation can be removed
with the supporting method. The angle of the supporting force shall be close to the angle of the external force that
caused the damage. Apply a counterforce at the back of the pulling force point to adjust the supporting force. Make
measurement on the deformation generated in the supporting process. To remove the internal stress, heat the
corresponding parts. For different rectification methods, see Fig. 5-24.

washer

Fig. 5-24(a) Drawing Rectification Fig. 5-24(b) Drawing & Supporting Fig. 5-24(c) Auxiliary Force-receiving
Rectification Point Rectification

2. Reinforcement
When the local damage, rupture or crack occurs on various components, repair can be made by reinforcement.
Especially for those parts on which damage occurs frequently, special reinforcement measures shall be taken.
However, random reinforcement or component welding shall be avoided, which may affect the body's status.
The reinforcement includes bushing reinforcement, patching reinforcement, arc inlay, and angle plate reinforcement.
3. Local Removal & New Parts Replacement
For the parts with serious corrosion, they must be removed. For the ruptured parts, they shall be replaced
entirely. For the posts manufactured with thin plate by punch, they shall be ordered from the manufacturer. When
the molding is made independently, all specifications (including material, section dimensions and thickness etc.)
shall meet the original design requirement. For the ruptured post (including cross beam), if it is replaced entirely,
it must be connected in the same manner as that of the original post.

II. Repair for Body Outside Plate


1. Damage Type
a. Crack & Rupture
In the running process, the body vibrates continuously and burdens the loads. When the vehicle makes accident
acceleration, sharp swerve an emergency brake, the body will keep in an inertial status. When the vehicle runs on
the uneven road, bend and distortion will happen on the body.
Affected by these external forces for a long time, crack and rupture may occurs on the stress concentrated parts
and weak structure on the body outside plate.
The stress mostly concentrate on the corner, hem and narrow part of the outside plate, so crack and rupture often
occur on these parts.
b. Corrosion
The corrosion on the outside plate is mostly caused by the mud and water on the metal surface. Only in special
case, it results from the chemical corrosion by chemicals. When the corrosion occurs, rust may appear on the
outside plate and fall gradually, resulting in a hole. On the skirt outside plate and launder, corrosion usually occurs
on the seams between door and frame and the interlayer between the outside plate and the frame.
c. Cave-in
7-18 Body Repair - Repair After Body Damage

The cave-in is mainly caused by collision and extrusion. For the light cave-in damage, the metal doesn't extend,
which is plastic deformation. If the collision or extrusion is serious, the metal plate will rupture. For the vehicles
running in the city, it is common that collision damage occurs on the side wall.
d. Bend & Distortion
Bend and distortion belong to mechanical damage. Bend and distortion may have a variety of causes, such as
collision or extrusion, alternating loads generated by the vibration, accident acceleration, emergency brake, sharp
swerve and body torsion caused by poor road.
For the light distortion, it shall be confirmed by test. For the serious bend and distortion, it is obvious in the
appearance. Generally, the distortion can be fixed according to the clearance of the frames and the change of their
relative positions.
e. Unsoldering
The unsoldering is caused by the poor fusion between different metal plates.
2. Outside Plate Repair
a. Repair for Crack
(a) CO2 Welding
The crack on the metal outside plate can be repaired by CO2 welding. In the welding process, align the two
metal plates, and weld the outside crack of the plate first. If the crack doesn't exceed 50mm, the welding shall start
from the rear part of the crack and continue along the crack and edge. If the crack is a little longer, several points
shall be welded first at a certain space. After welding several points, finish them and then weld the crack block
by block. By so doing, it can prevent the metal overroasting and plate deformation caused by too high temperature.
If the crack is located in the position that burden heavy force and it is convenient to carry out the welding operation,
a double-welding method can be used. After the spot welding is made outside, carry out the welding inside. After
the inside welding is completed, make the welding outside in the same manner.
After the welding, put a sizing block inside, and beat from the outside welding line with hammer to remove
the retaining stress. Finally, finish the welding
seam properly to make it even and smooth for
painting.
(b) Solder Filling
For the fine concavo-convex plate with
damage and crack on its surface, it can be re-
paired with a solder filling method. (Fig. 5-25)

Fig. 5-25 Concave Body Filling Repair


b. Repair for Local Damage
For the local corrosion or serious mechanical damage on the outside plate, if it can't be repaired in common
method, the patching or pasting repair method can be used.
Repair Method:
(a). Fix the patching scope;
(b). Cut the paper sample;
(c). Cut the plate as per the sample;
(d). Adhere the molded plate on the surface of the patching part;
(e). Line out the profile along the plate edge with needlepoint, and cut off the damaged or corroded part;
Body Repair - Repair After Body Damage 7-19

(f). Flatten the edge with hammer or sizing block, and remove the burr with file to make sure that it is aligned
with the both side alternative plates with a clearance not more than 1mm;
(g). Replace the plate, and clamp it with pincers. Carry out the spot welding along the seam at a space of
approximately 50mm;
(h). Make the welding from the center to both sides alternately block by block. Which can reduce the
deformation;
(i). Strike the welding line with the hammer or sizing block to remove the retaining stress. Polish the welding
lien wit the file or manual grinding wheel to make it even and smooth for the painting.
c. Repair for Accidented Damage
(a). Plate work flattening
When the accidented damage occurs on the plate work of the body, it can be repaired by means of beating.
In the repair process, start from Point C as shown in Fig. 5-26. Put the sizing block on the convex point, and beat
it with the hammer and change the block's position correspondingly. When the convex point is flattened, the
concaved part in Point B will rise. Similar wit the original profile of the plate, for the remaining dent, a sizing block
with the same radian can be employed. Press the bottom of the plate with hand, and beat the high point of the dent
with the hammer. (Fig. 5-27)

Fig. 5-26 Plate Work Flattening (I) Fig. 5-27 Plate Work Flattening (II) Fig. 5-28 Heating & Planishing
A. Impact point B. Concaved point after impact A. Hammer B. Plate work Convex Point
C. Convex point after impact C. Sizing block 1. Heating point

In the beating process, beat the work piece heavily at the beginning and lightly at the end. Attention shall
be paid to reduce the number of beating as possible as it can. Don't beat the same points repeatedly to prevent the
metal plate extending locally, which can complicate the repair work.
For the larger arc concave, a sizing block can be used under the center of the concave. The area of the sizing
block shall be a little larger. Jack the concaved plate up with a supporting tool. Sometime, heat the concaved part
to wine color to reduce the force. When jacking the plate up, a little excess is acceptable. (Fig. 5-28)
(b) Thermal contraction
When the concave is jacked up, if the plate extends seriously and the area is large, the thermal contraction
method can be used in case that the traditional methods don't work. (Fig. 5-29)
Heat the work piece to cerise color with oxyacetylene flame. The heating scope depends on the degree of extension.
If the extension is serious or the area is large, the heating point shall be larger relatively (diameter: approx.20-
30mm). If the extension is not serious or the area is small, the heating point shall be a little smaller (diameter:
approx.10-15mm). After the heating, beat the heating point immediately. In the beating process, a proper sizing
block is used under the plate. After it is cooled down, beat it lightly with the hammer.
The contraction starts from the highest point to the center, and then to the edge. Heat and flatten the extended
part repeatedly till the plate is flattened fully. If the convex part is too high, compress it to one half of the original
height. After it is cooled down, heat it at the original heating point till the other half of convex part is removed.
7-20 Body Repair - Repair After Body Damage

Heating

Compress
Cooling
load

Metal bar thermal Extend load Plate work


contraction thermal contraction

Fig. 5-29 Thermal Contraction Method


For those parts that are not sure whether they will contract or not, the thermal contraction method shall not
be used to avoiding any side effect. Especially for those thin plates, great attention shall be made to prevent them
from melting down or burning through.
(c) Welding ring
The welding ring method is used to repair the most seriously damaged part of the concave on the plate work
surface. Some rings are welded to connect the rods. (Shown as Fig. 11-30) When the area of the concave is large,
several rings can be welded in a parallel manner, and gets through the rod to make the pulling force act on the plate
surface evenly. The ring can be replaced by the washer. The rod pulls the washer or shaft through a coupling device.
After the concaved plate is flattened by the inertia hammer puller, remove the ring or washer and finish the welding
points.
Rod

Washer Shaft

Shaft
Shaft
Washer

Washer

Fig. 5-30 Welding Washer Stretching


Body Repair - Repair After Body Damage 7-21

In addition, there are some other repair methods, such as beating repair (Fig. 5-31), plate reshaping repair
(Fig. 5-32), damaged plate work cutting repair (Fig. 5-33) and welding point cutting repair (Fig. 5-34).

Sizing block
Use sizing block

Knife

(b) Direct Beating on Deformed Surface

Knife

(a) Beating Repair

(c) Edge & Corner Repair (d) Plane Repair

Fig. 5-31

Steel plate

Start Beat Hammer

Sizing block Sizing block


File
Check evenness

Hammer
Finish Beat Flexible file
Sizing block

(a) Beating Modification (b) Check Fine Roughness with File

Fig. 5-32
7-22 Body Repair - Repair After Body Damage

Cutting line
Cutting line

(a) Cutting with Gas Welding (b) Cutting with Saw

Fig. 5-33

Electronic borer head

Flat blade borer

Mill welding point Removable piece


Separate
Mill welding point

Welding point

Wedge

(a) Milling Welding Point with Flat Blade Borer


(c) Separating Spot Welding Point

Brush
Welding point
Grinding wheel

Welding line

Determinate position of
welding point Grinding wheel

Welding line

(b) Drill Spot Welding Point with Common Borer (d) Seperating Continuous Welding Joint

Fig. 5-34
Body Repair - Repair After Body Damage 7-23

If the collision is not serious and the concave belongs to elastic deformation, the plate can be returned to its
original shape by pressing from the inside surface.
For some concaved parts, they can be repaired in a prizing method. The prizing method is a repair method
that needs not to disassemble the parts. According to the degree of deformation, repair the plate by means of various
clearances and the lever principle. As the prizing method doesn't disassemble the parts, it can keep the original
installation quality and improve the work efficiency.
d. Repair for Unsoldering
The unsoldering is mostly caused by the poor fusion between the welding bar and the metal plate. For the
common unsoldering, weld the metal plate again after remove the welding bar accumulated in the welding line.
For the unsoldering of the spot weld, weld the metal plate near the unsoldered point with a single-side spot welder.
The new welding point is about 10-15mm from the original point. Before the spot welding, remove the oil dirt and
rust in the welding point to ensure the plates are jointed in a good status.
For the unsoldering in some hems, after the two plates are jointed, weld the plates spasmodically on the edges
to make the plates joining together. The welding line at every block is about 30mm long. The line space depends
on the original welding space.
Another repair method for the unsoldering is plug welding. This method needs CO2 welding. Bore a dia. 6mm
hole on the outside plate, and then join the two plates. Weld the hole with the CO2 welding method. In the welding
process, the welding bare shall point to the inner plate and move in a circular manner, which can make the two plates
welded together. After the welding, finish and paint it.
7-24 Body Repair - Features and Composition of Automobile Body

Section 4 Features and Composition of Automobile Body


I. Body Feature
The body is an integral structure. Its main structure also is a frame, which can carry all loads. The vehicle is
designed with three compartments and five doors. With the same overall length, the space is utilized fully, which
is helpful to arrangement of passengers. (Fig. 5-35)

1435

1431

1450 848 2502 992


1934.5 4343

Fig. 5-35 Outline & Dimensions

1. Material of Punch Piece


In order to improve the body's rigidity, high-strength steel plates are used at many key parts on the body. For
the parts under forces, reinforced measures are carried out. (Fig. 5-36)

Fig. 5-36 High-strength Steel Panel


1. Engine compartment hood outside panel
3 2. Left/right fender
3. Left/right mid-door post inside panel
5
4. Luggage cover outside panel
4 5. Left/right door outside panel
Body Repair - Features and Composition of Automobile Body 7-25

2. Shock Absorption & Noise Isolation


(1) Body structure (Fig. 5-37)
a. Arrange the reinforced bar reasonably to improve the parts' rigidity, reduce the shock and lower the noise.
b. Apply the sealant in the floor seam to improve the floor sealing and reduce the noise in the cabin.

Fig. 5-37 Front Wall Panel


1. Front wall bridge reinforced panel
2. Front wall mid-frame panel
3. Front wall lower main panel
4. Heat-isolated pad

(2) Deadening
It is an interactive and systemic work to make the body isolate heat, shock and noise. Besides the measures
carried out to improve the body's stiffness and sealing performance, the following measures shall be taken in the
design and manufacture process.
a. Sound isolation material: add sound isolation pad on the front wall and floor.
b. Sound absorption material: add molded carpet on the front floor and rear floor.
3. Sealing
Special consideration has been given to the sealing of the body both in design process and in manufacture
process. Sealing plays an important role in many aspects, such as dust resistance, water resistance, corrosion
resistance, heat resistance, heat preservation, and noise reduce etc. Especially when the body floor and front wall
stay in a tough external condition, the mud, dust, noises (from the tire and engine) and hot air will invade into the
cabin any time.
After the body assembly is welded, sealant will be employed on all joints to prevent the water and steam
penetrating into the metal seam and ensure the quality of subsequent painting.
In addition, a thick layer of impact-proof PVC coat is applied on the base of the body, which has excellent
sealing performance. For the sealing to those assemblies, the traditional sealing method is used, such as rubber seal

3
1 Front

2
1 4

Fig. 5-38 (a) Body floor


1. Front mud guard 2. Rear side wall 3. Rear wheel housing 4.Floor sides
7-26 Body Repair - Features and Composition of Automobile Body

ring, cover, tape and dust shield etc. But these parts are more precise both in design process and in manufacture
process. For those contact seal pieces, the two-way dimension relation is more reliable. For the front windshield
and rear wall glass, a naturally hardened high-strength sealant is used, whose reliability and practicability reach
the state-of-the-art level. (Fig.5-38)

Apply sealant

Apply sealant

Apply sealant

Fig. 5-38 (b) Engine Compartment


Body Repair - Features and Composition of Automobile Body 7-27

Apply sealant

Apply sealant

Fig. 5-38 (c) Body Inside (I)


7-28 Body Repair - Features and Composition of Automobile Body

Apply sealant

Fig. 5-38 (d) Body Inner (II)


Body Repair - Features and Composition of Automobile Body 7-29

Apply sealant

Apply sealant

Fig. 5-38 (e) Luggage Compartment


7-30 Body Repair - Features and Composition of Automobile Body

Apply sealant

Apply sealant

Apply sealant

Apply sealant

Apply sealant

Apply sealant

Fig. 5-38 (f) Door


Body Repair - Features and Composition of Automobile Body 7-31

Apply sealant

Apply sealant

Apply sealant

Fig. 5-38 (g) Engine Hood & Luggage Compartment Lid


7-32 Body Repair - Features and Composition of Automobile Body

Engine hood

Engine dood hinge

Door

Front door upper hinge Rear door upper hinge

Oil tank cap

Front door lower hinge Rear door lower hinge

Fig. 5-38 (h) Antirust Position on Body Steel Panel


Body Repair - Features and Composition of Automobile Body 7-33

Fig. 2-38 (i) Filling Position of Foaming Material


7-34 Body Repair - Features and Composition of Automobile Body

PVC Impact-proof Coat

Fig. 5-38 (j) Painting Position of Impact-proof Coat

4. Surface Treatment
Surface treatment shall be strict, careful and all-around. Though this car is not a deluxe sedan, it nearly has no
difference with the deluxe sedan in the surface treatment.
a. Phosphoric acid processing
Phosphoric acid processing is also called pretreatment before painting. After removing the grease on the body
by washing, apply zinc phosphate onto the body, with a thickness under 3 1U m. It not only can protect the work piece,
but also can help to increase adhesion in the next coating process.
b. Cathode electrophoresis
In the practical application, the electrophoresis painting shows many advantages, such as high efficiency, good
quality, safety and cost effectiveness. It is accompanied with four electrochemical phenomena including
electroanalysis, electrophoresis, electrodeposition and electroosmosis. The cathode electrophoresis is much better
than the anode electrophoresis both in the features and advantages. Incomparably, the process is strict extremely.
c. Intermediate coat
The intermediate coat is also called intermediate layer, which is located between the primer and the surface
paint. Its function is to improve the evenness of the painted work piece and the primer and provide the surface paint
with a good base to improve the paint's brightness and richness and improve the decoration of the entire coat.
d. Surface paint
The surface paint is the last coat in the multiple coats, which directly affect the vehicle's decoration,
weatherability and appearance etc. Great attention shall be made when selecting the surface paint, including its
adaptability, cost-effectiveness and usability. All performance indexes shall meet the national standard and
industrial standard. The paint shall be even and smooth.
e. Protective coat
For those vehicles parked outside for a long time (more than three months) or used for shipping, water-soluble
protective wax shall be applied on the outside surface of the body. This agent contains ultraviolet absorbent. Before
selling the vehicle, wash it with soap detergent and flush it with clean water, to make the paint brighter.
Body Repair - Painting Techniques After Body Repair 7-35

Section 5 Painting Techniques After Body Repair


In the practical use, various factors may cause painting damage, such as traffic accident, component rust,
premature damage due to bubble, and local color change etc. It is necessary to make repair locally as the following
steps:
I. Base Processing (Pretreatment)
1. Remove the paint, and remove the coating on the plate work.
2. Cut the edges and corners, and polish the metal plate without paint and the uneven paint at the edge.
3. Blow and clean the dust and dirt, and remove the grease with degreasant.
II. Primer Processing
1. Apply the self-drying primer on the bare metal surface.
2. Leave the primer drying naturally, or dry it with the infrared radiator.
3. Apply the self-drying oily putty or polyester putty on the plate work surface.
4. Leave the putty drying naturally or artificially.
5. Polish the putty manually to remove the uneven parts.
6. Polish it manually in water to clear the sandpaper lines.
7. Wash the dirt, polish the oil dirt and putty slurry.
8. Wipe the oil dirt on the polishing surface.
9. Cover the part not to be repaired with protective shield or paper.
III. Painting Intermediate Coat
1. Paint the second primer.
2. Leave the primer drying naturally or dry it.
3. Find out the sand hole or sandpaper line.
4. Polish it manually in wet condition.
5. Wash the part clean, and leave it drying naturally. (The number of putty applying and polishing depends on the
evenness of the surface to be repaired.)
IV. Preparing to Paint Surface Paint
1. Paste paper on the surface not to be painted.
2. Remove the dust and grease on the local surface paint.
3. Mix the color the same with that of the vehicle's surface paint.
4. Prepare the paint.
V. Painting Surface Paint
1. Paint the part with fast-drying surface paint 3-4 times and synthetic resin paint 2-3 times.
2. Leave it drying naturally or dry it.
VI. Polishing
1. After painting, burnish the part with wax to clear the shadow and improve the effect.
2. After painting, tear off the paper and wipe the ground paint.
3. Check the appearance and quality.
7-36 Body Repair - Service Data For for Body

Section 6 Service Data For for Body


I. Technical Repair Data (Table 5-1)
Table 5-1
Technical Repair Data
Item (Clearance) Repair Data
Front fender and side wall outside plate 2.5mm(+1,0mm)
Front fender and front door outside plate 5mm±1mm
Side wall outside plate and front/rear door 5.5mm±1.5mm, Height Difference 2 mm±1.5mm
Door outside plate and side wall outside plate 6mm±1.5mm, Height Difference 2.5mm±1.5mm
Front door and rear door 5.5mm±1mm
Rear windshield and side wall outside plate 7mm±1.5mm
Luggage outside plate and side wall outside plate 4.5mm±1.5mm
Side wall outside plate and taillight & bumper 2mm±0.5
Luggage outside panel and rear taillight 5.5mm±0.5mm
Taillight and rear bumper 3mm(1,-0.5mm)
Side wall outside plate and refill opening 3.5mm(1,0mm)
Front bumper and headlight 3mm±1mm
Left fender and front bumper 1mm(1,0mm)
Engine cover outside plate and left front fender 4mm±1mm
Roof and front windshield 4mm±0.5mm
Roof and rear windshield 3mm±0.5mm
Left front fender and headlight 3mm±0.5mm
Engine cover outside plate and headlight 4.5mm±1mm
Side wall outside plate and front windshield 11mm±0.5mm
Body Repair - Service Data For for Body 7-37

II. Supplemental Specifications on Tightening Torque


For those fastening pieces either not specified in the "Body" part or not stated in other assemblies, the following
specifications shall apply.
Table 5-2
Supplemental Specifications for Vehicle Body and All Assembly Fastening Piece

Thread Dia. Thread Pitch Tightening Torque


(mm) (mm) Standard Value (N.m) Max. Value(N.m) Min. Value(N.m)
6 1 9 12 6
8 1.25 23 26 16
8 1 25 28 17
10 1.5 59 75 37
10 1.25 63 79 45
10 1 64 80 46
12 1.75 95 111 73
12 1.5 97 113 75
12 1.25 99 115 78
14 2 160 185 122
14 1.5 180 205 146
16 2 215 245 182
16 1.5 240 270 199
18 2.5 268 298 229
18 1.5 316 346 287
20 2.5 430 470 389
20 1.5 440 480 396
7-38

(mm)
1. Engine Compartment

Item Description Diameter of Hole X Y Z


A,a Front fender installetion hole(Front) 7(M6 nut) -336.18 +/-652.5 580.69
B,b Front absorber spring support hole(Inside) 10 1.09 +/-519.51 641.4
C,c Front fender installetion hole(Rear) 7(M6 nut) 62.3 +/-661.71 665.72
D Cowl panel drip charnel fixing hole 7(M6 nut) 66.13 -1.2 648.7
E,e Collision sensor installation hole 9(M8 nut) -445.74 +/-436.17 273.26
F Braking pipe instaltion hole 7(M6 nut) -49 -418.74 309.12
f ABS actuator installatim hole(front) 9(M8 nut) -48.64 417.53 291
G,g Radiator upper crossmermber installation hole(front) 7(M6 nut) -589.94 +/-397 452.84
H,h Radiator side insulation gasket installation hole 10x8 -621.82 +/-403.33 94.99
I Hood lock bracket installation hole 7(M6 nut) -662.61 0 36.34
J,j FR bumper horizontal installation hole 9(M8 nut) -651.68 -487.41 275.57
K,k Windscreen fastener installation hole 11.5x8.7 -849.35 +/-357.86 111.07
L,l Radiator uppor crossmenber installation hole 7(M6 nut) -553.26 +/-392.02 502.18
M,m Hood hinge hole(Rear) 9(M8 nut) 149.64 +/-668.27 678.44
Appendix: Body Key Dimensions

N,n Front fender support hole 10 -368.55 +/-704.84 379.94


O,o Joint between side outerpanel and roof panel £- 202.21 +/-636.33 736.57
P,p Joint between side outer panel and dash panel - 851.59 +/-508.37 1092.37

Measuring Measuring Measuring


point Value Tolerance point Value Tolerance point Value Tolerance

A-D 771±2.5 D-E 771±2.5 I-j 547±2.5


4 4 4
a-D 771±2.5 D-e 777±2.5 I-J 547±2.5
B-c 1183±2.5 D-L 746±2.5 I-H 410±2.5
4 4 4
b-C 1183±2.5 D-l 746±2.5 I-h 410±2.5
Appendix - Body Key Dimensions

B-D 522±2.5 N-O 1410±2.5 O-p 1360±2.5


4 4
b-D 552±2.5 A-c 1376±2.5 o-P 1360±2.5
4
C-M 89±2.5 a-C 1376±2.5 A-o 1408±2.5
4
c-m 89±2.5 a-O 1408±2.5

Measuring
point Value Tolerance

I-g 580±2.5
4
i-G 580±2.5
F-b 997±2.5
f-B 1088±2.5
L-c 1231±2.5
4
l-C 1231±2.5
Measuring
point Value Tolerance
G-n 1710±2.5
4
g-N 1710±2.5
I-o 1208±2.5
4
i-O 1208±2.5
M-n 1548±2.5
4
m-N 1548±2.5
M-q 1568±2.5
4
m-Q 1568±2.5
Q-r 1423±2.5
4
q-R 1423±2.5
E-f 1464±2.5
4
e-F 1464±2.5
2. Left/Right Side Wall Parts

H-i 1583±2.5
4
h-I 1583±2.5
M-r 1545±2.5
4
m-R 1545±2.5
N-o 1567±2.5
4
n-O 1567±2.5
I-h 1583±2.5
4
i-H 1583±2.5
E-b 2840±2.5
4
e-B 2840±2.5
T-s 2540±2.5
4
t-S 2540±2.5

Measuring
point Value Tolerance

E-h 1555±2.5
4
e-H 1555±2.5
E-j 1457±2.5
4
e-J 1457±2.5
F-j 1717±2.5
4
f-J 1717±2.5

Capital letter shows points in the right side and small letter show ones in the left side.Left and right are symmetrical
Appendix - Body Key Dimensions

Item Description Diameter of Hole X Y Z


C,c FR upper door hinge installation hole 13(M8 nut) 316.9 +/-742.96 569.3
D,d FR Lower door hinge installation hole 13(M8 nut) 327.8 +/-759.62 257.8
E,e A-pillar upper assembling mark 681.96 +/-615.09 945.67
F,f A-pillar lower assembling mark 443.19 +/-686.75 219.43
G,g Upper joint between side outer panel and roof panel 851.588 +/-508.37 1092.37
H,h FR door sill assembling mark 913.56 +/-682 120
I,i Roof side panel assembling mark 1154.83 +/-539.8 1097.59
Item Description Diameter of Hole X Y Z J,j B-pillar front assembling mark 1369.03 +/-664.67 833.91
A,a Lower joint between side outer panel ane roof panel £- 202.21 +/-636.33 736.57 K,k RR upper door hinge installation hole 15(M8 nut) 1401.94 +/-748.88 596.46
B,b Taillamp installation hole 5 2190.8 +/-679.49 632.24 L,l RR lower door ringe installation hole 15(M8 nut) 1354.63 +/-767.12 272.82
S,s Joint between side outer panel and taillamp panel £- 3154.87 +/-516.76 784.2 M,m B-pillar rear assembling mark 1493.1 +/-672.96 812.59
N,n RR door sill assembling mark 1774.79 +/-682 120
E-e F-f F-g/H-h I-i J-j O,o Roof side panel assembling mark 1711.65 +/-531.82 1108.55
1230±2.5 1374±2.5 1364±2.5 1080±2.5 1329±2.5 P,p Roof side panel assembling mark 2241.04 +/-604.31 940.02
M-m N-n O-o P-p Q-q R-r Q,q Rear fender assembling mark 2315.25 +/-658.16 712.07
1346±2.5 1364±2.5 1064±2.5 1029±2.5 1316±2.5 1364±2.5 R,r Rear fender assembling mark 2044.43 +/-682 316.52
7-39
7-40

3. Body Opening Part (Back View)


Appendix-

Measuring
point Value Tolerance

A-d 1504±2.5
4
a-D 1504±2.5
C-d 1191±2.5
4
c-D 1191±2.5
f-G 1217±2.5
4
F-g 1217±2.5
e-B 1599±2.5
Body Key Dimensions

4
E-b 1599±2.5
h-I 1003±2.5
4
H-i 1003±2.5

(mm)
Item Description Diameter of Hole X Y Z
A,a Back window glass fastener installation hole 11.5¡Á8.5 2327.46 +/-374.49 1118.41
B,b Rear absorber spring support hole 18 2506.99 +/-534.81 550.09
C,c Tall lamp installation hole 5 3190.8 +/-679.49 632.24
D,d Rear bumperinstallation bole 15 3202.45 +/-428.13 195.64
E,e B-pillar rear assembly mark - 1493.1 +/-672.96 812.59
F,f Rear joint between side outer panel and roof panel - 2310.74 +/-598.88 1106.12
G,g Joint between side outer panel and luggage compartment - 2816.19 +/-569.92 831.4
H,h Joint between side outer panel and tail lmap panel - 2987.01 +/-569.92 798.34
I,i Rear joint between side outer panel and rear end panel - 3327.63 +/-325.23 500.2
Appendix - Torque Table of the Fasteners for Important Assembly I

Appendix: Torque Table of the Fasteners for Important Assembly


Torque N.m
No. Area Fastener JL7132U
JL7132HU
JL7152U
JL7152HU JL7162U
1 Engine right insulator x body JQ184C1025(3 pcs) 43~58 43~58
2 Brake pedal with bracket assy. x central cross member Q151B0820(1 pcs) 22~29 22~29
Brake pedal with bracket assy. x brake master cylinder
3 Q32008(4 pcs) 22~29 22~29
with vacuum booster assy.
4 Clutch pedal x central cross member Q1840816(1 pcs)/ 22~29
5 Clutch pedal x clutch master cylinder Q32208(2 pcs)/ 22~29
6 Accelerator pedal Q32208(2 pcs) 22~29 22~29
7 LH/RH front brake pipe component x HECU controller Null 13~18 13~18
8 LH/RH rear brake pipe component I x HECU controller Null 13~18 13~18
Brake master cylinder No. 1 and No.2 pipe component
9 Null 13~18 13~18
x HECU controller, brake master cylinder
10 Clutch hydraulic hose assy. x master cylinder oil outlet pipe component Null 13~18 13~18
11 Steering column assy. x universal joint assy. Q151B0820TF2(1 pcs) 22~29 22~29

front suspension
12 (LH & RH) front shock absorber component x body support sub-assy. 37~45 37~45
Mounting nut (6 pcs)

13 (LH & RH) rear shock absorber component top nut Q341C10(2 pcs) 22~29 22~29
(LH & RH) front shock absorber piston rod x front
14 Q330B12(2 pcs) 31~38 31~38
suspension bracket sub-assy.
15 (LH & RH) rear seat belt assy. x body 7/16" bolt ( ) 39~53 39~53
16 (LH & RH) front seat belt assy. x body 7/16" bolt( ) 39~53 39~53
17 (LH & RH) front buckle assy. x body 7/16" bolt( ) 39~53 39~53
18 RR seat belt buckle and lap belt assy. x body 7/16" bolt( ) 39~53 39~53
19 LR buckle assy. x body 7/16" bolt( ) 39~53 39~53
20 Rear axle assy. x body JQ14012110TF2(2 pcs) 73~103 73~103
21 (LH & RH) rear shock absorber x rear axle JQ320B12(2 pcs) 47~56 47~56
LH & RH brake pipe component III x LH & RH rear
22 Null 13~18 13~18
drum brake with wheel hub assy.
23 LH & RH rear brake hose x LH & RH rear brake pipe component III Null 13~18 13~18
24 LH/RH rear drum brake with wheel hub assy. x rear axle Mounting nut (8pcs) 60~72 60~72
25 LH/RH rear brake pipe component I x LH/RH rear brake pipe component II Null 13~18 13~18
II Appendix - Torque Table of the Fasteners for Important Assembly

Appendix: Torque Table of the Fasteners for Important Assembly


Torque N.m
No. Area Fastener JL7132U
JL7132HU
JL7152U
JL7152HU JL7162U
26 LH/RH rear brake pipe component II x rear brake hose assy. Null 13~18 13~18
27 front suspension cross member (front part) x body JQ1401280TF2(2 pcs) 94~110 94~110
28 Front suspension cross member (rear part) x body JQ1401455TF2(2 pcs) 110~130 110~130
29 Engine right mount x right insulator JQ319B10(1 pcs) 49~60 49~60
30 Engine left mount x left insulator JQ184C1030(2 pcs) 43~58 43~58
31 Engine left LH x body JQ184B12140(1 pcs) 94~110 94~110
32 Engine x automatic transmission JQ140BD1255TF2(2 pcs) / 55~70
33 Engine x automatic transmission JQ140BD1260TF2(1 pcs) / 55~70
34 Engine x automatic transmission JQ140C1040TF2(1 pcs) / 43~58
35 Engine x automatic transmission JQ140C1020(3 pcs) / 43~58
36 Engine x automatic transmission JQ140BD1255TF2(2 pcs) 55~70 /
37 Engine x automatic transmission JQ140BD1045TF2(1 pcs) 43~58 /
38 Engine x automatic transmission JQ140C1040TF2(1 pcs) 43~58 /
39 Engine x automatic transmission JQ140C0820(3 pcs) 22~29 /
40 Starter x transmission JQ146C1040TF2(2 pcs) 30~60 30~60
41 Engine left bracket x transmission JQ184C1030(3 pcs) 43~58 43~58
42 Engine rear bracket x engine JQ184C1025(2 pcs) 43~58 43~58
43 Engine rear bracket x engine JQ184C1020(1 pcs) 43~58 43~58
44 Compressor bracket x engine JQ146C1035(1 pcs) 43~58 43~58
45 Compressor bracket x engine JQ146C1030(3 pcs) 43~58 43~58
46 Power steering pump with bracket assy. (without reservoir) x engine Q1420825(3 pcs) 22~29 22~29
47 Power steering pump with bracket assy. (without reservoir) x engine Q14201030(1 pcs) 43~58 43~58
48 Oil pump adjustment bracket x engine JQ146C1030(2 pcs) 43~58 43~58
Oil pump adjustment bracket x power steering pump
49 JQ146C1030(1 pcs) 43~58 43~58
with bracket assy. (without reservoir)
Oil pump mounting bracket x power steering pump with
50 JQ142C1085(2 pcs) 43~58 43~58
bracket assy. (without reservoir)
Oil pump mounting bracket x power steering pump with
51 Q40110(1 pcs) 43~58 43~58
bracket assy. (without reservoir)
Oil pump mounting bracket x power steering pump with
52 Q361C10(1 pcs) 43~58 43~58
bracket assy. (without reservoir)
53 Rear insulator x front suspension cross member JQ184C1060(1 pcs) 43~65 43~65
Appendix - Torque Table of the Fasteners for Important Assembly III

Appendix: Torque Table of the Fasteners for Important Assembly


Torque N.m
No. Area Fastener JL7132U
JL7132HU
JL7152U
JL7152HU JL7162U
54 Rear insulator x front suspension cross member JQ319C10(2 pcs) 43~65 43~65
55 Front stabilizer bar x front suspension cross member Q1400825(4 pcs) 22~29 22~29
56 Power steering gear with tie rod assy. x front suspension cross member JQ184B1265(2 pcs) 125~152 125~152
57 High/low pressure oil pipe assy. x power steering gear with tie rod assy. Null 25~32 25~32
LH & RH lower suspension swing arm x front sus
58 JQ1401280TF2(2 pcs) 125~152 125~152
pension cross member rear
LH & RH lower suspension swing arm x front sus
59 JQ320B12(2pcs) 125~152 125~152
pension cross member rear
LH & RH lower suspension swing arm x front s
60 JQ1401280TF2(2 pcs) 83-103 83-103
uspension cross member front
61 Front stabilizer bar x LH & RH lower suspension swing arm assy. JQ33808(2 pcs) 22~29 22~29
(LH & RH) front brake hose x (LH & RH) front disk brake hose union 13~18 13~18
62
brake with steering knuckle assy. bolt (2 pcs)
63 Engine rear insulator x rear bracket Q184C10105(1 pcs) 61~74 61~74
64 High pressure oil pipe assy. x power steering pump with bracket assy. Union bolt 51~63 51~63
(LH & RH) lower swing arm ball joint x (LH & RH) disk
65 JQ38312(2 pcs) 83~103 83~103
brake with steering knuckle assy.
LH & RH brake with steering knuckle assy. x power
66 Q383B10(2 pcs) 30~40 30~40
steering gear assy. with tie rod assy.
(LH & RH) front disk brake with steering knuckle assy.
67 JQ1841450TF2(4 pcs)125~152 125~152
x (LH & RH) front shock absorber
(LH & RH) front disk brake with steering knuckle assy.
68 JQ320C14(4 pcs) 125~152 125~152
x (LH & RH) front shock absorber
69 LH/RH constant velocity drive shaft assy. Set nut 190~230 190~230
70 (LH & RH) front brake hose x (LH & RH) front brake pipe Null 13~18 13~18
Front suspension reinforcement member x front
71 JQ1401020(4 pcs) 43~58 43~58
suspension cross member, body
72 Oil tank component x body JQ146Db0835A(4 pcs) 22~29 22~29
73 3-way catalytic converter assy. x engine exhaust manifold JQ189C1058TF2E(4 pcs) 40~60 40~60
74 Intermediate muffler x 3-way catalytic converter assy. JQ1461035(2 pcs) 40~60 40~60
75 Intermediate muffler x 3-way catalytic converter assy. JQ32010(2 pcs) 40~60 40~60
76 Primary muffler x intermediate muffler JQ1461035(2 pcs) 40~60 40~60
IV Appendix - Torque Table of the Fasteners for Important Assembly

Appendix: Torque Table of the Fasteners for Important Assembly


Torque N.m
No. Area Fastener JL7132U
JL7132HU
JL7152U
JL7152HU JL7162U
77 Primary muffler x intermediate muffler JQ32010(2 pcs) 40~60 40~60
78 Engine right mount x right insulator JQ184C1040(2 pcs) 49~60 49~60
79 Wheel rim x wheel hub Hub nut (16 pcs) 88~117 88~117
80 Universal joint x power steering gear Q151B0820TF2(1 pcs) 22~29 22~29
81 Steering wheel x steering column assy. Steering wheel nut 33~59 33~59

You might also like